Docs: fix mention of (the nonexistent) $domain_verified. Bug 2567
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.93"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552020
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "website"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455.cindex "wiki"
456.cindex "FAQ"
457As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496.cindex "bug reports"
497.cindex "reporting bugs"
498Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506.cindex "FTP site"
507.cindex "HTTPS download site"
508.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509.cindex "distribution" "https site"
510The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511.display
512&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513.endd
514The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524here are top-level directories.
525
526There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533.display
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537.endd
538where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541most portable to old systems.
542
543.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544.cindex "distribution" "public key"
545.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565.endd
566For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574.display
575&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579.endd
580These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585.ilist
586.cindex "limitations of Exim"
587.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593.next
594.cindex "domainless addresses"
595.cindex "address" "without domain"
596Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600arrival.
601.next
602.cindex "transport" "external"
603.cindex "external transports"
604The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610.next
611Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614other means.
615.next
616Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620a number of common scanners are provided.
621.endlist
622
623
624.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6413, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653.cindex "terminology definitions"
654.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657below) by a blank line.
658
659.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666rise to further bounce messages.
667
668The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671otherwise.
672
673The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676until a later time.
677
678The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682.cindex "envelope, definition of"
683.cindex "sender" "definition of"
684A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692.cindex "header section" "definition of"
693The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697line.
698
699.cindex "local part" "definition of"
700.cindex "domain" "definition of"
701The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712.cindex "return path" "definition of"
713&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714message's envelope.
715
716.cindex "queue" "definition of"
717The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744.cindex "incorporated code"
745.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746.cindex "PCRE"
747.cindex "OpenDMARC"
748A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750.ilist
751Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757.next
758.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763following statements:
764
765.blockquote
766Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771version.
772This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776restrictions applied to it).
777.endblockquote
778.next
779.cindex "SPA authentication"
780.cindex "Samba project"
781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785under the Gnu GPL.
786.next
787.cindex "Cyrus"
788.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793conditions expressed therein.
794
795.blockquote
796Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800are met:
801
802.olist
803Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805.next
806Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809distribution.
810.next
811The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814details, please contact
815.display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822.endd
823.next
824Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825acknowledgment:
826
827&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837.endlist
838.endblockquote
839
840.next
841.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842.cindex "X-windows"
843.cindex "Athena"
844The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849.blockquote
850Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853All Rights Reserved
854
855Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869SOFTWARE.
870.endblockquote
871
872.next
873.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878source code.
879
880.next
881Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884.endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898.cindex "design philosophy"
899Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908.cindex "policy control" "overview"
909Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915.ilist
916.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925error code.
926.next
927An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929.next
930When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934.next
935When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940.next
941Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944.next
945After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947runs at the start of every delivery process.
948.endlist
949
950
951
952.section "User filters" "SECID12"
953.cindex "filter" "introduction"
954.cindex "Sieve filter"
955In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960of filtering are available:
961
962.ilist
963Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964by RFC 3028.
965.next
966Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968.endlist
969
970User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976.cindex "format" "of message id"
977.cindex "id of message"
978.cindex "base62"
979.cindex "base36"
980.cindex "Darwin"
981.cindex "Cygwin"
982Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989not always case-sensitive.
990
991.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997somewhat eccentric:
998
999.ilist
1000The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003way of representing the date and time of day).
1004.next
1005After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006received the message.
1007.next
1008There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009.olist
1010.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015.next
1016If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018(1/100) of a second.
1019.endlist
1020.endlist
1021
1022After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030.cindex "receiving mail"
1031.cindex "message" "reception"
1032The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035there are several possibilities:
1036
1037.ilist
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041.next
1042If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048.next
1049If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054.next
1055A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059.endlist
1060
1061
1062.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113affect file system performance.
1114
1115The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137.cindex "message" "life of"
1138.cindex "message" "frozen"
1139A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151to be sent.
1152
1153.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1158
1159.cindex "message" "log file for"
1160.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169systems.
1170
1171.cindex "journal file"
1172.cindex "file" "journal"
1173All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192.cindex "router" "definition of"
1193.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208the driver's features in general.
1209
1210A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214to be bounced.
1215
1216A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233configuration.
1234
1235The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243configured to fail the address.
1244
1245The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262.cindex "router" "for verification"
1263.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268&%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283.cindex "router" "running details"
1284.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285.cindex "router" "result of running"
1286As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290the following:
1291
1292.ilist
1293&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295original address ceases
1296.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301end of routing.
1302
1303Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308.next
1309&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314.next
1315&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320.next
1321&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324.next
1325&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329.next
1330&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332.endlist
1333
1334If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348.cindex "case of local parts"
1349.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366.ilist
1367.cindex affix "router precondition"
1368The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373of any other conditions.
1374.next
1375Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378address.
1379Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384.next
1385If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390.next
1391Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394.next
1395Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397.next
1398If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399of domains that it defines.
1400.next
1401.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1403.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1404.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1405.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1406.cindex affix "router precondition"
1407If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1408the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1409&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1410part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1411that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1412.new
1413that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1414&$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1415and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1416.wen
1417.next
1418.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1419.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1420.vindex "&$home$&"
1421If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1422an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1423local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1424user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1425remaining preconditions.
1426.next
1427If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1428because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1429later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1430subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1431could lead to confusion.
1432.next
1433If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1434set of addresses that it defines.
1435.next
1436If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1437specified files is tested.
1438.next
1439.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1440If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1441uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1442Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1443.endlist
1444
1445
1446Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1447it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1448part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1449&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1450&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1451going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1452example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1453
1454
1455
1456.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1457.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1458When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1459
1460.ilist
1461If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1462filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1463message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1464fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1465files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1466filtering'&.
1467.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1468(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1469
1470Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1471&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1472filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1473if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1474be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1475condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1476filter.
1477.next
1478Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1479its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1480address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1481can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1482processed entirely independently of each other.
1483.next
1484.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1485.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1486A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1487transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1488is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1489Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1490from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1491process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1492which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1493.next
1494When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1495handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1496doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1497local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1498collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1499addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1500address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1501addresses to the same domain.
1502.next
1503Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1504non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1505deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1506to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1507run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1508one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1509The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1510deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1511.next
1512.cindex "queue runner"
1513When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1514database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1515address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1516Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1517reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1518queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1519follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1520better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1521causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1522.next
1523.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1524Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1525deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1526retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1527reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1528not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1529.next
1530If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1531appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1532for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1533messages to other addresses.
1534.next
1535.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1536If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1537the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1538&'deferred'&.
1539.next
1540When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1541handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1542deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1543.endlist
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1549.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1550.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1551.cindex "queue runner"
1552Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1553attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1554uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1555intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1556not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1557first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1558its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1559passed its retry time.
1560You can run several queue runners at once.
1561
1562Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1563address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1564should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1565bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1566error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1567as permanent.
1568
1569
1570
1571.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1572.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1573There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1574particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1575connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1576detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1577Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1578is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1579impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1580also apply.
1581
1582If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1583waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1584connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1585deferred,
1586.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1587Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1588SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1589for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1590connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1591one connection.
1592
1593
1594
1595.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1596.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1597.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1598When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1599bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1600errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1601delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1602many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1603attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1604message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1605See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1606
1607.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1608Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1609failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1610automatically.
1611
1612.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1613A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1614obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1615address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1616forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1617failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1618&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1619of the list.
1620
1621
1622
1623.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1624.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1625If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1626itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1627but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1628that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1629for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1630&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1637. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1638
1639.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1640.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1641
1642.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1643Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1644creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1645&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1646
1647.table2 140pt
1648.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1649.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1650 documented"
1651.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1652.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1653.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1654.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1655 instructions"
1656.endtable
1657
1658Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1659following subdirectories are created:
1660
1661.table2 140pt
1662.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1663.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1664.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1665.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1666.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1667.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1668.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1669.endtable
1670
1671The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1672with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1673that may be useful to some sites.
1674
1675
1676.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1677.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1678The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1679a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1680source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1681Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1682system.
1683.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1684Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1685the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1686architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1687overridden if necessary.
1688.cindex compiler requirements
1689.cindex compiler version
1690A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1691
1692
1693.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1694.cindex "PCRE library"
1695Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1696modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1697install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1698system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1699process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1700headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1701and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1702or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1703If your operating system has no
1704PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1705from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1706More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1707
1708.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1709.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1710.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1711Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1712DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1713databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1714different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1715
1716.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1717.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1718.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1719.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1720If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1721Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1722may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1723you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1724
1725.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1726Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1727via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1728versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1729some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1730distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1731versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1732Berkeley DB library.
1733
1734Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1735use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1736possibilities:
1737
1738.olist
1739A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1740Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1741.next
1742.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1743The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1744compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1745&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1746filename is used unmodified.
1747.next
1748.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1749The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1750operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1751programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1752.next
1753If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1754file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1755the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1756.next
1757To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1758Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17592.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1760Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1761Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1762&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1763page with far newer versions listed.
1764It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1765Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1766suited to Exim's usage model.
1767.next
1768.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1769Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1770&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1771operates on a single file.
1772.endlist
1773
1774.cindex "USE_DB"
1775.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1776Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1777to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1778USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1779&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1780.code
1781USE_DB=yes
1782.endd
1783Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1784error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1785
1786At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1787thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1788configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1789Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1790configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1791&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1792
1793As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1794necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1795in one of these lines:
1796.code
1797DBMLIB = -ldb
1798DBMLIB = -ltdb
1799.endd
1800Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1801place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1802the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1803file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1804this example:
1805.code
1806INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1807DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1808.endd
1809There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1810file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1811
1812
1813
1814.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1815.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1816.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1817.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1818.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1819Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1820independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1821&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1822&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1823therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1824building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1825&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1826
1827There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1828without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1829(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1830(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1831maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1832a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1833
1834There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1835at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1836machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1837directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1838you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1839detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1840be logged.
1841
1842.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1843Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1844access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1845facilities, you need to set
1846.code
1847WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1848.endd
1849in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1850chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1851
1852
1853.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1854.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1855If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1856required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1857your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1858happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1859&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1860
1861This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1862operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1863to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1864configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1865defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1866do this.
1867
1868
1869
1870.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1871.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1872.cindex "RFC 2047"
1873The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1874described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1875in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1876character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1877mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1878(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1879supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1880
1881However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1882very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1883&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1884systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1885&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1886.code
1887HAVE_ICONV=yes
1888.endd
1889to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1890
1891
1892
1893.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1894.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1895.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1896.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1897.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1898Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1899command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1900start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1901&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1902line option).
1903
1904If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1905OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1906implementing SSL.
1907
1908If you do not want TLS support you should set
1909.code
1910DISABLE_TLS=yes
1911.endd
1912in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1913
1914If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1915.code
1916USE_OPENSL=yes
1917TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1918.endd
1919in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1920OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1921.code
1922USE_OPENSSL=yes
1923TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1924TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1925.endd
1926.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1927If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1928.code
1929USE_OPENSSL=yes
1930USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1931.endd
1932.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1933If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1934.code
1935USE_GNUTLS=yes
1936TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1937.endd
1938in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1939library and include files. For example:
1940.code
1941USE_GNUTLS=yes
1942TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1943TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1944.endd
1945.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1946If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1947.code
1948USE_GNUTLS=yes
1949USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1950.endd
1951
1952You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1953specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1954given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1960
1961.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1962.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1963.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1964.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1965Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1966SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1967alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1968already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1969should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1970&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1971&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1972EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1973you might have
1974.code
1975USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1976CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1977EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1978.endd
1979in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1980files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1981.code
1982exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1983.endd
1984in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1985the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1986All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1987can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1988&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1989configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1990further details.
1991
1992
1993.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1994.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1995Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1996&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1997it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1998where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1999library files.
2000
2001Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2002defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2003currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2004as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2005over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2006Exim used to
2007have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2008withdrawn.
2009
2010
2011
2012.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2013.cindex "lookup modules"
2014.cindex "dynamic modules"
2015.cindex ".so building"
2016On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2017the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2018on demand.
2019This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2020library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2021dependencies.
2022Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2023
2024Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2025installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2026measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2027for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2028Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2029see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2030
2031Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2032&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2033For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2034on demand:
2035.code
2036LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2037LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2038LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2039.endd
2040
2041
2042.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2043.cindex "build directory"
2044Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2045created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2046operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2047For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2048&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2049.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2050Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2051
2052If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2053a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2054&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2055&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2056then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2057number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2058makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2059directory, should this ever be necessary.
2060
2061If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2062&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2063FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2064
2065
2066
2067.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2068The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2069unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2070output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2071appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2072each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2073get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2074.code
2075FULLECHO='' make -e
2076.endd
2077The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2078command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2079given in addition to the short output.
2080
2081
2082
2083.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2084.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2085The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2086consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2087values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2088more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2089convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2090order:
2091.display
2092&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2093&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2094&_Local/Makefile_&
2095&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2096&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2097&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2098&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2099.endd
2100.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2101.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2102.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2103where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2104architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2105process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2106and are often not needed.
2107
2108The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2109called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2110the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2111values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2112Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2113fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2114of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2115that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2116to find out what values are being used on your system.
2117
2118
2119&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2120therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2121needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2122file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2123default values are.
2124
2125
2126.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2127If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2128or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2129need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2130putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2131.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2132when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2133formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2134compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2135called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2136Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2137default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2138containing the lines
2139.code
2140CC=cc
2141CFLAGS=-std1
2142.endd
2143If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2144these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2145
2146Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2147files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2148the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2149
2150
2151.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2152.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2153.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2154.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2155Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2156lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2157not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2158and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2159which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2160case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2161.code
2162LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2163LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2164LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2165.endd
2166and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2167&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2168libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2169.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2170However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2171the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2172files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2173binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2174errors.
2175
2176.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2177.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2178Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2179about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2180being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2181makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2182variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2183name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2184&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2185with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2186syntax. For instance:
2187.code
2188LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2189LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2190AUTH_GSASL=yes
2191AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2192AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2193AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2194.endd
2195
2196.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2197Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2198subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2199.code
2200EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2201.endd
2202must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2203chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2204
2205.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2206The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2207operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2208with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2209monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2210The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2211.code
2212X11=/usr/X11R6
2213XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2214XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2215.endd
2216These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2217example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2218.code
2219X11=/usr/openwin
2220XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2221XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2222.endd
2223If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2224definition of all three of these variables into your
2225&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2226
2227.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2228If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2229variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2230default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2231command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2232
2233.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2234There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2235use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2236EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2237binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2238libraries.
2239
2240.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2241The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2242files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2243necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2244&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2245
2246
2247.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2248.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2249.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2250The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2251&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2252normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2253recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2254are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2255
2256
2257
2258.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2259.cindex "building Eximon"
2260A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2261where the files that are involved are
2262.display
2263&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2264&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2265&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2266&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2267&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2268&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2269.endd
2270.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2271As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2272&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2273&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2274variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2275EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2276LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2277.ecindex IIDbuex
2278
2279
2280.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2281.cindex "installing Exim"
2282.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2283The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2284arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2285whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2286.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2287The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2288going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2289&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2290install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2291some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2292it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2293chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2294
2295.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2296Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2297in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2298exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2299by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2300is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2301alternative files, no default is installed.
2302
2303.cindex "system aliases file"
2304.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2305One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2306default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2307The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2308SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2309If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2310and outputs a comment to the user.
2311
2312The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2313aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2314kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2315&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2316Exim's configuration if necessary.
2317
2318The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2319and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2320running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2321directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2322other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2323over SMTP.
2324
2325It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2326distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2327command such as
2328.code
2329make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2330.endd
2331This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2332paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2333configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2334For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2335but this usage is deprecated.
2336
2337.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2338Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2339&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2340upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2341directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2342INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2343
2344For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2345to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2346installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2347for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2348called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2349of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2350from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2351
2352.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2353If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2354real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2355command:
2356.code
2357make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2358.endd
2359The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2360script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2361the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2362directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2363command:
2364.code
2365(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2366.endd
2367.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2368There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2369
2370.ilist
2371&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2372to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2373.next
2374&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2375installed binary.
2376.endlist
2377
2378INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2379.code
2380make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2381.endd
2382The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2383to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2384without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2385.code
2386make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2387.endd
2388
2389
2390
2391.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2392.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2393Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2394reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2395distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2396&<<SECTavail>>&).
2397
2398If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2399source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2400install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2401
2402
2403
2404.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2405.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2406When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2407exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2408directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2409necessary.
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2415.cindex "testing" "installation"
2416Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2417syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2418Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2419.code
2420exim -bV
2421.endd
2422If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2423Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2424the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2425other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2426Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2427example,
2428.display
2429&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2430.endd
2431should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2432.display
2433&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2434.endd
2435a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2436This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2437user agent. For example:
2438.code
2439exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2440From: user@your.domain.example
2441To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2442Subject: Testing Exim
2443
2444This is a test message.
2445^D
2446.endd
2447The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2448In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2449arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2450
2451.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2452If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2453&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2454of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2455&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2456with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2457.display
2458&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2459.endd
2460You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2461produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2462For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2463relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2464&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2465
2466.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2467.cindex "lock files"
2468One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2469local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2470&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2471writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2472is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2473directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2474that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2475&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2476approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2477&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2478agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2479see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2480
2481One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2482the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2483&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2484port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2485&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2486incoming SMTP mail.
2487
2488Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2489be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2490within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2491that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2492production version.
2493
2494
2495.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2496.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2497Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2498general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2499is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2500operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2501binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2502normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2503or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2504.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2505a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2506privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2507and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2508
2509.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2510.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2511Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2512example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2513&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2514described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2515as follows:
2516.code
2517sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2518send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2519mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2520newaliases /usr/bin/true
2521.endd
2522Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2523your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2524favourite user agent.
2525
2526You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2527have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2528various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2529command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2530use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2531&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2532
2533
2534
2535.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2536.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2537If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2538version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2539call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2540.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2541.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2542to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2543new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2544version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2545configuration file.
2546
2547
2548
2549
2550.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2551.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2552The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2553.code
2554/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2555.endd
2556If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2557fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2558for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2559(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2560solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2561.code
2562pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2563.endd
2564to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2565
2566Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2567still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2568(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2574. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2575
2576.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2577.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2578.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2579Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2580each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2581options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2582some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2583combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2584The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2585
2586
2587.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2588.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2589If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2590were present before any other options.
2591The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2592standard output.
2593This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2594that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2595&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2596
2597.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2598If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2599were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2600&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2601format.
2602
2603.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2604If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2605&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2606Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2607
2608.cindex "&'runq'&"
2609.cindex "queue runner"
2610If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2611were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2612option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2613
2614.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2615.cindex "alias file" "building"
2616.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2617If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2618&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2619This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2620the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2621command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2622
2623
2624.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2625Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2626available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2627user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2628EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2629&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2630
2631.ilist
2632.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2633.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2634The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2635&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2636supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2637configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2638
2639.cindex '&"From"& line'
2640.cindex "envelope from"
2641.cindex "envelope sender"
2642Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2643&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2644Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2645See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2646users to set envelope senders.
2647
2648.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2649.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2650.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2651.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2652For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2653header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2654&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2655
2656Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2657protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2658locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2659have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2660users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2661that are available to trusted users.
2662.next
2663.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2664.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2665The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2666Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2667The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2668
2669Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2670operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2671necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2672the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2673
2674By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2675Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2676However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2677option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2678
2679Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2680is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2681false.
2682.endlist
2683
2684
2685&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2686edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2687getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2688&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2694Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2695of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2696a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2697format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2698on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2699with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2700outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2701
2702. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2703. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2704. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2705. creates a man page for the options.
2706. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2707
2708.literal xml
2709<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2710.literal off
2711
2712
2713.vlist
2714.vitem &%--%&
2715.oindex "--"
2716.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2717This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2718therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2719rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2720
2721.vitem &%--help%&
2722.oindex "&%--help%&"
2723This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2724The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2725no arguments.
2726
2727.vitem &%--version%&
2728.oindex "&%--version%&"
2729This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2730displayed.
2731
2732.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2733 &%-Am%&
2734.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2735.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2736These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2737ignored by Exim.
2738
2739.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2740.oindex "&%-B%&"
2741.cindex "8-bit characters"
2742.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2743This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2744clean; it ignores this option.
2745
2746.vitem &%-bd%&
2747.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2748.cindex "daemon"
2749.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2750.cindex "queue runner"
2751This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2752the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2753that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2754
2755The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2756(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2757disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2758stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2759
2760By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2761all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2762ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2763&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2764
2765When a listening daemon
2766.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2767.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2768is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2769configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2770in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2771PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2772running as root.
2773
2774When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2775process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2776used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2777
2778The SIGHUP signal
2779.cindex "SIGHUP"
2780.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2781.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2782.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2783.cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2784.cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2785.cindex reload configuration
2786can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2787whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2788means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2789of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2790referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2791because these are reread each time they are used.
2792
2793.vitem &%-bdf%&
2794.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2795This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2796from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2797
2798.vitem &%-be%&
2799.oindex "&%-be%&"
2800.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2801.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2802Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2803prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2804files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2805of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2806
2807If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2808to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2809used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2810function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2811test data. A line history is supported.
2812
2813Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2814continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2815continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2816string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2817configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2818message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2819is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2820
2821&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2822files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2823the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2824of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2825
2826Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2827defined and macros will be expanded.
2828Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2829available to admin users.
2830
2831.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2832.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2833.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2834.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2835This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2836of a file. For example:
2837.code
2838exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2839.endd
2840The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2841message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2842variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2843no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2844recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2845&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2846line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2847&%-be%&).
2848
2849.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2850.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2851.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2852.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2853This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2854tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2855system filters are recognized.
2856
2857.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2858.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2859.cindex "filter" "testing"
2860.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2861.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2862.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2863.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2864This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2865to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2866there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2867supplied.
2868
2869If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2870can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2871filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2872.code
2873exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2874.endd
2875This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2876variables that are used by the user filter.
2877
2878If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2879.code
2880# Exim filter
2881# Sieve filter
2882.endd
2883it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2884that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2885&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2886redirection lists.
2887
2888The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2889detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2890with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2891separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2892
2893When testing a filter file,
2894.cindex "&""From""& line"
2895.cindex "envelope from"
2896.cindex "envelope sender"
2897.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2898the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2899or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2900that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2901can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2902options).
2903
2904.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2905.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2906.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2907This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2908tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2909&$qualify_domain$&.
2910
2911.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2912.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2913This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2914tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2915process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2916suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2917actually being delivered.
2918
2919.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2920.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2921.cindex affix "filter testing"
2922This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2923file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2924prefix.
2925
2926.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2927.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2928.cindex affix "filter testing"
2929This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2930file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2931suffix.
2932
2933.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2934.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2935.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2936.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2937.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2938.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2939.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2940.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2941This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2942standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2943after a full stop. For example:
2944.code
2945exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2946exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2947.endd
2948When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2949of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2950conversion to the canonical form is
2951&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2952
2953Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2954include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2955This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2956messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2957test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2958
2959&*Warning 1*&:
2960.cindex "RFC 1413"
2961You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2962information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2963an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2964connection.
2965
2966&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2967are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2968occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2969
2970Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2971written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2972lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2973can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2974and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2975session were authenticated.
2976
2977The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2978output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2979acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2980
2981Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2982plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2983specialized SMTP test program such as
2984&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2985
2986.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2987.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2988This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2989verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2990updating the callout cache database.
2991
2992.vitem &%-bi%&
2993.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2994.cindex "alias file" "building"
2995.cindex "building alias file"
2996.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2997Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2998Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2999this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3000tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3001recognized.
3002
3003If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3004configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3005the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3006The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3007use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3008if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3009&%-bi%& is a no-op.
3010
3011. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3012.vitem &%-bI:help%&
3013.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3014.cindex "querying exim information"
3015We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3016information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3017consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3018synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3019options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3020
3021.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3022.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3023.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3024This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3025recognised DSCP names.
3026
3027.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3028.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3029.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3030This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3031Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3032useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3033&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3034compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3035way to guarantee a correct response.
3036
3037.vitem &%-bm%&
3038.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3039.cindex "local message reception"
3040This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3041locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3042command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3043argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3044default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3045if no other conflicting option is present.
3046
3047If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3048qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3049options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3050suppressing this for special cases.
3051
3052Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3053the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3054
3055.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3056The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3057action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3058
3059The format
3060.cindex "message" "format"
3061.cindex "format" "message"
3062.cindex "&""From""& line"
3063.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3064.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3065of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3066compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3067.code
3068From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3069From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3070.endd
3071(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3072is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3073authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3074matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3075option, which can be changed if necessary.
3076
3077.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3078The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3079&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3080preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3081trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3082
3083.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3084.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3085.cindex "testing", "malware"
3086.cindex "malware scan test"
3087This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3088(depending on the used scanner interface),
3089using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3090this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3091the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3092not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3093will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3094
3095Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3096using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3097user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3098This option requires admin privileges.
3099
3100The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3101there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3102administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3103
3104.vitem &%-bnq%&
3105.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3106.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3107By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3108without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3109is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3110envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3111&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3112defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3113
3114Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3115being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3116content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3117header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3118syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3119
3120The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3121messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3122addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3123unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3124
3125
3126.vitem &%-bP%&
3127.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3128.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3129.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3130If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3131main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3132of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3133arguments, for example:
3134.code
3135exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3136.endd
3137.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3138.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3139.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3140However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3141configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3142users, the output is as in this example:
3143.code
3144mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3145.endd
3146If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3147output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3148
3149If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3150configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3151backward compatibility.)
3152If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3153is the name of the file that was actually used.
3154
3155.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3156If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3157name will not be output.
3158
3159.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3160.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3161If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3162directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3163respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3164sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3165written directly into the spool directory.
3166
3167If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3168.code
3169exim -bP +local_domains
3170.endd
3171it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3172local part) and outputs what it finds.
3173
3174.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3175.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3176.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3177If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3178followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3179that driver are output. For example:
3180.code
3181exim -bP transport local_delivery
3182.endd
3183The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3184options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3185using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3186&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3187settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3188&%authenticators%&.
3189
3190.cindex "environment"
3191If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3192variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3193variables.
3194
3195.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3196If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3197are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3198for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3199The output format is one item per line.
3200For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3201the exit status will be nonzero.
3202
3203.vitem &%-bp%&
3204.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3205.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3206.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3207This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3208standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3209just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3210admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3211to allow any user to see the queue.
3212
3213Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3214.code
321525m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3216 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3217 <other addresses>
3218.endd
3219.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3220.cindex "size" "of message"
3221The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3222(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3223identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3224envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3225&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3226the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3227before the sender address.
3228
3229.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3230If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3231&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3232
3233The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3234displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3235been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3236expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3237displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3238complete.
3239
3240
3241.vitem &%-bpa%&
3242.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3243This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3244that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3245alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3246of just &"D"&.
3247
3248
3249.vitem &%-bpc%&
3250.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3251.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3252This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3253to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3254&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3255
3256
3257.vitem &%-bpr%&
3258.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3259This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3260chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3261lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3262going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3263
3264.vitem &%-bpra%&
3265.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3266This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3267
3268.vitem &%-bpru%&
3269.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3270This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3271
3272
3273.vitem &%-bpu%&
3274.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3275This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3276addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3277forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3278router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3279
3280
3281.vitem &%-brt%&
3282.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3283.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3284.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3285This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3286arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3287and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3288.code
3289exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3290Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3291.endd
3292See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3293argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3294&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3295contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3296retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3297with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3298rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3299sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3300used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3301.code
3302exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3303Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3304.endd
3305
3306.vitem &%-brw%&
3307.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3308.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3309.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3310This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3311a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3312complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3313would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3314&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3315
3316.vitem &%-bS%&
3317.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3318.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3319.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3320This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3321for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3322submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3323input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3324input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3325&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3326believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3327
3328The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3329dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3330provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3331
3332As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3333messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3334Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3335&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3336
3337Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3338as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3339QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3340
3341.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3342If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3343error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3344was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3345was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3346
3347More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3348&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3349
3350.vitem &%-bs%&
3351.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3352.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3353.cindex "local SMTP input"
3354This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3355on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3356policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3357Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3358messages to the MTA.
3359
3360In
3361.cindex "sender" "source of"
3362this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3363set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3364Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3365the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3366&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3367&%-bnq%& option is used.
3368
3369.cindex "inetd"
3370The
3371&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3372using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3373whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3374&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3375above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3376Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3377the listening daemon.
3378
3379.vitem &%-bt%&
3380.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3381.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3382.cindex "address" "testing"
3383This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3384as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3385written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3386user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3387sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3388
3389If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3390right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3391
3392Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3393&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3394security issues.
3395
3396Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3397(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3398written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3399&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3400genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3401program.
3402
3403.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3404The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3405failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3406code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3407
3408.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3409&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3410addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3411This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3412always shown.
3413
3414&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3415routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3416message,
3417.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3418you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3419&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3420default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3421whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3422those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3423doing such tests.
3424
3425.vitem &%-bV%&
3426.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3427.cindex "version number of Exim"
3428This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3429number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3430It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3431specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3432name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3433
3434As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3435configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3436values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3437detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3438alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3439realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3440dynamic testing facilities.
3441
3442.vitem &%-bv%&
3443.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3444.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3445.cindex "address" "verification"
3446This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3447taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3448not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3449happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3450(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3451including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3452
3453If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3454failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3455usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3456
3457If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3458right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3459
3460Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3461&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3462security issues.
3463
3464Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3465that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3466router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3467verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3468address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3469
3470If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3471address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3472latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3473causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3474addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3475and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3476to succeed.
3477
3478When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3479and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3480considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3481
3482The
3483.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3484return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3485failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3486code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3487
3488If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3489address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3490sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3491calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3492
3493.vitem &%-bvs%&
3494.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3495This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3496than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3497might happen.
3498
3499.vitem &%-bw%&
3500.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3501.cindex "daemon"
3502.cindex "inetd"
3503.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3504This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3505similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3506and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3507
3508In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3509listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3510inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3511each port only when the first connection is received.
3512
3513If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3514which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3515
3516.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3517.oindex "&%-C%&"
3518.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3519.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3520.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3521This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3522list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3523compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3524but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3525file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3526proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3527
3528When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3529from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3530runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3531However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3532file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3533which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3534listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3535CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3536not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3537
3538Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3539configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3540even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3541running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3542delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3543test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3544in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3545
3546If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3547prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3548must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3549However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3550CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3551usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3552unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3553
3554ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3555to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3556broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3557configuration file.
3558
3559The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3560syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3561caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3562require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3563specified by this option.
3564
3565
3566.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3567.oindex "&%-D%&"
3568.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3569This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3570(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3571unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3572If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3573completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3574
3575If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3576colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3577supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3578not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3579the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3580to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3581regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3582
3583The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3584command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3585string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3586synonymous:
3587.code
3588exim -DABC ...
3589exim -DABC= ...
3590.endd
3591To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3592quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3593example:
3594.code
3595exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3596.endd
3597&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3598Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3599
3600
3601.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3602.oindex "&%-d%&"
3603.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3604.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3605This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3606error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3607database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3608filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3609writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3610return code.
3611
3612When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3613standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3614some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3615made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3616of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3617debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3618no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3619are:
3620.display
3621&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3622&`auth `& authenticators
3623&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3624&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3625&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3626&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3627&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3628&`filter `& filter handling
3629&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3630&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3631&`ident `& ident lookup
3632&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3633&`lists `& matching things in lists
3634&`load `& system load checks
3635&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3636 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3637&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3638&`memory `& memory handling
3639&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3640&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3641&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3642&`queue_run `& queue runs
3643&`receive `& general message reception logic
3644&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3645&`retry `& retry handling
3646&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3647&`route `& address routing
3648&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3649&`tls `& TLS logic
3650&`transport `& transports
3651&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3652&`verify `& address verification logic
3653&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3654.endd
3655The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3656for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3657tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3658is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3659generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3660turn everything off.
3661
3662.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3663.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3664The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3665with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3666unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3667rather than stderr.
3668
3669The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3670&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3671However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3672daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3673automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3674run in parallel.
3675
3676The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3677of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3678in processing.
3679
3680.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3681.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3682The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3683UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3684When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3685Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3686
3687If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3688any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3689
3690.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3691.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3692This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3693starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3694subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3695behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3696
3697.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3698.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3699This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3700handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3701described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3702
3703.vitem &%-E%&
3704.oindex "&%-E%&"
3705.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3706This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3707failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3708and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3709generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3710could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3711follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3712new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3713
3714.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3715.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3716There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3717called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3718example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3719form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3720
3721.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3722.oindex "&%-F%&"
3723.cindex "sender" "name"
3724.cindex "name" "of sender"
3725This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3726message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3727entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3728their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3729between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3730
3731.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3732.oindex "&%-f%&"
3733.cindex "sender" "address"
3734.cindex "address" "sender"
3735.cindex "trusted users"
3736.cindex "envelope from"
3737.cindex "envelope sender"
3738.cindex "user" "trusted"
3739This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3740message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3741by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3742users to use it.
3743
3744Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3745trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3746options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3747of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3748domain.
3749
3750There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3751can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3752never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3753string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3754examples of shell commands:
3755.code
3756exim -f '<>' user@domain
3757exim -f "" user@domain
3758.endd
3759In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3760with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3761&%-bv%& options.
3762
3763Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3764it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3765refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3766though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3767
3768White
3769.cindex "&""From""& line"
3770space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3771given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3772locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3773&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3774if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3775
3776.vitem &%-G%&
3777.oindex "&%-G%&"
3778.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3779This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3780.code
3781control = suppress_local_fixups
3782.endd
3783for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3784bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3785in future.
3786
3787As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3788this option.
3789
3790.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3791.oindex "&%-h%&"
3792.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3793This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3794Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3795headers.)
3796
3797.vitem &%-i%&
3798.oindex "&%-i%&"
3799.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3800.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3801This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3802line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3803no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3804command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3805
3806.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3807.oindex "&%-L%&"
3808.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3809This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3810file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3811Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3812read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3813effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3814
3815The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3816
3817.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3818.oindex "&%-M%&"
3819.cindex "forcing delivery"
3820.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3821.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3822This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3823any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3824delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3825and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3826
3827Retry
3828.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3829hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3830the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3831to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3832which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3833for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3834
3835The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3836not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3837produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3838use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3839
3840.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3841.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3842.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3843.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3844This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3845message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3846id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3847active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3848can be used only by an admin user.
3849
3850.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3851 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3852.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3853.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3854.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3855.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3856This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3857by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3858an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3859given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3860must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3861
3862.vitem &%-MCA%&
3863.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3864This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3865by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3866connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3867
3868.vitem &%-MCD%&
3869.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3870This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3872remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3873
3874.new
3875.vitem &%-MCd%&
3876.oindex "&%-MCd%&"
3877This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3879to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3880.wen
3881
3882.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3883.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3884This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3885by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3886alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3887
3888.vitem &%-MCK%&
3889.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3890This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3891by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3892remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3893
3894.vitem &%-MCP%&
3895.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3896This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3897by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3898which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3899
3900.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3901.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3902This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3903by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3904started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3905together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3906signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3907messages through the same SMTP connection.
3908
3909.vitem &%-MCS%&
3910.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3911This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3914connection.
3915
3916.vitem &%-MCT%&
3917.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3918This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3919by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3920host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3921
3922.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3923.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3924This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3925by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3926connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3927The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3928
3929.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3930.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3931.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3932.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3933This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3934but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3935that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3936provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3937order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3938However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3939respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3940overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3941If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3942&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3943and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3944
3945.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3946.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3947.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3948.cindex "sender" "changing"
3949This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3950given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3951&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3952be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3953is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3954This option can be used only by an admin user.
3955
3956.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3957.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3958.cindex "freezing messages"
3959.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3960This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3961prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3962either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3963However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3964attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3965user.
3966
3967.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3968.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3969.cindex "giving up on messages"
3970.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3971.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3972This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3973including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3974their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3975is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3976Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3977user.
3978
3979.vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3980.oindex "&%-MG%&"
3981.cindex queue named
3982.cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
3983.cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3984This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3985queue to the given named queue.
3986The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3987string to define the default queue.
3988If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3989a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3990
3991.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3992.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3993.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3994This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3995as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3996message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3997altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3998
3999.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4000.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
4001.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4002.cindex "recipient" "removing"
4003.cindex "removing recipients"
4004This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4005(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4006the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4007addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4008(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4009can be used only by an admin user.
4010
4011.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4012.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4013.cindex "removing messages"
4014.cindex "abandoning mail"
4015.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4016This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4017bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4018the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4019only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4020placed in the queue.
4021
4022. .new
4023. .vitem &%-MS%&
4024. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4025. .cindex REQUIRETLS
4026. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4027. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4028. a bounce message.
4029. .wen
4030
4031.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4032.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4033.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4034.cindex "expansion" "testing"
4035This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4036string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4037the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4038&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4039available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4040make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4041user. See also &%-bem%&.
4042
4043.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4044.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4045.cindex "thawing messages"
4046.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4047.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4048.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4049This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4050&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4051messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4052by an admin user.
4053
4054.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4055.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4056.cindex "listing" "message body"
4057.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4058This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4059written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4060
4061.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4062.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4063.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4064.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4065This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4066be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4067only by an admin user.
4068
4069.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4070.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4071.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4072.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4073.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4074This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4075written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4076
4077.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4078.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4079.cindex "listing" "message log"
4080.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4081This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4082the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4083
4084.vitem &%-m%&
4085.oindex "&%-m%&"
4086This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4087treats it that way too.
4088
4089.vitem &%-N%&
4090.oindex "&%-N%&"
4091.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4092.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4093This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4094level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4095it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4096had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4097database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4098than &"=>"&.
4099
4100Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4101user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4102words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4103which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4104address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4105routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4106the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4107for that message.
4108
4109.vitem &%-n%&
4110.oindex "&%-n%&"
4111This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4112For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4113When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4114option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4115
4116.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4117.oindex "&%-O%&"
4118This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4119Exim.
4120
4121.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4122.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4123.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4124This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4125alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4126description above.
4127
4128.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4129.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4130.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4131.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4132.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4133This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4134be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4135transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4136
4137.vitem &%-odb%&
4138.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4139.cindex "background delivery"
4140.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4141This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4142including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4143messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4144delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4145processes to finish.
4146
4147When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4148leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4149and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4150This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4151
4152If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4153(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4154overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4155setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4156
4157.vitem &%-odf%&
4158.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4159.cindex "foreground delivery"
4160.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4161This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4162accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4163&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4164and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4165
4166The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4167process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4168during deliveries.
4169
4170However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4171false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4172
4173If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4174message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4175process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4176restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4177
4178
4179.vitem &%-odi%&
4180.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4181This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4182Sendmail.
4183
4184.vitem &%-odq%&
4185.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4186.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4187.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4188.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4189This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4190including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4191not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4192are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4193process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4194&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4195conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4196forces queueing.
4197
4198.vitem &%-odqs%&
4199.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4200.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4201.cindex "first pass routing"
4202This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4203However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4204&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4205configuration file is in effect.
4206
4207When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4208message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4209also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4210in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4211done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4212runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4213messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4214host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4215configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4216&%-qq%& option.
4217
4218.vitem &%-oee%&
4219.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4220.cindex "error" "reporting"
4221If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4222example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4223message.
4224
4225.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4226Provided
4227this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4228exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4229is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4230This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4231
4232.vitem &%-oem%&
4233.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4234.cindex "error" "reporting"
4235.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4236This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4237return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4238This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4239
4240.vitem &%-oep%&
4241.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4242.cindex "error" "reporting"
4243If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4244error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4245.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4246The return code is 1 for all errors.
4247
4248.vitem &%-oeq%&
4249.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4250.cindex "error" "reporting"
4251This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4252effect as &%-oep%&.
4253
4254.vitem &%-oew%&
4255.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4256.cindex "error" "reporting"
4257This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4258effect as &%-oem%&.
4259
4260.vitem &%-oi%&
4261.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4262.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4263This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4264line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4265single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4266lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4267&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4268
4269.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4270.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4271This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4272
4273.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4274.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4275.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4276A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4277with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4278over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4279&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4280other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4281
4282The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4283number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4284.code
4285exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4286.endd
4287An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4288followed by a colon and the port number:
4289.code
4290exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4291.endd
4292The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4293port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4294are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4295whichever one is last.
4296
4297.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4298.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4299.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4300See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4301option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4302name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4303This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4304authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4305
4306.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4307.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4308.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4309See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4310option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4311This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4312where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4313&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4314
4315.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4316.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4317.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4318See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4319option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4320overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4321messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4322default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4323specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4324&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4325
4326.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4327.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4328.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4329See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4330option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4331using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4332&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4333
4334.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4335.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4336.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4337See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4338option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4339delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4340messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4341abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4342running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4343
4344The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4345The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4346is sending the bounce.
4347
4348.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4349.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4350.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4351.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4352See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4353option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4354&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4355or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4356SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4357&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4358one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4359be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4360
4361.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4362.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4363.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4364See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4365option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4366present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4367uses the name it is given.
4368
4369.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4370.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4371.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4372See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4373option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4374local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4375used, when there is no default.
4376
4377.vitem &%-om%&
4378.oindex "&%-om%&"
4379.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4380In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4381message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4382expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4383
4384.vitem &%-oo%&
4385.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4386.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4387This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4388whatever that means.
4389
4390.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4391.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4392.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4393.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4394This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4395value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4396written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4397without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4398because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4399
4400.new
4401.vitem &%-oPX%&
4402.oindex "&%-oPX%&"
4403.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4404.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4405This option is not intended for general use.
4406The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4407combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4408It causes the pid file to be removed.
4409.wen
4410
4411.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4412.oindex "&%-or%&"
4413.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4414This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4415set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4416by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4417described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4418
4419.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4420.oindex "&%-os%&"
4421.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4422.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4423This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4424applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4425the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4426for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4427
4428.vitem &%-ov%&
4429.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4430This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4431
4432.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4433.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4434.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4435.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4436.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4437This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4438is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4439of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4440in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4441file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4442
4443.vitem &%-pd%&
4444.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4445.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4446This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4447chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4448option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4449needed.
4450
4451.vitem &%-ps%&
4452.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4453.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4454This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4455chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4456option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4457started.
4458
4459.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4460.oindex "&%-p%&"
4461For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4462.display
4463&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4464.endd
4465It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4466host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4467Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4468to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4469or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4470Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4471
4472.vitem &%-q%&
4473.oindex "&%-q%&"
4474.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4475This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4476configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4477relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4478and &%-S%& options).
4479
4480.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4481If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4482the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4483waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4484for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4485process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4486have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4487
4488If
4489.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4490.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4491.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4492the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4493passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4494proceeding.
4495
4496When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4497process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4498mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4499this to be repeated periodically.
4500
4501Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4502random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4503If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4504MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4505
4506It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4507order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4508&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4509
4510.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4511The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4512behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4513appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4514
4515.vitem &%-qq...%&
4516.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4517.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4518.cindex "queue" "routing"
4519.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4520.cindex "first pass routing"
4521An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4522stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4523every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4524transports are run.
4525
4526.new
4527Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4528.wen
4529
4530.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4531The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4532is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4533complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4534place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4535delivered down a single SMTP
4536.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4537.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4538.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4539connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4540This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4541intermittently.
4542
4543.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4544.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4545.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4546If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4547those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4548delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4549&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4550
4551.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4552.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4553.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4554.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4555If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4556message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4557their retry times are tried.
4558
4559.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4560.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4561.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4562If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4563frozen or not.
4564
4565.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4566.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4567.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4568The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4569be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4570for later delivery.
4571
4572.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4573.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4574.cindex queue named
4575.cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4576.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4577If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4578queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4579The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4580For a periodic queue run (see below)
4581append to the name a slash and a time value.
4582
4583If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4584will specify a queue to operate on.
4585For example:
4586.code
4587exim -bp -qGquarantine
4588mailq -qGquarantine
4589exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4590.endd
4591
4592.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4593When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4594lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4595starting message id. For example:
4596.code
4597exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4598.endd
4599Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4600second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4601are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4602.code
4603exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4604.endd
4605just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4606&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4607that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4608mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4609are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4610queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4611
4612.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4613.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4614.cindex "periodic queue running"
4615When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4616starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4617(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4618&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4619single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4620combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4621.code
4622/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4623.endd
4624Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4625process every 30 minutes.
4626
4627When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4628pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4629
4630.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4631.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4632This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4633compatibility.
4634
4635.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4636.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4637This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4638
4639.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4640.oindex "&%-R%&"
4641.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4642.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4643.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4644The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4645is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4646which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4647<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4648
4649This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4650perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4651queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4652address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4653way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4654regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4655
4656If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4657you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4658.code
4659exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4660.endd
4661This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4662every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4663applied to each queue run.
4664
4665Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4666are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4667information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4668means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4669existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4670address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4671will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4672information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4673address will be skipped.
4674
4675.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4676If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4677all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4678&'ff'& is present.
4679
4680The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4681to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4682command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4683effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4684an arbitrary command instead.
4685
4686.vitem &%-r%&
4687.oindex "&%-r%&"
4688This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4689
4690.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4691.oindex "&%-S%&"
4692.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4693.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4694This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4695message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4696conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4697has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4698
4699.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4700.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4701This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4702recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4703&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4704
4705.vitem &%-t%&
4706.oindex "&%-t%&"
4707.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4708.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4709.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4710.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4711When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4712input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4713from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4714from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4715takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4716
4717.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4718If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4719is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4720the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4721and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4722Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4723Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4724argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4725Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4726instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4727&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4728
4729.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4730If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4731recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4732lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4733with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4734&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4735
4736RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4737message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4738added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4739not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4740nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4741In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4742are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4743once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4744&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4745
4746.vitem &%-ti%&
4747.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4748This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4749compatibility with Sendmail.
4750
4751.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4752.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4753.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4754.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4755This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4756incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4757&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4758&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4759
4760
4761.vitem &%-U%&
4762.oindex "&%-U%&"
4763.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4764Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4765documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4766syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4767set. Exim ignores this option.
4768
4769.vitem &%-v%&
4770.oindex "&%-v%&"
4771This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4772describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4773receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4774dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4775the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4776selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4777unconditional.
4778
4779.vitem &%-x%&
4780.oindex "&%-x%&"
4781AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4782National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4783It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4784this option.
4785
4786.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4787.oindex "&%-X%&"
4788This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4789to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4790
4791.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4792.oindex "&%-z%&"
4793This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4794Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4795Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4796under most shells.
4797.endlist
4798
4799.ecindex IIDclo1
4800.ecindex IIDclo2
4801
4802
4803. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4804. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4805. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4806. creates a man page for the options.
4807. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4808
4809.literal xml
4810<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4811.literal off
4812
4813
4814
4815
4816
4817. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4818. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4819
4820
4821.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4822 "The runtime configuration file"
4823
4824.cindex "runtime configuration"
4825.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4826.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4827.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4828.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4829.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4830Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4831binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4832because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4833control.
4834
4835If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4836writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4837The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4838errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4839not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4840actually alter the string.
4841
4842The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4843reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4844most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4845give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4846existing file in the list.
4847
4848.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4849.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4850.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4851.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4852.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4853.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4854The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4855specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4856configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4857group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4858CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4859
4860&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4861to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4862easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4863CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4864who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4865
4866Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4867be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4868since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4869compromise the Exim user account.
4870
4871A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4872is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4873defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4874configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4875CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4876&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4877configuration.
4878
4879
4880
4881.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4882.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4883A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4884option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4885&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4886unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4887CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4888is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4889is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4890installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4891specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4892
4893Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4894with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4895listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4896testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4897delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4898Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4899the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4900can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4901message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4902&%-M%&).
4903
4904If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4905prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4906start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4907There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4908filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4909
4910One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4911option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4912configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4913non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4914If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4915completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4916
4917The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4918to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4919necessarily be discarded.
4920WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4921considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4922values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4923is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4924transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4925values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4926
4927Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4928share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4929If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4930looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4931and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4932file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4933each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4934
4935In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4936different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4937help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4938
4939
4940
4941.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4942.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4943.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4944Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4945option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4946are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4947is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4948space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4949
4950.ilist
4951&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4952&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4953.next
4954.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4955&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4956are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4957.next
4958&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4959addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4960&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4961.next
4962&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4963define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4964&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4965.next
4966&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4967If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4968defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4969are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4970&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4971.next
4972&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4973when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4974chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4975.next
4976&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4977want to use this feature, you must set
4978.code
4979LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4980.endd
4981in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4982facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4983.endlist
4984
4985.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4986.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4987.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4988Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4989
4990Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4991leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4992# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4993and does not introduce a comment.
4994
4995Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4996the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4997backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4998lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4999appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5000
5001A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5002default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5003change settings as required.
5004
5005The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5006described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5007respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5008items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5009onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5010described.
5011
5012
5013
5014.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5015.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5016.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5017.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5018.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5019You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5020using this syntax:
5021.display
5022&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5023&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5024.endd
5025on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5026the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5027second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5028The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5029the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5030is required.
5031
5032Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5033configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5034If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5035because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5036
5037The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5038comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5039for example:
5040.code
5041hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5042 .include /some/file
5043.endd
5044Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5045process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5046inclusion appears.
5047
5048
5049
5050.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5051.cindex "macro" "description of"
5052.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5053If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5054&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5055definition, and must be of the form
5056.display
5057<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5058.endd
5059The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5060in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5061continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5062space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5063a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5064
5065Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5066definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5067ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5068
5069.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5070Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5071files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5072scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5073replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5074for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5075the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5076define
5077.display
5078&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5079&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5080.endd
5081but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5082error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5083before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5084consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5085line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5086comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5087
5088
5089.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5090Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5091(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5092&'='&. For example:
5093.code
5094MAC = initial value
5095...
5096MAC == updated value
5097.endd
5098Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5099subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5100the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5101Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5102.code
5103MAC = initial value
5104...
5105MAC == MAC and something added
5106.endd
5107This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5108from a number of other files.
5109
5110.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5111The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5112&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5113used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5114using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5115file to be ignored.
5116
5117
5118
5119.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5120As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5121up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5122strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5123.code
5124ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5125 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5126.endd
5127This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5128.code
5129data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5130.endd
5131In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5132address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5133section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5134
5135
5136.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5137Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5138differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5139All of these macros start with an underscore.
5140They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5141(see below).
5142
5143The following classes of macros are defined:
5144.display
5145&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5146&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5147&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5148&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5149&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5150&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5151&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5152&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5153&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5154&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5155&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5156&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5157.endd
5158
5159Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5160
5161
5162.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5163.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5164.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5165You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5166&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5167portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5168read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5169
5170The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5171be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5172that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5173line. Thus:
5174.code
5175.ifdef AAA
5176message_size_limit = 50M
5177.else
5178message_size_limit = 100M
5179.endif
5180.endd
5181sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5182(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5183otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5184is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5185obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5186
5187Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5188it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5189in this line"& will always be true.
5190
5191Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5192to clarify complicated nestings.
5193
5194
5195
5196.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5197.cindex "common option syntax"
5198.cindex "syntax of common options"
5199.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5200For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5201each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5202lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5203these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5204space) and then the value. For example:
5205.code
5206qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5207.endd
5208.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5209.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5210.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5211Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5212accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5213line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5214word &"hide"&. For example:
5215.code
5216hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5217.endd
5218For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5219.code
5220mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5221.endd
5222If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5223all instances of the same driver.
5224
5225The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5226that are found in option settings.
5227
5228
5229.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5230.cindex "format" "boolean"
5231.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5232.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5233.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5234Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5235different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5236the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5237if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5238boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5239&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5240the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5241.code
5242queue_only
5243queue_only = true
5244.endd
5245The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5246.code
5247no_queue_only
5248queue_only = false
5249.endd
5250You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5251
5252
5253
5254
5255.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5256.cindex "integer configuration values"
5257.cindex "format" "integer"
5258If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5259hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5260number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5261with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5262hexadecimal number.
5263
5264If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5265it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5266if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5267When the values
5268of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52691024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5270and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5271used.
5272
5273
5274.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5275.cindex "integer format"
5276.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5277If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5278interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5279Such options are always output in octal.
5280
5281
5282.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5283.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5284.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5285If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5286integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5287
5288
5289
5290.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5291.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5292.cindex "format" "time interval"
5293A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5294the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5295
5296.table2 30pt
5297.irow &%s%& seconds
5298.irow &%m%& minutes
5299.irow &%h%& hours
5300.irow &%d%& days
5301.irow &%w%& weeks
5302.endtable
5303
5304For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5305intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5306is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5307
5308
5309
5310.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5311.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5312.cindex "format" "string"
5313If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5314or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5315consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5316the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5317removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5318Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5319appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5320therefore equivalent:
5321.code
5322trusted_users = uucp:mail
5323trusted_users = uucp:\
5324 # This comment line is ignored
5325 mail
5326.endd
5327.cindex "string" "quoted"
5328.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5329If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5330double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5331continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5332
5333.table2 100pt
5334.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5335.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5336.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5337.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5338.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5339.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5340 character"
5341.endtable
5342
5343If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5344character, that character replaces the pair.
5345
5346Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5347insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5348trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5349current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5350in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5351and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5352
5353
5354.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5355.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5356Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5357by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5358circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5359is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5360strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5361However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5362backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5363within a quoted configuration string.
5364
5365
5366.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5367.cindex "user name" "format of"
5368.cindex "format" "user name"
5369.cindex "groups" "name format"
5370.cindex "format" "group name"
5371User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5372above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5373either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5374&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5375
5376
5377.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5378.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5379.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5380.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5381The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5382default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5383the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5384&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5385are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5386particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5387&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5388
5389In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5390input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5391&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5392in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5393on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5394start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5395example, the list
5396.code
5397local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5398.endd
5399contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5400
5401&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5402list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5403colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5404be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5405
5406.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5407.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5408.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5409Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5410introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5411with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5412character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5413above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5414.code
5415local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5416.endd
5417This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5418&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5419confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5420
5421.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5422.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5423It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5424code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5425must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5426are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5427sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5428interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5429generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5430.code
5431domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5432.endd
5433This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5434to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5435expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5436the value in quotes. For example:
5437.code
5438local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5439.endd
5440Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5441doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5442set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5443enclosing an empty list item.
5444
5445
5446
5447.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5448.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5449An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5450separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5451.code
5452senders = user@domain :
5453.endd
5454contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5455in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5456items, the second of which is empty:
5457.code
5458senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5459.endd
5460&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5461are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5462would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5463just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5464.code
5465senders = :
5466.endd
5467In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5468is at the end of the list.
5469
5470
5471
5472
5473.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5474.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5475There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5476and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5477instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5478a sequence of lines like this:
5479.display
5480<&'instance name'&>:
5481 <&'option'&>
5482 ...
5483 <&'option'&>
5484.endd
5485In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5486followed by three options settings:
5487.code
5488localuser:
5489 driver = accept
5490 check_local_user
5491 transport = local_delivery
5492.endd
5493For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5494setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5495settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5496deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5497a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5498described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5499
5500You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5501the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5502
5503The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5504passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5505transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5506authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5507them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5508server.
5509
5510.cindex "generic options"
5511.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5512Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5513and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5514same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5515&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5516.cindex "private options"
5517The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5518they all have default values.
5519
5520The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5521precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5522this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5523
5524Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5525elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5526with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5527a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5528instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5529confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5530configuration lines:
5531.code
5532remote_smtp:
5533 driver = smtp
5534.endd
5535create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5536&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5537different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5538instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5539thus:
5540.code
5541special_smtp:
5542 driver = smtp
5543 port = 1234
5544 command_timeout = 10s
5545.endd
5546The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5547these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5548lines.
5549
5550Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5551list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5552defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5553option.
5554
5555
5556
5557
5558
5559
5560. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5561. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5562
5563.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5564.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5565.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5566The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5567is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5568the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5569configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5570of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5571itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5572initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5573mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5574
5575
5576
5577.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5578All macros should be defined before any options.
5579
5580One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5581.code
5582# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5583.endd
5584If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5585hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5586later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5587deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5588
5589In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5590to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5591given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5592
5593
5594.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5595The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5596in the file, after the macros.
5597The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5598.code
5599# primary_hostname =
5600.endd
5601This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5602to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5603can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5604it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5605
5606The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5607.code
5608domainlist local_domains = @
5609domainlist relay_to_domains =
5610hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5611.endd
5612These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5613domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5614domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5615configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5616
5617The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5618later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5619on the local host.
5620
5621.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5622There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5623of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5624called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5625be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5626the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5627
5628The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5629list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5630controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5631domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5632domain is permitted.
5633
5634The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5635used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5636that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5637loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5638submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5639hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5640
5641Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5642we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5643and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5644
5645The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5646.code
5647acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5648acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5649.endd
5650These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5651during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5652command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5653respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5654&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5655section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5656accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5657to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5658contents of a message to be checked.
5659
5660Two commented-out option settings are next:
5661.code
5662# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5663# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5664.endd
5665These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5666content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5667scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5668details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5669
5670Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5671.code
5672# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5673# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5674# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5675.endd
5676These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5677support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5678first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5679connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5680other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5681key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5682More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5683
5684Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5685.code
5686# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5687# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5688.endd
5689.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5690.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5691.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5692.cindex "submissions protocol"
5693.cindex "smtps protocol"
5694.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5695.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5696.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5697.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5698These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5699server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5700TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5701more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5702Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5703to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5704much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5705consequences).
5706RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5707which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5708RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5709which should be used in preference to 587.
5710You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5711these ports.
5712Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5713
5714Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5715.code
5716# qualify_domain =
5717# qualify_recipient =
5718.endd
5719The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5720complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5721receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5722the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5723you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5724addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5725
5726.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5727The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5728addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5729(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5730.code
5731# allow_domain_literals
5732.endd
5733The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5734Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5735quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5736try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5737people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5738&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5739
5740The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5741.code
5742never_users = root
5743.endd
5744It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5745convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5746setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5747The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5748list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5749FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5750contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5751FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5752
5753When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5754Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5755line,
5756.code
5757host_lookup = *
5758.endd
5759specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5760in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5761information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5762or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5763Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5764because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5765unreachable.
5766
5767The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57681413 (hence their names):
5769.code
5770rfc1413_hosts = *
5771rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5772.endd
5773These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5774Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5775terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5776of an incoming SMTP connection.
5777If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5778information, you can change this.
5779
5780This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5781and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5782.code
5783prdr_enable = true
5784.endd
5785
5786When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5787be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5788if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5789find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5790.code
5791# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5792# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5793.endd
5794show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5795and recipient addresses, respectively.
5796
5797The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5798over the default:
5799.code
5800log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5801 +tls_certificate_verified
5802.endd
5803
5804The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5805.code
5806# percent_hack_domains =
5807.endd
5808It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5809This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5810anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5811
5812The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5813concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5814message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5815occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5816address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5817bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5818are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5819always bounce messages.
5820.code
5821ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5822timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5823.endd
5824The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5825discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5826message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5827after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5828bounce message ever lasts a week.
5829
5830Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5831large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5832directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5833many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5834Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5835not often needed).
5836.code
5837# split_spool_directory = true
5838.endd
5839
5840In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5841messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5842characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5843violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5844In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5845problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5846check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5847.code
5848# check_rfc2047_length = false
5849.endd
5850
5851If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
58528BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5853that are not 8-bit clean.
5854.code
5855# accept_8bitmime = false
5856.endd
5857
5858Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5859imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5860&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5861&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5862Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5863option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5864.code
5865# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5866# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5867.endd
5868
5869
5870.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5871.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5872.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5873In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5874It starts with the line
5875.code
5876begin acl
5877.endd
5878and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5879&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5880and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5881
5882.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5883The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5884RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5885are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5886rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5887result of the ACL processing.
5888.code
5889acl_check_rcpt:
5890.endd
5891This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5892ACL, and names it.
5893.code
5894accept hosts = :
5895.endd
5896This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5897But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5898names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5899list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5900host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5901important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5902
5903What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5904messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5905input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5906manner.
5907.code
5908deny message = Restricted characters in address
5909 domains = +local_domains
5910 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5911
5912deny message = Restricted characters in address
5913 domains = !+local_domains
5914 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5915.endd
5916These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5917characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5918Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5919&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5920in Internet mail addresses.
5921
5922The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5923addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5924option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5925in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5926programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5927at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5928characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5929policy of being as safe as possible.
5930
5931The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5932to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5933first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5934&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5935reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5936&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5937
5938The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5939block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5940or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5941have to modify this rule.
5942
5943Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5944allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5945common convention of local parts constructed as
5946&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5947the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5948with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5949filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5950that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5951is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5952
5953The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5954allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5955and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5956with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5957local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5958and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5959(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5960.code
5961accept local_parts = postmaster
5962 domains = +local_domains
5963.endd
5964This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5965local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5966&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5967reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5968&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5969
5970The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5971by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5972in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5973.code
5974require verify = sender
5975.endd
5976This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5977ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5978address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5979see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5980addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5981used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5982discusses the details of address verification.
5983.code
5984accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5985 control = submission
5986.endd
5987This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5988hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5989verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5990that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5991second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5992is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5993messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5994&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5995probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5996.code
5997accept authenticated = *
5998 control = submission
5999.endd
6000This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6001Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6002likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6003authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6004examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6005fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6006.code
6007require message = relay not permitted
6008 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6009.endd
6010This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6011one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6012.code
6013require verify = recipient
6014.endd
6015This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6016fails, the address is rejected.
6017.code
6018# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6019# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6020# $dnslist_text
6021# dnslists = black.list.example
6022#
6023# warn dnslists = black.list.example
6024# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6025# a black list at $dnslist_domain
6026# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6027.endd
6028These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6029sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6030from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6031line.
6032.code
6033# require verify = csa
6034.endd
6035This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6036authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6037records.
6038.code
6039accept
6040.endd
6041The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6042address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6043.code
6044acl_check_data:
6045.endd
6046This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6047of this ACL are commented out:
6048.code
6049# deny malware = *
6050# message = This message contains a virus \
6051# ($malware_name).
6052.endd
6053These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6054viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6055suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6056virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6057.code
6058# warn spam = nobody
6059# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6060# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6061# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6062# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6063.endd
6064These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6065SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6066and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6067&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6068series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6069whatever the spam score.
6070.code
6071accept
6072.endd
6073This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6074
6075
6076.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6077.cindex "default" "routers"
6078.cindex "routers" "default"
6079The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6080by the line
6081.code
6082begin routers
6083.endd
6084Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6085messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6086accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6087matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6088manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6089.code
6090# domain_literal:
6091# driver = ipliteral
6092# domains = !+local_domains
6093# transport = remote_smtp
6094.endd
6095.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6096This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6097support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6098you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6099&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6100
6101Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6102macro has been defined, per
6103.code
6104.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6105smarthost:
6106#...
6107.else
6108dnslookup:
6109#...
6110.endif
6111.endd
6112
6113If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6114command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6115perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6116skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6117
6118.code
6119smarthost:
6120 driver = manualroute
6121 domains = ! +local_domains
6122 transport = smarthost_smtp
6123 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6124 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6125 no_more
6126.endd
6127This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6128specified by the line
6129.code
6130domains = ! +local_domains
6131.endd
6132The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6133exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6134that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6135the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6136indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6137passed on to the following routers.
6138
6139The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6140specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6141While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6142be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6143
6144With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6145will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6146other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6147&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6148are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6149and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6150&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6151
6152.code
6153dnslookup:
6154 driver = dnslookup
6155 domains = ! +local_domains
6156 transport = remote_smtp
6157 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6158 no_more
6159.endd
6160The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6161
6162The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6163and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6164the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6165instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6166one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6167
6168The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6169DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6170router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6171specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6172in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6173the address fails and is bounced.
6174
6175The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6176be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6177encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6178whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6179Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6180email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6181continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6182out.
6183.code
6184system_aliases:
6185 driver = redirect
6186 allow_fail
6187 allow_defer
6188 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6189# user = exim
6190 file_transport = address_file
6191 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6192.endd
6193Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6194domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6195alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6196data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6197the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6198the next router.
6199
6200&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6201often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6202file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6203&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6204.code
6205userforward:
6206 driver = redirect
6207 check_local_user
6208# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6209# local_part_suffix_optional
6210 file = $home/.forward
6211# allow_filter
6212 no_verify
6213 no_expn
6214 check_ancestor
6215 file_transport = address_file
6216 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6217 reply_transport = address_reply
6218.endd
6219This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6220redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6221individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6222local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6223router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6224namely:
6225.code
6226# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6227# local_part_suffix_optional
6228.endd
6229.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6230show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6231is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6232by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6233variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6234presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6235the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6236
6237When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6238home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6239declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6240redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6241
6242.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6243Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6244files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6245is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6246of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6247filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6248separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6249
6250The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6251verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6252There are two reasons for doing this:
6253
6254.olist
6255Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6256checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6257unnecessary work.
6258.next
6259More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6260command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6261The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6262It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6263this time.
6264.endlist
6265
6266The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6267address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6268works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6269forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6270
6271The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6272forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6273auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6274.code
6275a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6276.endd
6277the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6278transport.
6279.code
6280localuser:
6281 driver = accept
6282 check_local_user
6283# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6284# local_part_suffix_optional
6285 transport = local_delivery
6286.endd
6287The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6288part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6289the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6290routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6291same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6292
6293
6294.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6295.cindex "default" "transports"
6296.cindex "transports" "default"
6297Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6298only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6299not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6300.code
6301begin transports
6302.endd
6303Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6304.code
6305remote_smtp:
6306 driver = smtp
6307 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6308.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6309 hosts_try_prdr = *
6310.endif
6311.endd
6312This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6313The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6314The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6315with over-long lines.
6316
6317The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6318negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6319but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6320use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6321
6322The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6323with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6324usual federated system.
6325
6326.code
6327smarthost_smtp:
6328 driver = smtp
6329 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6330 multi_domain
6331 #
6332.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6333 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6334 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6335 hosts_require_tls = *
6336 tls_verify_hosts = *
6337 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6338 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6339 # or not:
6340 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6341 #
6342 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6343 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6344 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6345 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6346 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6347 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6348 #
6349.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6350 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6351.endif
6352.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6353 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6354.endif
6355.endif
6356.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6357 hosts_try_prdr = *
6358.endif
6359.endd
6360After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6361can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6362that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6363happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6364All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6365then no other options are defined.
6366If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6367and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6368used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6369Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6370from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6371mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6372the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6373to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6374ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6375You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6376should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6377
6378For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6379
6380All other options are defaulted.
6381.code
6382local_delivery:
6383 driver = appendfile
6384 file = /var/mail/$local_part_verified
6385 delivery_date_add
6386 envelope_to_add
6387 return_path_add
6388# group = mail
6389# mode = 0660
6390.endd
6391This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6392traditional BSD mailbox format.
6393
6394.new
6395We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6396as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6397Instead we use &$local_part_verified$&,
6398the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6399(done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6400.wen
6401
6402By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6403local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6404directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6405under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6406show how this can be done.
6407
6408Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6409&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6410similarly-named options above.
6411.code
6412address_pipe:
6413 driver = pipe
6414 return_output
6415.endd
6416This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6417redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6418option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6419be returned to the sender.
6420.code
6421address_file:
6422 driver = appendfile
6423 delivery_date_add
6424 envelope_to_add
6425 return_path_add
6426.endd
6427This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6428redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6429&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6430.code
6431address_reply:
6432 driver = autoreply
6433.endd
6434This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6435filter files.
6436
6437
6438
6439.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6440.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6441.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6442The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6443Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6444introduced by the line
6445.code
6446begin retry
6447.endd
6448In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6449errors:
6450.code
6451* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6452.endd
6453This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
64542 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
64551.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6456is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6457measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6458
6459If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6460if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6461temporary errors into permanent errors.
6462
6463
6464.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6465The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6466.code
6467begin rewrite
6468.endd
6469contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6470rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6471
6472
6473
6474.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6475.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6476The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6477.code
6478begin authenticators
6479.endd
6480defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6481configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6482which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6483standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6484mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6485to support most MUA software.
6486
6487The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6488.code
6489#PLAIN:
6490# driver = plaintext
6491# server_set_id = $auth2
6492# server_prompts = :
6493# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6494# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6495.endd
6496And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6497.code
6498#LOGIN:
6499# driver = plaintext
6500# server_set_id = $auth1
6501# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6502# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6503# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6504.endd
6505
6506The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6507in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6508&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6509that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6510i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6511when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6512when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6513need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6514
6515The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6516password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6517To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6518expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6519
6520Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6521usercode and password are in different positions.
6522Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6523
6524.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6525
6526
6527
6528. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6529. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6530
6531.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6532
6533.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6534.cindex "PCRE"
6535Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6536uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6537matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6538regular expressions is discussed in
6539online Perl manpages, in
6540many Perl reference books, and also in
6541Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6542O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6543. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6544. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6545. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6546
6547The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6548are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6549description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6550the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6551the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6552case-insensitive.
6553
6554In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6555it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6556or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6557second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6558.code
6559domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6560.endd
6561The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6562precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6563of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6564regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6565backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6566normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6567matched.
6568
6569There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6570recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6571string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6572these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6573it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6574match anywhere in the subject string.
6575
6576In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6577you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6578.code
6579domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6580.endd
6581matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6582You need to use:
6583.code
6584domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6585.endd
6586if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6587$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6588
6589
6590
6591. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6592. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6593
6594.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6595.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6596.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6597.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6598Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6599messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6600
6601.olist
6602A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6603cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6604lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6605can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6606&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6607The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6608.next
6609Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6610way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6611returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6612succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6613chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6614The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6615.endlist
6616
6617String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6618that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6619involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6620if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6621time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6622chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6623
6624.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6625It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6626lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6627processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6628Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6629.code
6630domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6631domains = lsearch;/some/file
6632.endd
6633The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6634No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6635defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6636The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6637file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6638.code
6639192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6640192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6641.endd
6642When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6643possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6644
6645In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6646Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6647in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6648.code
6649domain1:
6650domain2:
6651.endd
6652Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6653matches the list item.
6654
6655It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6656Consider a file containing lines like this:
6657.code
6658192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6659.endd
6660If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6661first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6662causes a second lookup to occur.
6663
6664The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6665available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6666lookup is permitted.
6667
6668
6669.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6670.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6671.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6672Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6673
6674.ilist
6675The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6676and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6677lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6678.new
6679.cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6680The file string may not be tainted
6681.wen
6682.next
6683.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6684The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6685key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6686Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6687.endlist
6688
6689The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6690the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6691default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6692.code
6693LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6694LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6695.endd
6696which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6697For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6698libraries and header files before building Exim.
6699
6700
6701
6702
6703.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6704.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6705.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6706The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6707
6708.ilist
6709.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6710.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6711.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6712&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6713string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6714indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6715re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6716aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6717tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6718.display
6719&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6720&url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6721&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6722&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6723.endd
6724A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6725because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6726However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6727you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6728.next
6729.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6730.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6731.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6732&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6733DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6734zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6735&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6736
6737.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6738For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6739when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6740using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6741the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6742that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6743other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6744.next
6745.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6746.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6747.cindex "sasldb2"
6748.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6749&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6750interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6751ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6752authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6753&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6754&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6755.next
6756.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6757.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6758.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6759.cindex "Courier"
6760.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6761.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6762&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6763is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6764if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6765other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6766use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6767calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6768utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6769by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6770.next
6771.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6772.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6773&(dsearch)&: The given file must be an
6774.new
6775absolute
6776.wen
6777directory path; this is searched for an entry
6778whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6779The key may not
6780contain any forward slash characters.
6781If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6782.new
6783.cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6784The result is regarded as untainted.
6785
6786Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6787separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6788each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6789
6790Two options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6791candidates.
6792The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6793the entire path for the entry. Example:
6794.code
6795${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6796.endd
6797The default result is just the requested entry.
6798The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6799are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6800not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6801.code
6802${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6803.endd
6804The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6805and symlinks.
6806.wen
6807
6808An example of how this
6809lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6810&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6811.next
6812.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6813.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6814&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6815terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6816file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6817IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6818being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6819.code
68201.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6821192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6822"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6823"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6824.endd
6825The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6826file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6827key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6828&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6829&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6830
6831&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6832&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6833lookup types support only literal keys.
6834
6835&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6836the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6837&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6838
6839&*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6840IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6841notation before executing the lookup.)
6842.next
6843.cindex lookup json
6844.cindex json "lookup type"
6845.cindex JSON expansions
6846&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6847An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6848The key is a list of subelement selectors
6849(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6850which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6851of the JSON structure.
6852If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6853nunbered array element is selected.
6854Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6855The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6856or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6857is returned.
6858For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6859.next
6860.cindex "linear search"
6861.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6862.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6863.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6864&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6865line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6866end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6867letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6868in the file is used.
6869
6870White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6871line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6872continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6873space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6874junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6875colon, for example:
6876.code
6877baduser: :fail:
6878.endd
6879Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6880middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6881that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6882wildcarding of any kind.
6883
6884.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6885.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6886In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6887characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6888If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6889matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6890contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6891quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6892quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6893
6894.next
6895.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6896.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6897.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6898&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6899the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6900&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6901reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6902aliases; the full map names must be used.
6903
6904.next
6905.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6906.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6907.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6908.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6909&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6910&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6911the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6912that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6913used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6914
6915.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6916Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6917file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6918&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6919
6920. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6921. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6922
6923.olist
6924The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6925.code
6926 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6927 *fish data for anythingfish
6928.endd
6929.next
6930The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6931example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6932.code
6933 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6934.endd
6935Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6936expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6937string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6938.code
6939 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6940.endd
6941The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6942expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6943For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6944.code
6945 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6946.endd
6947
6948If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6949either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6950ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6951colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6952escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6953
6954&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6955match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6956is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6957takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6958&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6959
6960.next
6961Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6962is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6963lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6964example:
6965.code
6966 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6967.endd
6968The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6969.endlist olist
6970
6971Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6972continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6973be followed by optional colons.
6974
6975&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6976&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6977lookup types support only literal keys.
6978
6979.next
6980.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6981If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6982(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6983For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6984.endlist ilist
6985
6986
6987.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6988.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6989.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6990The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6991many of them are given in later sections.
6992
6993.ilist
6994.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6995.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6996&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6997are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6998records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6999.next
7000.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7001.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7002&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7003.next
7004.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7005.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7006&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7007returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7008that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7009called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7010any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7011.next
7012.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7013.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7014&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7015MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7016.next
7017.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7018.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7019&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7020the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7021.next
7022.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7023.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7024&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7025Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7026.next
7027.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7028.cindex "passwd lookup type"
7029.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7030&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7031lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7032success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7033lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7034password value. For example:
7035.code
7036*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7037.endd
7038.next
7039.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7040.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7041&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7042PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7043
7044.next
7045.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7046.cindex lookup Redis
7047&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7048passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7049
7050.next
7051.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7052.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7053&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is
7054new
7055an optional filename
7056.wen
7057followed by an SQL statement
7058that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7059
7060.next
7061&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7062not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7063.next
7064.cindex "whoson lookup type"
7065.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7066. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
7067&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7068allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7069address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7070obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7071at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7072superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7073&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7074.code
7075require condition = \
7076 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7077.endd
7078The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7079the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7080this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7081one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7082.endlist
7083
7084
7085
7086.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7087.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7088Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7089completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7090reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7091options such as a list of local domains.
7092
7093When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7094of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7095temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7096or may give up altogether.
7097
7098
7099
7100.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7101.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7102.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7103.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7104.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7105.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7106In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7107that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7108
7109&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7110lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7111specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7112
7113If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7114and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7115provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7116
7117.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7118.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7119.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7120Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7121&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7122character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7123by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7124that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7125take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7126For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7127.code
7128data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7129.endd
7130Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7131looks up these keys, in this order:
7132.code
7133jane@eyre.example
7134*@eyre.example
7135*
7136.endd
7137The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7138&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7139complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7140Exim move on to try the next key.
7141
7142
7143
7144.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7145.cindex "partial matching"
7146.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7147.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7148.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7149.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7150The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7151match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7152being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7153information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7154domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7155a key in a DBM file is
7156.code
7157*.dates.fict.example
7158.endd
7159then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7160&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7161by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7162file.
7163
7164&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7165also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7166&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7167
7168Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7169keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7170be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7171partial matching keys
7172beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7173Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7174unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7175
7176Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7177the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7178is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7179is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7180fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7181start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7182remains.
7183
7184A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7185by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7186&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7187modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7188subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7189up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7190.code
71912250.dates.fict.example
7192*.2250.dates.fict.example
7193*.dates.fict.example
7194*.fict.example
7195.endd
7196As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7197finishes.
7198
7199.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7200.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7201The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7202changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7203formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7204parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7205.code
7206domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7207.endd
7208In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7209&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7210components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7211other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7212.code
7213domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7214.endd
7215For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7216&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7217
7218If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7219just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7220down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7221
7222.ilist
7223If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7224.next
7225If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7226example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7227.next
7228Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7229remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7230for &"*"& on its own.
7231.next
7232Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7233.endlist
7234
7235
7236If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7237&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7238this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7239specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7240prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7241lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7242&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7243
7244The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7245in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7246dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7247in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7248subject key is always followed by a dot.
7249
7250
7251
7252
7253.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7254.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7255.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7256Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7257lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7258of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7259single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7260
7261For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7262another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7263many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7264the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7265closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7266own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7267
7268The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7269strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7270complete.
7271
7272
7273
7274
7275.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7276.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7277.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7278When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7279is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7280the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7281.code
7282[name=$local_part]
7283.endd
7284will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7285For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7286.code
7287[name="$local_part"]
7288.endd
7289but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7290NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7291rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7292of the following form is provided:
7293.code
7294${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7295.endd
7296For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7297.code
7298[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7299.endd
7300See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7301operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7302lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7303
7304
7305
7306
7307.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7308.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7309.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7310.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7311The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7312of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7313an expansion string could contain:
7314.code
7315${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7316.endd
7317If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7318is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7319&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7320&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7321
7322The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7323and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7324If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7325
7326For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7327concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7328depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7329between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7330by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7331.code
7332${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7333.endd
7334It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7335white space is ignored.
7336For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7337an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7338separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7339
7340.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7341When the type is PTR,
7342the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7343&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7344.code
7345${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7346.endd
7347If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7348altered and nothing is added.
7349
7350.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7351.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7352For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7353each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7354port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7355The field separator can be modified as above.
7356
7357.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7358.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7359For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7360unless a field separator is specified.
7361To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7362For SPF records the
7363default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7364.code
7365${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7366${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7367${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7368.endd
7369It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7370white space is ignored.
7371
7372.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7373For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7374successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7375Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7376specified.
7377.code
7378${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7379.endd
7380
7381.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7382.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7383.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7384.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7385Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7386each followed by a comma,
7387that may appear before the record type.
7388
7389The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7390temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7391a defer-option modifier.
7392The possible keywords are
7393&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7394With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7395whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7396ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7397With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7398error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7399succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7400.code
7401${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7402${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7403.endd
7404Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7405yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7406
7407.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7408Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7409The possible keywords are
7410&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7411With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7412with the lookup.
7413With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7414is not labelled as authenticated data
7415is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7416The default is &"lax"&.
7417
7418See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7419
7420.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7421.cindex "DNS" timeout
7422Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7423The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7424(e.g. &"5s"&).
7425The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7426
7427Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7428The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7429The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7430
7431.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7432.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7433.cindex DNS TTL
7434Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7435The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7436value of the set of returned DNS records.
7437
7438
7439.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7440.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7441By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7442each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7443the pseudo-type MXH:
7444.code
7445${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7446.endd
7447In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7448returned.
7449
7450.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7451Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7452records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7453component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7454records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7455error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7456but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7457top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7458.code
7459${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7460${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7461.endd
7462Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7463the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7464the name servers for &%edu%&.
7465
7466You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7467top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7468sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7469given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7470for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7471such a list.
7472
7473.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7474A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7475records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7476&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7477not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7478result of a successful lookup such as:
7479.code
7480${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7481.endd
7482has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7483The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7484authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7485
7486.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7487The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7488and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7489(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7490.code
7491${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7492.endd
7493
7494
7495.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7496In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7497However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7498&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7499the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7500.code
7501${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7502${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7503${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7504.endd
7505In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7506the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7507to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7508case, it does not treat it as a list.
7509
7510The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7511in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7512different separator can be specified, as described above.
7513
7514
7515
7516
7517.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7518.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7519.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7520.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7521The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7522become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7523implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7524contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7525the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7526it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7527indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7528your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7529.code
7530LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7531LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7532LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7533LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7534LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7535.endd
7536If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7537same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7538
7539There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7540the way they handle the results of a query:
7541
7542.ilist
7543&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7544gives an error.
7545.next
7546&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7547Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7548.next
7549&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7550from all of them are returned.
7551.endlist
7552
7553
7554For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7555Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7556the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7557First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7558
7559
7560.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7561.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7562An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7563the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7564.code
7565data = ${lookup ldap \
7566 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7567 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7568.endd
7569.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7570The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7571secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7572encrypted TLS connection is used.
7573
7574With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7575LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7576See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7577
7578Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7579controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7580&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7581your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7582&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7583certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7584running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7585methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7586&_exim.conf_&.
7587
7588
7589.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7590.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7591Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7592and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7593within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7594reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7595
7596The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7597filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7598the string:
7599.code
7600* => \2A
7601( => \28
7602) => \29
7603\ => \5C
7604.endd
7605in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7606to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7607.code
7608! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7609.endd
7610are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7611.code
7612${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7613.endd
7614yields
7615.code
7616%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7617.endd
7618Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7619.code
7620a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7621.endd
7622The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7623base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7624by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7625.code
7626, + " \ < > ;
7627.endd
7628It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7629before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7630is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7631.code
7632${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7633.endd
7634yields
7635.code
7636%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7637.endd
7638Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7639.code
7640\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7641.endd
7642There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7643authentication below.
7644
7645
7646.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7647.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7648The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7649is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7650an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7651by starting it with
7652.code
7653ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7654.endd
7655If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7656used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7657taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7658colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7659handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7660returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7661are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7662Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7663failures, and timeouts.
7664
7665For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7666of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7667&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7668doubled. For example
7669.code
7670ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7671.endd
7672If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7673to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7674the local host) is used.
7675
7676If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7677a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7678&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7679to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7680not available.
7681
7682For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7683for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7684can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7685the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7686.code
7687ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7688.endd
7689When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7690&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7691.code
7692${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7693.endd
7694When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7695a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7696specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7697socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7698&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7699or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7700the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7701backup host.
7702
7703If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7704specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7705&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7706
7707.ilist
7708Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7709interface.
7710.next
7711Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7712.endlist
7713
7714
7715Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7716&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7717
7718
7719
7720.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7721.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7722The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7723information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7724be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7725spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7726when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7727them. The following names are recognized:
7728.display
7729&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7730&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7731&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7732&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7733&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7734&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7735&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7736&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7737.endd
7738The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7739&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7740must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7741library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7742
7743.cindex LDAP timeout
7744.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7745The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7746backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7747enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7748network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7749&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7750LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7751if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7752SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7753Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7754
7755The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7756set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7757
7758The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7759to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7760default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7761server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7762different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7763different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7764alternate list (colon-separated).
7765
7766Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7767values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7768.code
7769${lookup ldap
7770 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7771 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7772 {$value}fail}
7773.endd
7774The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7775any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7776which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7777non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7778
7779The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7780connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7781on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7782
7783When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7784removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7785some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7786quoting has two advantages:
7787
7788.ilist
7789It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7790DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7791.next
7792It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7793.endlist
7794
7795For example, a setting such as
7796.code
7797USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7798.endd
7799should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7800
7801Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7802expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7803field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7804does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7805.code
7806PASS=${quote:$3}
7807.endd
7808The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7809SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7810&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7811
7812
7813
7814.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7815.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7816The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7817as a sequence of values, for example
7818.code
7819cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7820.endd
7821The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7822search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7823the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7824values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7825you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7826directory.
7827
7828In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7829result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7830has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7831part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7832
7833If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7834strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7835quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7836backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7837Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7838(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7839Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7840output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7841same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7842
7843Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7844LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7845&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7846&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7847(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7848
7849.code
7850ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7851value1.1,value1,,2
7852
7853ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7854value two
7855
7856ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7857value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7858
7859ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7860attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7861
7862ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7863objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7864.endd
7865You can
7866make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7867results of LDAP lookups.
7868The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7869individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7870The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7871of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7872The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7873comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7874
7875
7876
7877
7878.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7879.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7880.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7881NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7882and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7883contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7884of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7885values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7886.code
7887[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7888.endd
7889might return the string
7890.code
7891name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7892home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7893.endd
7894(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7895.code
7896[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7897.endd
7898would just return
7899.code
7900Martin Guerre
7901.endd
7902with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7903for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7904operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7905
7906
7907
7908.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7909.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7910.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7911.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7912.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7913.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7914.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7915.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7916.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7917.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7918.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7919.cindex lookup Redis
7920Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7921and SQLite
7922databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7923might be
7924.code
7925${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7926 {$value}fail}
7927.endd
7928If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7929field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7930.code
7931${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7932 {$value}}
7933.endd
7934might be
7935.code
7936home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7937.endd
7938Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7939quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7940field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7941.code
7942Mister X
7943.endd
7944If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7945with a newline between the data for each row.
7946
7947
7948.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7949.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7950.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7951.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7952.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7953.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7954.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7955.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7956.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7957.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7958.cindex lookup Redis
7959If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7960&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7961or &%redis_servers%&
7962option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7963information.
7964.oindex &%mysql_servers%&
7965.oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
7966.oindex &%oracle_servers%&
7967.oindex &%ibase_servers%&
7968.oindex &%redis_servers%&
7969(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7970queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7971&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7972For all but Redis
7973each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7974items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7975Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7976name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7977.code
7978hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7979.endd
7980Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7981&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7982option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7983.code
7984hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7985 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7986.endd
7987For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7988because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7989query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7990a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7991found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7992servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7993
7994For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7995own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7996If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7997information.
7998Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7999host, database number, and password.
8000.olist
8001The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8002port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8003higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8004.next
8005The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8006.next
8007The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8008.endlist
8009
8010The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8011convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8012respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8013itself are escaped with backslashes.
8014
8015The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8016escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8017
8018.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
8019.new
8020For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8021it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8022done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8023.display
8024.endd
8025&`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8026.wen
8027Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8028.olist
8029If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8030global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8031of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8032taken from there.
8033.next
8034If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8035.endlist
8036The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8037Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8038successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8039
8040This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8041are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8042master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8043like this:
8044.code
8045mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8046 slave2/db/name/pw:\
8047 master/db/name/pw
8048.endd
8049In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8050.code
8051${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8052.endd
8053That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8054the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8055option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8056.code
8057${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8058.endd
8059
8060.new
8061An older syntax places the servers speciification before the qury,
8062semicolon separated:
8063.code
8064${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8065.endd
8066The new version avoids potential issues with tainted
8067arguments in the query, for explicit expansion.
8068&*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8069.wen
8070
8071
8072.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
8073For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8074causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8075socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8076An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8077the default value is &"exim"&.
8078The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8079.display
8080<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8081 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8082.endd
8083Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8084the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8085
8086No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8087the queries.
8088
8089If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8090or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8091
8092&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8093anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8094is zero because no rows are affected.
8095
8096
8097.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8098PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8099This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8100However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8101database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8102looks like this:
8103.code
8104hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8105.endd
8106In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8107given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8108visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8109
8110If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8111update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8112affected.
8113
8114.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8115.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8116.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8117SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8118addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8119daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8120
8121.new
8122.oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8123The preferred way of specifying the file is by using the
8124&%sqlite_dbfile%& option, set to
8125an absolute path.
8126.wen
8127A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8128separated by white space.
8129This means that the path name cannot contain white space.
8130.cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8131It also means that the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8132the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8133the file.
8134
8135.new
8136Here is a lookup expansion example:
8137.code
8138sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8139...
8140${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8141.endd
8142In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8143.code
8144domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8145 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8146.endd
8147.wen
8148The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8149quote, which it doubles.
8150
8151.cindex timeout SQLite
8152.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8153The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8154internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8155update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8156are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8157waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8158to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8159option.
8160
8161.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8162.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8163.cindex "redis lookup type"
8164Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8165Examples:
8166.code
8167${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8168${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8169.endd
8170
8171As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8172Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8173of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8174master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8175servers.
8176
8177When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8178immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8179to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8180reached.
8181
8182.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8183.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8184
8185
8186. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8187. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8188
8189.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8190 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8191 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8192.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8193A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8194email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8195contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8196are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8197arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8198
8199Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8200host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8201different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8202general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8203
8204Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8205support all the complexity available in
8206domain, host, address and local part lists.
8207
8208
8209
8210.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8211.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8212Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8213
8214&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8215splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8216
8217The result of
8218expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8219into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8220but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8221&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8222discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8223
8224
8225If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8226testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8227expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8228
8229If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8230other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8231misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8232the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8233expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8234.code
8235deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8236 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8237.endd
8238The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8239&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8240senders based on the receiving domain.
8241
8242
8243
8244
8245.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8246.cindex "list" "negation"
8247.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8248Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8249leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8250defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8251it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8252(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8253
8254The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8255subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8256subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8257subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8258was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8259.code
8260domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8261.endd
8262matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8263neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8264list is positive. However, if the setting were
8265.code
8266domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8267.endd
8268then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8269list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8270as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8271
8272Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8273the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8274item.
8275
8276
8277
8278.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8279.cindex "list" "filename in"
8280If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8281filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8282processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8283filenames are not allowed,
8284and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8285Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8286lines:
8287
8288.ilist
8289For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8290file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8291.next
8292Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8293address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8294white space or the start of the line. For example:
8295.code
8296not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8297.endd
8298.endlist
8299
8300Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8301file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8302is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8303so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8304
8305If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8306within the file is inverted. For example, if
8307.code
8308hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8309.endd
8310and the file contains the lines
8311.code
8312!a.b.c
8313*.b.c
8314.endd
8315then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8316any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8317
8318
8319
8320.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8321As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8322to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8323confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8324an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8325sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8326non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8327always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8328
8329If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8330list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8331in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8332&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8333
8334
8335
8336
8337.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8338.cindex "named lists"
8339.cindex "list" "named"
8340A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8341which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8342particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8343places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8344the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8345a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8346locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8347.code
8348domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8349.endd
8350Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8351for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8352configured with the line
8353.code
8354domains = +local_domains
8355.endd
8356The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8357except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8358.code
8359dnslookup:
8360 driver = dnslookup
8361 domains = ! +local_domains
8362 transport = remote_smtp
8363 no_more
8364.endd
8365The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8366the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8367respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8368equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8369.code
8370hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8371addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8372.endd
8373A named list may refer to other named lists:
8374.code
8375domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8376domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8377domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8378.endd
8379&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8380effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8381out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8382.code
8383domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8384domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8385.endd
8386The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8387list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8388means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8389.code
8390domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8391.endd
8392where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8393referenced lists if you can.
8394
8395.new
8396.cindex "hiding named list values"
8397.cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8398Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8399accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8400line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8401word &"hide"&. For example:
8402.code
8403hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8404.endd
8405.wen
8406
8407
8408Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8409address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8410lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8411.code
8412domains = +local_domains
8413.endd
8414on several of your routers
8415or in several ACL statements,
8416the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8417if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8418references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8419the same each time they are referenced.
8420
8421By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8422extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8423is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8424hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8425
8426
8427
8428.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8429.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8430.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8431At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8432configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8433write
8434.code
8435ALIST = host1 : host2
8436auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8437.endd
8438it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8439.code
8440auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8441.endd
8442Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8443list, and write
8444.code
8445hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8446auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8447.endd
8448the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8449.code
8450auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8451.endd
8452
8453
8454.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8455.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8456.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8457While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8458it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8459the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8460that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8461an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8462message. For example:
8463.code
8464domainlist special_domains = \
8465 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8466.endd
8467This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8468address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8469in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8470cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8471same list each time.
8472
8473By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8474cache the result anyway. For example:
8475.code
8476domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8477.endd
8478If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8479the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8480
8481
8482
8483.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8484.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8485.cindex "list" "domain list"
8486Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8487The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8488
8489.ilist
8490.cindex "primary host name"
8491.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8492.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8493.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8494.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8495If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8496as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8497possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8498differ only in their names.
8499.next
8500.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8501.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8502.cindex "domain literal"
8503If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8504in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8505only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8506&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8507control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8508In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8509.next
8510.cindex "@mx_any"
8511.cindex "@mx_primary"
8512.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8513.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8514If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8515has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8516.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8517&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8518are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8519local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8520but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8521preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8522
8523The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8524performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8525example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8526resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8527options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8528
8529Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8530patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8531list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8532ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8533on a router). For example:
8534.code
8535domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8536.endd
8537This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8538the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8539
8540The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8541host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8542contain negative items.
8543
8544Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8545be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8546list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8547.code
8548domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8549 an.other.domain : ...
8550.endd
8551so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8552involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8553.code
8554domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8555 an.other.domain ? ...
8556.endd
8557.next
8558.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8559.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8560.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8561If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8562are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8563domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8564list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8565matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8566list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8567&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8568
8569.next
8570.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8571.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8572If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8573expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8574function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8575Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8576default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8577with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8578are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8579
8580&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8581must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8582use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8583it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8584expression by expansion, of course).
8585.next
8586.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8587.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8588If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8589semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8590must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8591&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8592.code
8593domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8594.endd
8595The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8596key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8597only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8598is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8599or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8600&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8601other statements in the same ACL.
8602
8603.next
8604Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8605&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8606.code
8607domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8608.endd
8609This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8610works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8611
8612.next
8613.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8614Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8615a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8616original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8617select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8618value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8619expansion variable.
8620.next
8621If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8622semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8623pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8624chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8625.code
8626hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8627 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8628.endd
8629In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8630example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8631whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8632&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8633variable and can be referred to in other options.
8634.next
8635.new
8636If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8637of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8638followed by a command and options,
8639The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8640Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=".
8641.wen
8642.next
8643.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8644If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8645between the pattern and the domain.
8646.endlist
8647
8648Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8649.code
8650domainlist funny_domains = \
8651 @ : \
8652 lib.unseen.edu : \
8653 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8654 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8655 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8656 nis;domains.byname : \
8657 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8658.endd
8659There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8660an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8661explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8662but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8663patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8664patterns earlier.
8665
8666
8667
8668.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8669.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8670.cindex "list" "host list"
8671Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8672example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8673may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8674two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8675pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8676You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8677involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8678
8679
8680.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8681.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8682.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8683If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8684involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8685process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8686not used.
8687
8688.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8689The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8690the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8691
8692
8693
8694.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8695.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8696If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8697the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8698&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8699list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8700systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8701concerns.)
8702
8703The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8704inspecting its IP address:
8705
8706.ilist
8707If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8708with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8709to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8710&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8711This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8712with the IP address of the subject host.
8713
8714If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8715lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8716ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8717temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8718what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8719
8720.next
8721.cindex "@ in a host list"
8722If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8723domain name, as just described.
8724
8725.next
8726If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8727subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8728IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8729be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8730separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8731without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8732IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8733that can never match a client host.
8734
8735.next
8736.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8737If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8738the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8739interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8740.code
8741accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8742accept hosts = @[]
8743.endd
8744.next
8745.cindex "CIDR notation"
8746If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8747example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8748host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8749included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8750specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8751significant end of the address.
8752
8753&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8754of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8755address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8756addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8757.code
8758192.168.23.236/31
8759.endd
8760matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
876132 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8762matches.
8763
8764Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8765.code
8766recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8767 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8768.endd
8769The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8770appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8771For example:
8772.code
8773recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8774.endd
8775could make use of a file containing
8776.code
8777172.16.0.0/12
87783ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8779.endd
8780to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8781addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8782changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8783.code
8784recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8785 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8786.endd
8787The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8788list.
8789.endlist
8790
8791
8792
8793.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8794 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8795.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8796When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8797address, the pattern takes this form:
8798.display
8799&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8800.endd
8801For example:
8802.code
8803hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8804.endd
8805The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8806IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8807letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8808&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8809quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8810returned by the lookup is not used.
8811
8812.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8813.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8814Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8815patterns of this form:
8816.display
8817&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8818.endd
8819For example:
8820.code
8821net24-dbm;/networks.db
8822.endd
8823The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8824length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8825mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8826is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8827&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8828
8829When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8830of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8831terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8832to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8833recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8834(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8835For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8836converted using colons and not dots.
8837In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8838addresses are always used.
8839The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8840
8841Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8842colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8843However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8844configurations.
8845
8846&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8847IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8848the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8849case the IP address is used on its own.
8850
8851
8852
8853.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8854.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8855.cindex "unknown host name"
8856.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8857There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8858remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8859complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8860address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8861above.)
8862
8863If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8864patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8865Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8866DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8867Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8868effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8869Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8870
8871Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8872against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8873
8874By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8875if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8876&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8877are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8878security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8879for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8880Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8881discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8882found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8883
8884There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8885found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8886
8887.cindex "host" "alias for"
8888.cindex "alias for host"
8889As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8890of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8891
8892.ilist
8893.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8894If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8895the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8896&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8897requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8898expression.
8899.next
8900.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8901.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8902If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8903matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8904expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8905case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8906syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8907example,
8908.code
8909^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8910.endd
8911is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8912&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8913that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8914string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8915part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8916.code
8917sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8918.endd
8919&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8920&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8921example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8922required.
8923.endlist
8924
8925
8926
8927
8928.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8929.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8930While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8931name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8932from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8933behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8934
8935&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8936apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8937
8938.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8939.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8940Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8941lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8942Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8943does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8944To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8945&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8946not recognized in an indirected file).
8947
8948.ilist
8949If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8950cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8951.code
8952host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8953.endd
8954rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8955any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8956
8957.next
8958If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8959be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8960example:
8961.code
8962accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8963 192.168.4.5
8964.endd
8965accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8966whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8967name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8968.endlist
8969
8970Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8971list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8972list.
8973
8974.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8975 "SECTmixwilhos"
8976.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8977
8978This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8979as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8980wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8981
8982.ilist
8983If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8984IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8985addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8986.code
8987accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8988.endd
8989The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8990left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8991without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8992a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8993pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8994&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8995if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8996
8997.next
8998If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8999address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9000.code
9001accept hosts = *.friend.example
9002accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9003.endd
9004If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9005&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9006&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9007this section.
9008.endlist
9009
9010
9011.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9012 "SECTtemdnserr"
9013.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9014.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9015.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9016A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9017&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9018host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9019&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9020section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9021host lists such as whitelists.
9022
9023
9024
9025.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9026 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
9027.cindex "unknown host name"
9028.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9029If a pattern is of the form
9030.display
9031<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9032.endd
9033for example
9034.code
9035dbm;/host/accept/list
9036.endd
9037a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9038lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9039is not used.
9040
9041&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9042keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9043addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
9044&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9045two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9046lookup, both using the same file.
9047
9048
9049
9050.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
9051If a pattern is of the form
9052.display
9053<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9054.endd
9055the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9056data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9057&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9058.code
9059hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9060 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9061.endd
9062The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9063can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9064use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9065operator.
9066
9067If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9068looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9069&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9070
9071Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9072host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9073&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9074still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9075effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9076See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9077
9078
9079
9080
9081
9082.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9083.cindex "list" "address list"
9084.cindex "address list" "empty item"
9085.cindex "address list" "patterns"
9086Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9087is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9088always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9089list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9090using this option setting:
9091.code
9092senders = :
9093.endd
9094The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9095data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9096detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9097and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9098
9099Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9100example:
9101.code
9102senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9103.endd
9104A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9105character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9106semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9107subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9108with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9109the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9110wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9111.code
9112deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9113 *@+hostile_domains:\
9114 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9115 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9116.endd
9117.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9118.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9119If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9120specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9121treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9122
9123If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9124contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9125address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9126domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9127is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9128.code
9129deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9130.endd
9131
9132The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9133address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9134senders:
9135
9136.ilist
9137.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9138.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9139If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9140done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9141You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9142as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9143to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9144.code
9145deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9146 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9147.endd
9148The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9149start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9150
9151.next
9152.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9153Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9154lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9155example:
9156.code
9157deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9158 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9159 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9160.endd
9161Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9162lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9163not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9164always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9165
9166Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9167cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9168panic log.
9169.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9170However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9171&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9172default. For example, with this lookup:
9173.code
9174accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9175.endd
9176the file could contains lines like this:
9177.code
9178user1@domain1.example
9179*@domain2.example
9180.endd
9181and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9182that are tried is:
9183.code
9184nimrod@jaeger.example
9185*@jaeger.example
9186*
9187.endd
9188&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9189would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9190
9191&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9192.code
9193deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9194deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9195.endd
9196The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9197because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9198domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9199.endlist
9200
9201
9202The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9203If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9204always fails.
9205
9206
9207.ilist
9208.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9209.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9210.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9211If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9212(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9213split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9214it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9215from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9216of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9217
9218.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9219The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9220keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9221patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9222even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9223with
9224.code
9225deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9226.endd
9227the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9228.code
9229baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9230.endd
9231to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9232
9233.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9234If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9235has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9236may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9237but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9238surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9239.code
9240aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9241 spammer3 : spammer4
9242.endd
9243As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9244doubling.
9245
9246If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9247of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9248list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9249might have entries like
9250.code
9251aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9252xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9253*: ^\d{8}$
9254.endd
9255in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9256local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9257each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9258chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9259
9260.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9261It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9262them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9263
9264.next
9265The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9266lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9267can only return a single list of local parts.
9268.endlist
9269
9270&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9271in these two examples:
9272.code
9273senders = +my_list
9274senders = *@+my_list
9275.endd
9276In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9277example it is a named domain list.
9278
9279
9280
9281
9282.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9283.cindex "case of local parts"
9284.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9285.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9286Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9287case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9288Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9289Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9290blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9291lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9292default.
9293
9294The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9295address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9296comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9297the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9298that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9299keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9300works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9301case-independent.
9302
9303.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9304To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9305an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9306part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9307longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9308lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9309performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9310become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9311
9312
9313
9314.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9315.cindex "list" "local part list"
9316.cindex "local part" "list"
9317Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9318lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9319setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9320set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9321case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9322matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9323&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9324option is case-sensitive from the start.
9325
9326If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9327comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9328only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9329Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9330that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9331&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9332Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9333types.
9334.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9335
9336
9337
9338
9339. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9340. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9341
9342.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9343.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9344Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9345them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9346
9347When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9348.cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9349when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9350start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9351below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9352escape character, as described in the following section.
9353
9354Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9355dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9356options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9357the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9358conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9359reasons,
9360.cindex "tainted data" expansion
9361.cindex expansion "tainted data"
9362and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9363is not permitted.
9364
9365
9366
9367.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9368.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9369An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9370backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9371character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9372If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9373required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9374the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9375
9376.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9377A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9378two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9379expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9380.code
9381deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9382.endd
9383On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9384without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9385string.
9386
9387
9388
9389.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9390.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9391A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9392expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9393carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9394octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9395backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9396encoding.
9397
9398These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9399in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9400and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9401
9402
9403.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9404.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9405.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9406.oindex "&%-be%&"
9407Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9408takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9409arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9410to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9411since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9412value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9413database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9414and &%nhash%&.
9415
9416Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9417instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9418using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9419
9420.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9421If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9422from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9423option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9424read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9425.code
9426exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9427.endd
9428The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9429Exim message identifier. For example:
9430.code
9431exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9432.endd
9433This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9434is therefore restricted to admin users.
9435
9436
9437.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9438.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9439A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9440alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9441(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9442used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9443instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9444the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9445that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9446its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9447from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9448taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9449being expanded.
9450
9451
9452
9453
9454.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9455The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9456between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9457outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9458white space is significant.
9459
9460.vlist
9461.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9462.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9463Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9464.code
9465$local_part
9466${domain}
9467.endd
9468The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9469characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9470&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9471section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9472given, the expansion fails.
9473
9474.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9475.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9476The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9477<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9478.code
9479${lc:$local_part}
9480.endd
9481The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9482leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9483below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9484one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9485string easier to understand.
9486
9487.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9488This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9489expansion item below.
9490
9491
9492.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9493.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9494.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9495The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9496arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9497Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9498arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9499and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9500are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9501a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9502the result of the expansion.
9503If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9504the expansion result is an empty string.
9505If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9506
9507
9508.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9509.cindex authentication "results header"
9510.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9511.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9512This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9513&'Authentication-Results:'&
9514header line.
9515The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9516will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9517Methods that might be present in the result include:
9518.code
9519none
9520iprev
9521auth
9522spf
9523dkim
9524.endd
9525
9526Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9527.code
9528 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9529.endd
9530This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9531
9532
9533.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9534 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9535.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9536.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9537.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9538The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9539The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9540the certificate. Supported fields are:
9541.display
9542&`version `&
9543&`serial_number `&
9544&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9545&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9546&`notbefore `& time
9547&`notafter `& time
9548&`sig_algorithm `&
9549&`signature `&
9550&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9551&`ocsp_uri `& list
9552&`crl_uri `& list
9553.endd
9554If the field is found,
9555<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9556otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9557variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9558is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9559
9560If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9561key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9562extracted is used.
9563
9564Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9565
9566The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9567output a Distinguished Name string which is
9568not quite
9569parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9570(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9571RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9572a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9573result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9574The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9575a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9576Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9577
9578The field selectors marked as "time" above
9579take an optional modifier of "int"
9580for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9581Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9582in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9583
9584The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9585newline-separated by default,
9586(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9587The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9588a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9589
9590The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9591prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9592Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9593which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9594if so the element tags are omitted.
9595
9596If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9597
9598.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9599 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9600.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9601This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9602This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9603.code
9604EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9605.endd
9606set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9607object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9608(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9609
9610There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9611
9612When compiling
9613a local function that is to be called in this way,
9614first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9615and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9616The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9617are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9618must have the following type:
9619.code
9620int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9621.endd
9622Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9623function should return one of the following values:
9624
9625&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9626into the expanded string that is being built.
9627
9628&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9629from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9630
9631&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9632taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9633
9634&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9635
9636When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9637you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9638configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9639
9640
9641.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9642.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9643.cindex "environment" "values from"
9644The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9645removed.
9646This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9647If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9648and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9649
9650Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9651appear, for example:
9652.code
9653${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9654.endd
9655This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9656{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9657
9658If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9659search failure.
9660If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9661search success.
9662
9663The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9664&%add_environment%& main section options.
9665
9666
9667.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9668 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9669.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9670.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9671The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9672white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9673must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9674The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9675.display
9676<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9677.endd
9678.vindex "&$value$&"
9679where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9680values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9681values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9682described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9683for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9684the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9685otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9686variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9687is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9688
9689If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9690key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9691extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9692yield &"2001"&:
9693.code
9694${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9695${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9696.endd
9697Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9698appear, for example:
9699.code
9700${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9701.endd
9702This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9703{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9704
9705.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9706 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9707 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9708 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9709.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9710.cindex JSON expansions
9711The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9712white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9713must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9714The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9715.display
9716{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9717.endd
9718.vindex "&$value$&"
9719The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9720the spaces are optional.
9721Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9722For the &"json"& variant,
9723if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9724trailing quotes.
9725For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9726leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9727. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9728
9729The results of matching are handled as above.
9730
9731
9732.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9733 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9734.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9735.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9736The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9737apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9738This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9739behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9740extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9741argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9742<&'string3'&> as before.
9743
9744The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9745separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9746The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9747counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9748number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9749number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9750expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9751provided. For example:
9752.code
9753${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9754.endd
9755yields &"42"&, and
9756.code
9757${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9758.endd
9759yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9760empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9761
9762
9763.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9764 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9765 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9766 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9767.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9768.cindex JSON expansions
9769The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9770apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9771
9772Field selection and result handling is as above;
9773there is no choice of field separator.
9774For the &"json"& variant,
9775if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9776trailing quotes.
9777For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9778leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9779
9780
9781.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9782.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9783.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9784.vindex "&$item$&"
9785After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9786default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9787For each item
9788in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9789evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9790item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9791separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9792input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9793.code
9794${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9795.endd
9796yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9797to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9798
9799
9800.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9801.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9802.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9803This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9804early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9805(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9806
9807The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9808<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9809<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9810use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9811.code
9812${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9813.endd
9814The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9815or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9816Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9817function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9818first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9819.code
9820abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9821.endd
9822If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9823letters appear. For example:
9824.display
9825&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9826&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9827&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9828.endd
9829
9830.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9831 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9832 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9833 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9834 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9835 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9836 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9837 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9838.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9839.vindex "&$header_$&"
9840.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9841.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9842.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9843.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9844.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9845.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9846Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9847.code
9848$header_reply-to:
9849.endd
9850The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9851internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9852lines) may be present.
9853
9854The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9855the data in the header line is interpreted.
9856
9857.ilist
9858.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9859&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9860processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9861
9862.next
9863.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9864&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9865are multiple headers with a given name.
9866Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9867list-processing facilities can be used.
9868The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9869the content is &"raw"&.
9870
9871.next
9872.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9873&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9874or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9875character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9876&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9877.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9878produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9879what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9880
9881.next
9882&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9883standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9884be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9885returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9886&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9887a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9888.endlist ilist
9889
9890In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9891command of the following form:
9892.code
9893headers charset "UTF-8"
9894.endd
9895This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9896subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9897character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9898option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9899value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9900ISO-8859-1.
9901
9902Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9903any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9904&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9905if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9906
9907Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9908this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9909message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9910filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9911router or transport are not accessible.
9912
9913For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9914ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9915because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9916They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9917Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9918are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9919point they are added.
9920When any of the above ACLs ar
9921running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9922
9923Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9924following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9925this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9926white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9927expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9928expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9929section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9930header.)
9931
9932If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9933to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9934&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9935each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9936newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9937newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9938those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9939junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9940
9941.new
9942.cindex "tainted data"
9943When the headers are from an incoming message,
9944the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
9945.wen
9946
9947
9948.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9949.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9950.cindex &%hmac%&
9951This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9952shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9953RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9954&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9955cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9956or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9957present. For example:
9958.code
9959${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9960.endd
9961For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9962produces:
9963.code
9964dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9965.endd
9966As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9967an Exim configuration:
9968.code
9969SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9970.endd
9971In a router or a transport you could then have:
9972.code
9973headers_add = \
9974 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9975 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9976 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9977.endd
9978Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9979&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9980this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9981host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9982using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9983&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9984
9985
9986.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9987.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9988.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9989If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9990item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9991in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9992.code
9993${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9994.endd
9995The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9996true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9997be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9998case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9999&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10000
10001If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10002is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10003cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10004.code
10005condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10006.endd
10007you can use
10008.code
10009condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10010.endd
10011
10012
10013
10014.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10015.cindex expansion "imap folder"
10016.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10017This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10018folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10019For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10020
10021
10022
10023.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10024.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10025.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10026The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10027strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10028you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10029change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10030some of the braces:
10031.code
10032${length_<n>:<string>}
10033.endd
10034The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10035of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10036&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10037All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10038
10039
10040.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10041 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10042.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10043.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10044.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10045The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10046apart from an optional leading minus,
10047and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10048
10049After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10050default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10051
10052The first field of the list is numbered one.
10053If the number is negative, the fields are
10054counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10055The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10056then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10057
10058If the modulus of the
10059number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10060the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10061
10062For example:
10063.code
10064${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10065.endd
10066yields &"42"&, and
10067.code
10068${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10069.endd
10070yields &"result: 42"&.
10071
10072If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10073If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10074extracted is used.
10075You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10076
10077
10078.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10079 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10080This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
10081described in the next item.
10082
10083.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10084 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10085.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10086.cindex "file" "lookups"
10087.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10088The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10089discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10090lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10091<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10092
10093If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10094a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10095other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10096in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10097out by the system administrator.
10098
10099.vindex "&$value$&"
10100If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10101During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10102lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10103level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10104the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10105string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10106lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10107original lookup fails.
10108
10109If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10110data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10111expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10112the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10113appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10114to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10115{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10116successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10117
10118For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10119search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10120type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10121&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10122
10123.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10124If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10125and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10126They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10127
10128This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10129.code
10130${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10131.endd
10132This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10133the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10134.code
10135${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10136 {$value}fail}
10137.endd
10138
10139
10140.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10141.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10142.vindex "&$item$&"
10143After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10144default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10145For each item
10146in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10147expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10148for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10149setting is not included in the output. For example:
10150.code
10151${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10152.endd
10153expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10154value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10155and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10156
10157.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10158.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10159.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10160The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10161<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10162if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10163can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10164.code
10165${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10166.endd
10167The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10168the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10169processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10170slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10171example,
10172.code
10173${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10174.endd
10175returns the string &"6/33"&.
10176
10177
10178
10179.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10180.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10181.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10182This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10183interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10184expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10185additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10186name of the subroutine, is nine.
10187
10188The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10189the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10190way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10191Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10192return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10193not its contents.
10194
10195If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10196with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10197Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10198
10199The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10200out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10201
10202
10203.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10204.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10205The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10206keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10207it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10208to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10209as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10210and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10211
10212.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10213 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10214.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10215This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10216checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10217yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10218empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10219prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10220version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10221variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10222
10223These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10224retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10225against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10226which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10227
10228The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10229string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10230result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10231whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10232is the expansion of the third argument.
10233
10234All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10235However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10236For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10237
10238.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10239.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10240.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10241.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10242The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10243then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10244the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10245newlines are left in the string.
10246String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10247you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10248the string expansion fails.
10249
10250The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10251locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10252
10253
10254
10255.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10256 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10257.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10258.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10259.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10260This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10261string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10262examples:
10263.code
10264${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10265${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10266.endd
10267For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10268For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10269a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10270number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10271optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10272example:
10273.code
10274${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10275.endd
10276Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10277one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10278both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10279unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10280and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10281is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10282extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10283.code
10284${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10285.endd
10286
10287The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10288and must be present if any options are given.
10289Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10290Example:
10291.code
10292${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10293.endd
10294
10295.new
10296The following option names are recognised:
10297.ilist
10298&*cache*&
10299Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10300request in the same process.
10301Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10302If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10303will be invalidated.
10304
10305.next
10306&*shutdown*&
10307Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10308sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10309(preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10310
10311.next
10312&*tls*&
10313Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10314Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10315If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10316.endlist
10317.wen
10318
10319
10320A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10321that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10322turns them into spaces:
10323.code
10324${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10325.endd
10326As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10327happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10328addition, the following errors can occur:
10329
10330.ilist
10331Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10332.next
10333Failure to connect the socket;
10334.next
10335Failure to write the request string;
10336.next
10337Timeout on reading from the socket.
10338.endlist
10339
10340By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10341you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10342errors occurs. For example:
10343.code
10344${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10345 {socket failure}}
10346.endd
10347You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10348expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10349and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10350if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10351non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10352
10353The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10354locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10355
10356
10357.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10358.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10359.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10360.vindex "&$value$&"
10361.vindex "&$item$&"
10362This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10363<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10364separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10365Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10366assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10367list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10368them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10369iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10370added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10371number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10372.code
10373${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10374.endd
10375The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10376can be found:
10377.code
10378${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10379.endd
10380At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10381restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10382expansion items.
10383
10384.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10385This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10386expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10387
10388.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10389 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10390.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10391.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10392The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10393split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10394in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10395executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10396a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10397
10398Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10399which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10400simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10401script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10402variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10403quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10404in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10405around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10406variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10407character.
10408
10409The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10410and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10411.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10412.vindex "&$value$&"
10413If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10414and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10415from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10416<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10417expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10418&$value$&.
10419
10420If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10421can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10422command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10423of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10424
10425.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10426The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10427In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10428troubleshoot:
10429.code
10430warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10431 log_message = Output of id: $value
10432.endd
10433If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10434shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10435.code
10436${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10437.endd
10438
10439.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10440The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10441remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10442.code
10443if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10444 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10445 ...
10446endif
10447.endd
10448If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10449the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10450commands.
10451
10452&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10453option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10454testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10455by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10456
10457The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10458out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10459
10460
10461.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10462.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10463.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10464This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10465option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10466modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10467into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10468a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10469.code
10470${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10471.endd
10472yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10473if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10474substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10475.code
10476${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10477.endd
10478yields &"defabc"&, and
10479.code
10480${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10481.endd
10482yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10483the regular expression from string expansion.
10484
10485The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10486rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10487
10488
10489.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10490.cindex sorting "a list"
10491.cindex list sorting
10492.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10493After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10494default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10495The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10496of a two-argument expansion condition.
10497The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10498The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10499if the first value should sort before the second value.
10500The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10501the element being placed in &$item$&,
10502to give values for comparison.
10503
10504The item result is a sorted list,
10505with the original list separator,
10506of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10507
10508Examples:
10509.code
10510${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10511.endd
10512sorts a list of numbers, and
10513.code
10514${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10515.endd
10516will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10517
10518
10519.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10520.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10521.cindex "substring extraction"
10522.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10523The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10524<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10525if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10526can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10527.code
10528${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10529.endd
10530The second number is optional (in both notations).
10531If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10532omitted.
10533
10534The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10535&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10536length required. For example
10537.code
10538${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10539.endd
10540If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10541null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10542length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10543given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10544
10545The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10546from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10547the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10548.code
10549${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10550.endd
10551yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10552length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10553the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10554.code
10555${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10556.endd
10557yields an empty string, but
10558.code
10559${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10560.endd
10561yields &"1"&.
10562
10563When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10564is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10565string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10566no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10567.code
10568${substr_-1:abcde}
10569${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10570.endd
10571yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10572
10573All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10574
10575
10576
10577.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10578 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10579.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10580.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10581This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10582argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10583matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10584replacement list. For example
10585.code
10586${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10587.endd
10588yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10589last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10590last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10591place.
10592
10593All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10594
10595.endlist
10596
10597
10598
10599.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10600.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10601For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10602the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10603The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10604following operations can be performed:
10605
10606.vlist
10607.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10608.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10609.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10610The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10611header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10612not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10613
10614The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10615
10616
10617.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10618.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10619.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10620The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
106212822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10622operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10623result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10624doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10625Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10626
10627It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10628separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10629character. For example:
10630.code
10631${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10632.endd
10633expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10634first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10635separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10636separator explicitly:
10637.code
10638${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10639.endd
10640
10641Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10642expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10643address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10644processing lists.
10645
10646To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10647a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10648unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10649email address separator. For the example header line:
10650.code
10651From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10652.endd
10653The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10654properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10655It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10656example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10657de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10658The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10659quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10660.code
10661# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10662=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10663user@example.com
10664# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10665Last:user@example.com
10666# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10667user@example.com
10668# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10669フィリップ@example.jp
10670.endd
10671
10672.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10673.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10674.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10675The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10676base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10677Only lowercase letters are used.
10678
10679.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10680.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10681.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10682The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10683The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10684
10685.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10686.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10687.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10688The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10689base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10690the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10691its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10692filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10693to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10694
10695.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10696.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10697.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10698The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10699environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10700identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10701string.
10702
10703.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10704.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10705.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10706.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10707.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10708This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10709
10710If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10711returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10712
10713
10714.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10715.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10716.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10717.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10718This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10719
10720
10721.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10722.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10723.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10724The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10725from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10726
10727
10728.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10729.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10730.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10731If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10732escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10733significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10734is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10735
10736.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10737.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10738.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10739If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10740they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10741Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10742
10743
10744.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10745.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10746.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10747.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10748These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10749expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10750arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10751logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10752integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10753C programming language):
10754.table2 70pt 300pt
10755.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10756.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10757.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10758.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10759.irow "" "and (&&)"
10760.irow "" "xor (^)"
10761.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10762.endtable
10763Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10764space is permitted before or after operators.
10765
10766For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10767hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10768decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10769permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10770times, which often do have leading zeros.
10771
10772A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10773or 1024*1024*1024,
10774respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10775a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10776
10777.display
10778&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10779&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10780&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10781&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10782&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10783&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10784&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10785&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10786&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10787&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10788&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10789.endd
10790
10791As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10792.code
10793deny message = Too many bad recipients
10794 condition = \
10795 ${if and { \
10796 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10797 { \
10798 < \
10799 {$recipients_count} \
10800 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10801 } \
10802 }{yes}{no}}
10803.endd
10804The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10805fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10806
10807
10808.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10809.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10810The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10811example,
10812.code
10813${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10814.endd
10815first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10816and then re-expands what it has found.
10817
10818
10819.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10820.cindex "Unicode"
10821.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10822.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10823.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10824The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10825email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10826to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10827UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10828converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10829the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10830
10831Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10832ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10833For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10834way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10835characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10836single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10837translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10838
10839
10840.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10841.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10842.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10843The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10844be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10845change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10846.code
10847${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10848.endd
10849See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10850abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10851
10852
10853
10854.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10855.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10856.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10857.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10858This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10859be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10860
10861
10862
10863.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10864.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10865.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10866This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10867escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10868as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10869byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10870
10871
10872.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10873.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10874.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10875This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10876of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10877A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10878Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10879
10880.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10881.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10882.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10883.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10884This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10885Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10886set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10887A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10888Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10889
10890
10891.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10892.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10893.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10894.cindex "lower casing"
10895.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10896.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10897This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10898.code
10899${lc:$local_part}
10900.endd
10901Case is defined per the system C locale.
10902
10903.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10904.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10905.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10906The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10907can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10908changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10909.code
10910${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10911.endd
10912See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10913&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10914when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10915All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10916
10917
10918.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10919.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10920.cindex "list" "item count"
10921.cindex "list" "count of items"
10922.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10923The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10924
10925
10926.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10927.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10928.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10929The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10930expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10931If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10932and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10933Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10934matching list is returned.
10935
10936
10937.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10938.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10939.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10940The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10941extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10942empty.
10943The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10944
10945
10946.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10947.cindex "masked IP address"
10948.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10949.cindex "CIDR notation"
10950.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10951.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10952If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10953slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10954expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10955masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10956the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10957.code
10958${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10959.endd
10960returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10961be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10962address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10963terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10964.code
10965${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10966.endd
10967returns the string
10968.code
109693ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10970.endd
10971Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10972
10973
10974.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10975.cindex "MD5 hash"
10976.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10977.cindex certificate fingerprint
10978.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10979The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10980as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10981
10982If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10983returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10984
10985
10986.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10987.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10988.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10989The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10990that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10991strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10992.code
10993${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10994.endd
10995See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10996
10997
10998.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10999.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11000.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11001.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11002The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11003is an empty string or
11004contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11005Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11006Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11007respectively For example,
11008.code
11009${quote:ab"*"cd}
11010.endd
11011becomes
11012.code
11013"ab\"*\"cd"
11014.endd
11015The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11016variable or a message header.
11017
11018.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11019.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11020This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11021required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11022example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11023If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11024(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11025
11026This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11027will likely use the quoting form.
11028Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11029
11030
11031.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11032.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11033This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11034query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11035the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11036.code
11037${quote_ldap:two * two}
11038.endd
11039returns
11040.code
11041two%20%5C2A%20two
11042.endd
11043For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11044yields an unchanged string.
11045
11046
11047.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11048.cindex "random number"
11049This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11050supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11051on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11052If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11053If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11054for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11055Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11056srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11057random().
11058
11059
11060.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11061.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11062This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11063dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11064dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11065for DNS. For example,
11066.code
11067${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11068${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11069.endd
11070returns
11071.code
110724.2.0.192
11073f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11074.endd
11075
11076
11077.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11078.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11079.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11080.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11081This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11082encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11083assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11084&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11085contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11086characters
11087.code
11088? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11089.endd
11090it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11091string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11092characters.
11093
11094
11095.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11096.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11097.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11098.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11099This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11100bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11101character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11102not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11103
11104&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11105access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11106to use this operator as well.
11107
11108
11109
11110.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11111.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11112.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11113.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11114The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11115characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11116variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11117
11118
11119.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11120.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11121.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11122.cindex certificate fingerprint
11123.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11124The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11125it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11126
11127If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11128returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11129
11130
11131.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11132 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11133 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11134.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11135.cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11136.cindex certificate fingerprint
11137.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11138.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11139.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11140The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11141and returns
11142it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11143
11144If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11145returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11146
11147The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11148(except for certificates, which are not supported).
11149Finally, if an underbar
11150and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11151member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11152Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11153
11154
11155.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11156 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11157.cindex "SHA3 hash"
11158.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11159.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11160The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11161and returns
11162it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11163
11164If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11165the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11166with 256 being the default.
11167
11168The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11169compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11170or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11171The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11172
11173
11174.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11175.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11176.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11177.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11178The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11179function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11180expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11181series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11182except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11183a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1118410-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11185&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11186can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11187
11188The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11189the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11190systems for files larger than 2GB.
11191
11192.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11193.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11194Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11195
11196
11197
11198.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11199.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11200.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11201.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11202The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11203decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11204All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11205
11206
11207.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11208.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11209.cindex "substring extraction"
11210.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11211The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11212can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11213that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11214.code
11215${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11216.endd
11217See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11218abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11219All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11220
11221.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11222.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11223.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11224This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11225seconds.
11226
11227.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11228.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11229.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11230The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11231represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11232number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11233&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11234
11235.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11236.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11237.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11238.cindex "upper casing"
11239.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11240.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11241This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11242Case is defined per the system C locale.
11243
11244.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11245.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11246.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11247.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11248.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11249.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11250This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11251In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11252final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11253If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11254the complexity will depend upon the task.
11255For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11256extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11257dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11258.code
11259condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11260.endd
11261(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11262literal question mark).
11263
11264.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11265 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11266 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11267 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11268.cindex expansion UTF-8
11269.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11270.cindex EAI
11271.cindex internationalisation
11272.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11273.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11274.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11275.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11276These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11277For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11278.endlist
11279
11280
11281
11282
11283
11284
11285.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11286.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11287The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11288while expanding strings:
11289
11290.vlist
11291.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11292.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11293.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11294Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11295condition.
11296
11297.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11298.cindex "numeric comparison"
11299.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11300There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11301are:
11302.display
11303&`= `& equal
11304&`== `& equal
11305&`> `& greater
11306&`>= `& greater or equal
11307&`< `& less
11308&`<= `& less or equal
11309.endd
11310For example:
11311.code
11312${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11313.endd
11314Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11315two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11316optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11317lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11318As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11319zero.
11320
11321In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11322<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1132310M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11324
11325
11326.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11327 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11328.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11329.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11330The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11331arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11332Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11333arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11334and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11335are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11336a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11337the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11338If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11339If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11340
11341.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11342.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11343.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11344This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11345a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11346(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11347false if zero.
11348An empty string is treated as false.
11349Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11350thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11351All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11352
11353When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11354make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11355For example:
11356.code
11357${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11358.endd
11359
11360
11361.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11362.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11363.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11364Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11365where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11366loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11367and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11368true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11369
11370Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11371
11372.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11373.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11374.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11375.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11376This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11377authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11378necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11379included in the binary.
11380
11381The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11382compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11383be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11384encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11385does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11386&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11387Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11388string in LDAP form is:
11389.code
11390{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11391.endd
11392If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11393be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11394.code
11395${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11396.endd
11397The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11398supported:
11399
11400.ilist
11401.cindex "MD5 hash"
11402.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11403&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11404printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11405length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11406(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11407hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11408comparison fails.
11409
11410.next
11411.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11412&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11413printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11414length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11415If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11416SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11417
11418.next
11419.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11420&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11421only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11422systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11423whatever its length.
11424
11425.next
11426.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11427&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11428use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11429modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11430.endlist
11431Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11432&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11433HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11434operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11435the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11436support &[crypt16()]&.
11437
11438Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11439it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11440turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11441&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11442algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11443
11444However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11445functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11446Exim is seen as very low priority.
11447
11448If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11449comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11450determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11451default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11452function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11453
11454.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11455.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11456.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11457The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11458variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11459variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11460.code
11461${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11462.endd
11463Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11464variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11465
11466.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11467 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11468.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11469This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11470exists in the message. For example,
11471.code
11472${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11473.endd
11474&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11475the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11476
11477.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11478 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11479.cindex "string" "comparison"
11480.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11481.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11482.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11483The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11484resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11485letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11486case is defined per the system C locale.
11487
11488.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11489.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11490.cindex "file" "existence test"
11491.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11492The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11493condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11494is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11495users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11496
11497.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11498.cindex "delivery" "first"
11499.cindex "first delivery"
11500.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11501.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11502This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11503attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11504
11505
11506.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11507 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11508.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11509.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11510.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11511.vindex "&$item$&"
11512These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11513the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11514the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11515The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11516be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11517condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11518.ilist
11519For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11520the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11521items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11522.next
11523For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11524and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11525all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11526.endlist
11527Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11528items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11529that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11530list separator is changed to a comma:
11531.code
11532${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11533.endd
11534The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11535being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11536
11537To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11538
11539.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11540 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11541 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11542 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11543.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11544.cindex JSON expansions
11545.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11546.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11547.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11548.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11549As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11550be a JSON array.
11551The array separator is not changeable.
11552For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11553and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11554
11555
11556
11557.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11558 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11559.cindex "string" "comparison"
11560.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11561.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11562.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11563The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11564string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11565comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11566case-independent.
11567Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11568
11569.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11570 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11571.cindex "string" "comparison"
11572.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11573.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11574.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11575The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11576string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11577includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11578case-independent.
11579Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11580
11581.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11582 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11583.cindex "string" "comparison"
11584.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11585Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11586strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11587is true.
11588For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11589
11590These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11591Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11592.code
11593${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11594 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11595${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11596 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11597.endd
11598
11599.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11600 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11601 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11602.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11603.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11604.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11605.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11606.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11607The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11608an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11609&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11610
11611For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11612which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11613colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11614hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11615component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11616
11617&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11618values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11619check.
11620This is no longer the case.
11621
11622The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11623host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11624.code
11625${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11626.endd
11627to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11628
11629.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11630.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11631.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11632.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11633This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11634&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11635queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11636query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11637password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11638server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11639with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11640will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11641of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11642this can be used.
11643
11644
11645.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11646 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11647.cindex "string" "comparison"
11648.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11649.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11650.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11651The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11652string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11653comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11654case-independent.
11655Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11656
11657.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11658 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11659.cindex "string" "comparison"
11660.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11661.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11662.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11663The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11664string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11665includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11666case-independent.
11667Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11668
11669
11670.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11671.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11672.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11673.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11674The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11675expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11676regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11677escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11678(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11679premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11680&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11681For example,
11682.code
11683${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11684.endd
11685If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11686backslashes is also required.
11687
11688The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11689The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11690metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11691and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11692the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11693metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11694All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11695but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11696
11697.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11698At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11699substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11700succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11701will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11702of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11703combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11704variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11705
11706.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11707.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11708See &*match_local_part*&.
11709
11710.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11711.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11712See &*match_local_part*&.
11713
11714.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11715.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11716This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11717be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11718address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11719list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11720.code
11721${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11722.endd
11723The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11724
11725.ilist
11726An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11727.next
11728A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11729.next
11730An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11731useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11732in a single test such as
11733. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11734. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11735. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11736. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11737.code
11738 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11739.endd
11740where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11741.next
11742The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11743.next
11744Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11745even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11746address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11747&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11748masks. For example:
11749.code
11750 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11751.endd
11752It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11753do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11754address mask, for example:
11755.code
11756 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11757.endd
11758However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11759just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11760.code
11761 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11762.endd
11763.endlist ilist
11764
11765Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11766Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11767
11768Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11769
11770.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11771.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11772.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11773.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11774.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11775This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11776possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11777condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11778example is:
11779.code
11780${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11781.endd
11782In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11783list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11784is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11785Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11786.code
11787${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11788.endd
11789.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11790For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11791item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11792have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11793caselessly.
11794
11795Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11796Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11797
11798&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11799hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11800how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11801matched using &%match_ip%&.
11802
11803.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11804.cindex "PAM authentication"
11805.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11806.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11807.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11808.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11809&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11810(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11811available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11812distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11813the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11814.code
11815SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11816.endd
11817in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11818in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11819
11820The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11821colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11822The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11823taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11824The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11825from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11826request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11827
11828There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11829characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11830separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11831item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11832of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11833.code
11834server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11835.endd
11836For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11837.code
11838server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11839.endd
11840In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11841running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11842messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11843. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11844
11845
11846.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11847.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11848.cindex "Cyrus"
11849.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11850.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11851This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11852This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11853that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11854deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11855
11856The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11857the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11858building Exim. For example:
11859.code
11860CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11861.endd
11862You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11863the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11864from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11865access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11866
11867The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11868password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11869configuration, you might have this:
11870.code
11871server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11872.endd
11873Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11874.code
11875server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11876.endd
11877.vitem &*queue_running*&
11878.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11879.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11880.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11881This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11882initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11883
11884
11885.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11886.cindex "Radius"
11887.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11888.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11889Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11890set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11891the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11892support.
11893
11894With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11895library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11896this library, you need to set
11897.code
11898RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11899.endd
11900in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11901&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11902.code
11903RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11904.endd
11905in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11906You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11907Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11908
11909The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11910Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11911the authentication is successful. For example:
11912.code
11913server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11914.endd
11915
11916
11917.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11918 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11919.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11920.cindex "Cyrus"
11921.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11922.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11923This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11924daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11925Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11926by a process that is not running as root.
11927
11928The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11929the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11930building Exim. For example:
11931.code
11932CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11933.endd
11934You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11935the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11936from the Cyrus SASL library.
11937
11938Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11939two are mandatory. For example:
11940.code
11941server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11942.endd
11943The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11944in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11945realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11946.endlist vlist
11947
11948
11949
11950.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11951.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11952Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11953and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11954conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11955sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11956the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11957
11958
11959.vlist
11960.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11961.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11962.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11963The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11964any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11965For example,
11966.code
11967${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11968.endd
11969When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11970evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11971numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11972
11973.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11974.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11975.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11976The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11977all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11978sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11979the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11980parsed but not evaluated.
11981.endlist
11982.ecindex IIDexpcond
11983
11984
11985
11986
11987.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11988.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11989This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11990of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11991support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11992
11993.vlist
11994.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11995.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11996When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11997captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11998processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11999In the expansion condition case
12000they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12001values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12002variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12003precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12004Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12005matching condition.
12006
12007.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12008Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12009any arguments are copied to these variables,
12010any unused variables being made empty.
12011
12012.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12013Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12014can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12015long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12016example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12017variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12018used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12019same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12020with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12021during subsequent delivery.
12022
12023.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12024These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12025are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12026received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12027message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12028also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12029message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12030and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12031delivery.
12032
12033.vitem &$acl_narg$&
12034Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12035this variable has the number of arguments.
12036
12037.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12038.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12039After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12040message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
12041be preserved by coding like this:
12042.code
12043warn !verify = sender
12044 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12045.endd
12046You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12047&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12048failure.
12049
12050.vitem &$address_data$&
12051.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12052This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12053value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12054and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12055the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12056for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12057user filter files.
12058
12059If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12060a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12061conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12062to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12063of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12064from the child's routing.
12065
12066If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12067sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12068&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12069address.
12070
12071In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12072after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12073these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12074
12075.vitem &$address_file$&
12076.vindex "&$address_file$&"
12077When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12078to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12079is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12080default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12081.code
12082/home/r2d2/savemail
12083.endd
12084then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12085contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12086.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12087For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12088then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12089to the relevant file.
12090
12091.vitem &$address_pipe$&
12092.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12093When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12094this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12095
12096.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
12097.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12098These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12099&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12100
12101.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12102.cindex "authentication" "id"
12103.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12104When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12105preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12106&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12107user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12108in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12109&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12110
12111When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12112the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12113process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12114command line option.
12115This second case also sets up information used by the
12116&$authresults$& expansion item.
12117
12118.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12119.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12120.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12121When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12122will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12123id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12124available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12125A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12126authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12127the ACL's as well.
12128
12129
12130.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
12131.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12132.cindex "authentication" "sender"
12133.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12134.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12135When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12136SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12137described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12138&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12139available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12140sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12141
12142.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12143When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12144value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12145name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12146can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12147
12148
12149.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12150.cindex "authentication" "failure"
12151.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12152This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12153command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12154possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12155(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12156&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12157is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12158negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12159an undefined mechanism.
12160
12161.vitem &$av_failed$&
12162.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12163This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12164extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12165problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12166the ACL malware condition.
12167
12168.vitem &$body_linecount$&
12169.cindex "message body" "line count"
12170.cindex "body of message" "line count"
12171.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12172When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12173number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12174
12175.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12176.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12177.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12178.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12179.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12180When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12181number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12182
12183.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12184.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12185This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12186it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12187chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12188
12189.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12190.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12191This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12192up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12193file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12194
12195.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12196.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12197.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12198The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12199not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12200&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12201incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12202
12203.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12204.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12205.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12206The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12207not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12208&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12209incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12210
12211.vitem &$callout_address$&
12212.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12213After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12214address that was connected to.
12215
12216.vitem &$compile_number$&
12217.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12218The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12219of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12220compilations of the same version of Exim.
12221
12222.vitem &$config_dir$&
12223.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12224The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12225&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12226contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12227&$config_dir$& is ".".
12228
12229.vitem &$config_file$&
12230.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12231The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12232
12233.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12234 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12235 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12236 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12237Results of DMARC verification.
12238For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12239
12240.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12241Results of DKIM verification.
12242For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12243
12244.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12245 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12246 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12247 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12248 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12249 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12250 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12251 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12252 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12253 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12254 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12255 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12256 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12257 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12258 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12259 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12260 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12261 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12262 &$dkim_key_length$&
12263These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12264For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12265
12266.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12267.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12268When a message has been received this variable contains
12269a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12270For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12271
12272.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12273 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12274 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12275 &$dnslist_value$&
12276.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12277.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12278.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12279.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12280.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12281When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12282the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12283looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12284main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12285
12286.vitem &$domain$&
12287.vindex "&$domain$&"
12288When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12289contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12290case for &$domain$&.
12291
12292Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12293&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12294is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12295message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12296
12297When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12298RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12299have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12300at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12301the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12302which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12303
12304.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12305At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12306set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12307
12308The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12309
12310.ilist
12311When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12312the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12313&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12314normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12315is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12316&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12317the &(smtp)& transport.
12318
12319.next
12320When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12321&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12322it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12323rewrite domains by file lookup.
12324
12325.next
12326With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12327&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12328a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12329is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12330that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12331recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12332
12333.next
12334.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12335.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12336When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12337the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12338.endlist
12339
12340.new
12341.cindex "tainted data"
12342If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12343the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12344When un untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12345looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12346See also &$domain_data$&.
12347.wen
12348
12349
12350.vitem &$domain_data$&
12351.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12352When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12353means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12354of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12355address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12356transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12357used.
12358
12359&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12360domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12361the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12362to nothing.
12363
12364.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12365.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12366This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12367
12368.vitem &$exim_path$&
12369.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12370This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12371
12372.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12373.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12374This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12375
12376.vitem &$exim_version$&
12377.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12378This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12379The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12380Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12381There may be other characters following the minor version.
12382This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12383
12384.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12385This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12386inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12387be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12388characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12389See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12390
12391.vitem &$headers_added$&
12392.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12393Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12394the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12395The headers are a newline-separated list.
12396
12397.vitem &$home$&
12398.vindex "&$home$&"
12399When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12400directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12401means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12402explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12403by a setting on the transport itself.
12404
12405When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12406of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12407&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12408
12409.vitem &$host$&
12410.vindex "&$host$&"
12411If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12412list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12413to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12414to local and remote transports.
12415
12416.cindex "transport" "filter"
12417.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12418For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12419&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12420particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12421using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12422&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12423is connected.
12424
12425When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12426&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12427client is connected.
12428
12429
12430.vitem &$host_address$&
12431.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12432This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12433for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12434when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12435
12436.vitem &$host_data$&
12437.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12438If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12439result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12440allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12441.code
12442deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12443message = $host_data
12444.endd
12445.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12446.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12447.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12448This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12449message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12450name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12451variables is set to &"1"&.
12452
12453.ilist
12454If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12455succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12456
12457.next
12458If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12459tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12460lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12461.endlist ilist
12462
12463Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12464single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12465names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12466is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12467&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12468IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12469sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12470lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12471the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12472&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12473
12474.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12475Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12476&%authresults%& expansion item.
12477
12478
12479.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12480.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12481See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12482
12483.vitem &$host_port$&
12484.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12485This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12486for an outbound connection.
12487
12488.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12489.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12490This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12491directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12492working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12493to &$spool_directory$& later.
12494
12495.vitem &$inode$&
12496.vindex "&$inode$&"
12497The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12498option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12499of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12500a unique name for the file.
12501
12502.vitem &$interface_address$&
12503.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12504This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12505
12506.vitem &$interface_port$&
12507.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12508This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12509
12510.vitem &$item$&
12511.vindex "&$item$&"
12512This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12513conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12514&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12515empty.
12516
12517.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12518.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12519This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12520contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12521lookup.
12522
12523.vitem &$load_average$&
12524.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12525This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12526is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12527variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12528
12529.vitem &$local_part$&
12530.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12531When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12532variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12533delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12534session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12535
12536Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12537&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12538&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12539because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12540once.
12541
12542.new
12543.cindex "tainted data"
12544If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12545the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12546
12547&*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12548attacker.
12549Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12550for file access.
12551This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12552For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12553&$local_part_verified$& variable rather than this one.
12554For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12555which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12556rather than this variable.
12557If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12558the retrieved data.
12559.wen
12560
12561.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12562.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
12563.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12564.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
12565.cindex affix variables
12566If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12567value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12568any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12569&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12570.new
12571If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12572the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12573&$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate.
12574.wen
12575
12576When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12577result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12578the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12579&$address_pipe$&).
12580
12581When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12582local part of the recipient address.
12583
12584When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12585&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12586it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12587
12588In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12589the addresses
12590.code
12591"abc:xyz"@test.example
12592abc\:xyz@test.example
12593.endd
12594the value of &$local_part$& is
12595.code
12596abc:xyz
12597.endd
12598If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12599inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12600have:
12601.code
12602data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12603.endd
12604&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12605to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12606&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12607
12608.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12609.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12610When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12611lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12612router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12613to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12614handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12615
12616&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12617matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12618available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12619variable expands to nothing.
12620
12621.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12622.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12623.cindex affix variables
12624When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12625specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12626variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12627
12628.new
12629.vitem &$local_part_prefix_v$&
12630.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
12631When &$local_part_prefix$& is valid and the prefix match used a wildcard,
12632the portion matching the wildcard is available in this variable.
12633.wen
12634
12635.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12636.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12637When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12638specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12639variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12640
12641.new
12642.vitem &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12643.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
12644When &$local_part_suffix$& is valid and the suffix match used a wildcard,
12645the portion matching the wildcard is available in this variable.
12646.wen
12647
12648.new
12649.vitem &$local_part_verified$&
12650.vindex "&$local_part_verified$&"
12651If the router generic option &%check_local_part%& has run successfully,
12652this variable has the user database version of &$local_part$&.
12653Such values are not tainted and hence usable for building file names.
12654.wen
12655
12656.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12657.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12658This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12659a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12660
12661.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12662.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12663See &$local_user_uid$&.
12664
12665.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12666.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12667This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12668&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12669are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12670and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12671router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12672are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12673
12674.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12675.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12676This contains the expanded value of the
12677&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12678been read.
12679
12680.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12681.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12682The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12683log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12684referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12685the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12686
12687.vitem &$log_space$&
12688.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12689The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12690partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12691whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12692ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12693the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12694
12695
12696.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12697.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12698This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12699a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12700.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12701It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12702&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12703and &"yes"& if it was.
12704Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12705the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12706as authenticated data.
12707
12708.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12709.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12710This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12711&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12712&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12713contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12714without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12715variable is empty.
12716
12717.vitem &$malware_name$&
12718.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12719This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12720content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12721when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12722
12723.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12724.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12725.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12726.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12727This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12728received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12729character(s).
12730It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12731
12732.vitem &$message_age$&
12733.cindex "message" "age of"
12734.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12735This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12736of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12737delivery attempt.
12738
12739.vitem &$message_body$&
12740.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12741.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12742.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12743.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12744.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12745This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12746being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12747number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12748&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12749
12750.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12751By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12752easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12753this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12754zeros are always converted into spaces.
12755
12756.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12757.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12758.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12759.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12760This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12761body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12762&$message_body$&.
12763
12764.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12765.cindex "body of message" "size"
12766.cindex "message body" "size"
12767.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12768When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12769in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12770separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12771also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12772
12773If the spool file is wireformat
12774(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12775the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12776
12777.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12778.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12779When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12780unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12781An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12782received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12783line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12784&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12785
12786.vitem &$message_headers$&
12787.vindex &$message_headers$&
12788This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12789is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12790lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12791same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12792
12793.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12794.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12795This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12796contents of header lines is done.
12797
12798.vitem &$message_id$&
12799This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12800
12801.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12802.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12803This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12804message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12805During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12806number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12807routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12808&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12809lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12810from the body is not counted.
12811
12812As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12813appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12814&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12815file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12816header and the body).
12817
12818Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12819.code
12820deny message = Too many lines in message header
12821 condition = \
12822 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12823.endd
12824In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12825message has not yet been received.
12826
12827This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12828
12829.vitem &$message_size$&
12830.cindex "size" "of message"
12831.cindex "message" "size"
12832.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12833When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12834most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12835message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12836deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12837expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12838doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12839precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12840&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12841
12842.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12843While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12844contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12845value may not, of course, be truthful.
12846
12847.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12848A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12849available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12850details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12851
12852.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12853These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12854of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12855
12856.vitem &$original_domain$&
12857.vindex "&$domain$&"
12858.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12859When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12860same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12861generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12862variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12863differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12864aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12865single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12866
12867If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12868filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12869part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12870
12871.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12872.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12873.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12874When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12875same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12876local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12877part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12878filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12879the original address.
12880
12881If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12882case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12883This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12884one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12885delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12886
12887If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12888filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12889part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12890
12891.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12892.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12893.cindex "sender" "gid"
12894.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12895.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12896This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12897message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12898gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12899normally the gid of the Exim user.
12900
12901.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12902.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12903.cindex "sender" "uid"
12904.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12905.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12906The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12907messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12908For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12909user.
12910
12911.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12912.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12913This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12914above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12915
12916.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12917.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12918This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12919(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12920
12921.vitem &$pid$&
12922.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12923.vindex "&$pid$&"
12924This variable contains the current process id.
12925
12926.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12927.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12928.cindex "transport" "filter"
12929.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12930This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12931&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12932&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12933(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12934It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12935variable"& error if encountered.
12936
12937.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12938.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12939This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12940configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12941a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12942&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12943qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12944
12945
12946.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12947 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12948 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12949 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12950 &$proxy_session$&
12951These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12952or SOCKS5 support.
12953For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12954
12955.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12956.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12957This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12958current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12959
12960.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12961This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12962which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12963&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12964
12965.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12966This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12967which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12968&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12969
12970.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12971This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12972which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12973&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12974
12975.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12976.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12977The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12978
12979.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12980.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12981The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12982or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12983
12984.vitem &$queue_name$&
12985.vindex &$queue_name$&
12986.cindex "named queues" variable
12987.cindex queues named
12988The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12989
12990.vitem &$queue_size$&
12991.vindex "&$queue_size$&"
12992.cindex "queue" "size of"
12993.cindex "spool" "number of messages"
12994This variable contains the number of messages queued.
12995It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
12996
12997.vitem &$r_...$&
12998.vindex &$r_...$&
12999.cindex router variables
13000Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13001They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13002The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13003and the eventual transport.
13004
13005.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13006.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13007When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13008RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13009RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13010
13011.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13012.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13013.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13014When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13015RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13016temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13017
13018.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13019.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13020When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13021RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13022permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13023
13024.vitem &$received_count$&
13025.vindex "&$received_count$&"
13026This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13027including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13028is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13029delivering.
13030
13031.vitem &$received_for$&
13032.vindex "&$received_for$&"
13033If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13034variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13035built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13036the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13037
13038.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
13039.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13040As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
13041variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
13042is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
13043&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13044the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13045option.
13046
13047As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13048could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13049on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13050values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13051messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13052time.
13053For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13054
13055.vitem &$received_port$&
13056.vindex "&$received_port$&"
13057See &$received_ip_address$&.
13058
13059.vitem &$received_protocol$&
13060.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13061When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13062protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13063by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13064&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13065(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13066is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13067connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13068
13069Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13070automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13071&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13072encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13073where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13074STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13075
13076The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13077messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13078identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13079
13080.vitem &$received_time$&
13081.vindex "&$received_time$&"
13082This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13083as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13084
13085.vitem &$recipient_data$&
13086.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13087This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13088condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13089until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13090.display
13091&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13092&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13093.endd
13094&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13095method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13096The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13097expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13098
13099.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13100.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13101In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13102information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13103
13104.ilist
13105&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13106was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13107
13108.next
13109&"route"&: Routing failed.
13110
13111.next
13112&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13113or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13114MAIL).
13115
13116.next
13117&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13118.next
13119
13120&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13121.endlist
13122
13123The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13124rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13125
13126.vitem &$recipients$&
13127.vindex "&$recipients$&"
13128This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
13129a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
13130is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13131unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
13132cases:
13133
13134.olist
13135In a system filter file.
13136.next
13137In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13138is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13139&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13140&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13141.next
13142From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13143.endlist
13144
13145
13146.vitem &$recipients_count$&
13147.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13148When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13149envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13150from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13151increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13152
13153
13154.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13155.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13156This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13157&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13158
13159.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13160.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13161When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13162these variables contain the
13163captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13164
13165
13166.vitem &$reply_address$&
13167.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
13168When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13169&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13170contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13171white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13172decoding or character code translation takes place.
13173
13174.vitem &$return_path$&
13175.vindex "&$return_path$&"
13176When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13177the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13178in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13179same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13180mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13181for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13182address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13183that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13184the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13185envelope sender.
13186
13187.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13188.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13189This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13190
13191.vitem &$router_name$&
13192.cindex "router" "name"
13193.cindex "name" "of router"
13194.vindex "&$router_name$&"
13195During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13196
13197.vitem &$runrc$&
13198.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13199.vindex "&$runrc$&"
13200This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13201&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13202assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13203preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13204reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13205another.
13206
13207.vitem &$self_hostname$&
13208.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13209.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13210When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13211local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13212One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13213happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13214original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13215
13216.vitem &$sender_address$&
13217.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13218When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13219that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13220is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13221value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13222
13223.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13224.vindex "&$address_data$&"
13225.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13226If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13227sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13228distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13229after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13230longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13231
13232.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13233.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13234The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13235
13236.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13237.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13238The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13239
13240.vitem &$sender_data$&
13241.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13242This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13243in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13244value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13245this:
13246.display
13247&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13248&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13249.endd
13250&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13251method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13252The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13253expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13254
13255.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13256.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13257When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13258name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13259brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13260enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13261issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13262looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13263&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13264start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13265verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13266the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13267the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13268
13269.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13270.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13271This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13272.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13273done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13274
13275.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13276.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13277When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13278command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13279set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13280the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13281
13282.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13283.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13284When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13285this variable contains that
13286host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13287
13288.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13289.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13290This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13291driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13292received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13293&$authenticated_id$&.
13294
13295.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13296.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13297If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13298(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13299otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13300resolver library states that both
13301the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13302other times, this variable is false.
13303
13304.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13305It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13306library, by setting:
13307.code
13308dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13309.endd
13310
13311.new
13312In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13313default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13314This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13315Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13316glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13317&_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13318.code
13319options trust-ad
13320.endd
13321.wen
13322
13323Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13324validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13325
13326If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13327mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13328
13329This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13330DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13331all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13332is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13333
13334
13335.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13336.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13337When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13338host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13339other means, this variable is empty.
13340
13341.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13342If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13343&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13344A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13345via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13346any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13347&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13348
13349.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13350However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13351DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13352&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13353
13354Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13355host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13356in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13357is set to &"1"&.
13358
13359Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13360maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13361these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13362following are true:
13363
13364.ilist
13365A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13366.next
13367The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13368configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13369to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13370.next
13371Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13372that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13373&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13374.next
13375The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13376In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13377EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13378.next
13379The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13380domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13381. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13382. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13383.code
13384 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13385.endd
13386which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13387IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13388.endlist
13389
13390
13391.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13392.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13393When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13394number that was used on the remote host.
13395
13396.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13397.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13398When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13399identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13400been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13401called Exim.
13402
13403.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13404A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13405&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13406&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13407
13408.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13409.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13410.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13411.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13412This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13413either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13414there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13415there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13416the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13417followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13418first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13419the parentheses.
13420
13421There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13422was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13423address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13424all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13425into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13426
13427.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13428.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13429In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13430about the failure. The details are the same as for
13431&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13432
13433.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13434.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13435This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13436been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13437used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13438on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13439connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13440
13441.vitem &$sending_port$&
13442.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13443This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13444been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13445connections, see &$received_port$&.
13446
13447.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13448.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13449During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13450host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13451&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13452value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13453
13454.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13455.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13456During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13457entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13458the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13459.code
13460MAIL FROM:<>
13461MAIL FROM: <>
13462.endd
13463For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13464command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13465rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13466the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13467
13468.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13469.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13470.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13471While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13472argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13473space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13474somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13475
13476.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13477.cindex SMTP "command history"
13478.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13479A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13480received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13481are remembered.
13482
13483.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13484.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13485This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13486daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13487in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13488connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13489the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13490never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13491there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13492single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13493daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13494
13495.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13496These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13497that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13498filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13499example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13500message is junk mail.
13501
13502.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13503A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13504is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13505&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13506
13507.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13508 &$spf_received$& &&&
13509 &$spf_result$& &&&
13510 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13511 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13512These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13513For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13514
13515.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13516.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13517The name of Exim's spool directory.
13518
13519.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13520.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13521The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13522being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13523If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13524is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13525
13526.vitem &$spool_space$&
13527.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13528The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13529Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13530variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13531find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13532value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13533megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13534.code
13535condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13536.endd
13537See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13538
13539
13540.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13541.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13542This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13543command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13544command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13545interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13546
13547.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13548.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13549Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13550on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13551this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13552If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13553The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13554when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13555
13556The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13557except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13558the outbound.
13559
13560.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13561.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13562Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13563on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13564this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13565If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13566
13567.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13568.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13569.cindex certificate variables
13570This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13571inbound connection when the message was received.
13572It is only useful as the argument of a
13573&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13574or a &%def%& condition.
13575
13576&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13577when a list of more than one
13578file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13579The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13580
13581.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13582.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13583This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13584inbound connection when the message was received.
13585It is only useful as the argument of a
13586&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13587or a &%def%& condition.
13588If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13589which is not the leaf.
13590
13591.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13592.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13593This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13594outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13595&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13596or a &%def%& condition.
13597
13598.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13599.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13600This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13601outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13602&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13603or a &%def%& condition.
13604If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13605which is not the leaf.
13606
13607.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13608.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13609This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13610message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13611
13612The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13613except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13614the outbound.
13615
13616.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13617.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13618This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13619outbound SMTP connection was made,
13620and &"0"& otherwise.
13621
13622.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13623.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13624.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13625When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13626connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13627example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13628received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13629&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13630non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13631
13632The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13633but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13634becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13635
13636.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13637.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13638As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13639
13640.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13641.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13642This variable is
13643cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13644and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13645&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13646details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13647
13648.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13649.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13650As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13651
13652.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13653.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13654DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13655
13656.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13657.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13658When a message is received from a remote client connection
13659the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13660.code
136610 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
136621 No response to request
136632 Response not verified
136643 Verification failed
136654 Verification succeeded
13666.endd
13667
13668.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13669.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13670When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13671the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13672See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13673
13674.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13675.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13676.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13677.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13678When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13679connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13680the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13681&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13682If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13683which is not the leaf.
13684
13685The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13686except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13687the outbound.
13688
13689.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13690.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13691When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13692connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13693the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13694&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13695If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13696which is not the leaf.
13697
13698.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13699.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13700.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13701.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13702When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13703Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13704If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13705some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13706will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13707a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13708used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13709
13710The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13711except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13712the outbound.
13713
13714.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13715.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13716.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13717During outbound
13718SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13719the transport.
13720
13721.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13722.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13723Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13724
13725.vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13726.vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13727When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13728this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13729
13730.vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13731.vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13732When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13733this variable is set to the protocol version.
13734
13735
13736.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13737.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13738The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13739files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13740
13741.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13742.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13743The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13744
13745.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13746.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13747The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13748
13749.vitem &$tod_full$&
13750.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13751A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13752+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13753positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13754values for those that are behind (west).
13755
13756.vitem &$tod_log$&
13757.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13758The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
137591995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13760
13761.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13762.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13763This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13764is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13765flag.
13766
13767.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13768.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13769This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13770-0500.
13771
13772.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13773.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13774This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13775by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13776
13777.vitem &$transport_name$&
13778.cindex "transport" "name"
13779.cindex "name" "of transport"
13780.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13781During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13782
13783.vitem &$value$&
13784.vindex "&$value$&"
13785This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13786or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13787&*reduce*& expansion.
13788
13789.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13790.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13791While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13792contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13793Otherwise, empty.
13794
13795.vitem &$version_number$&
13796.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13797The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13798by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13799
13800.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13801.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13802This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13803delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13804
13805.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13806.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13807This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13808delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13809.endlist
13810.ecindex IIDstrexp
13811
13812
13813
13814. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13815. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13816
13817.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13818.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13819Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13820Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13821use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13822your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13823the line
13824.code
13825EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13826.endd
13827in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13828
13829
13830.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13831.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13832Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13833&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13834no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13835interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13836the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13837option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13838a newly created Perl interpreter.
13839
13840The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13841need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13842should usually be something like
13843.code
13844perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13845.endd
13846where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13847use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13848soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13849the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13850its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13851fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13852necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13853the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13854two ways:
13855
13856.ilist
13857.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13858Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13859a startup when Exim is entered.
13860.next
13861The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13862overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13863.endlist
13864
13865There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13866initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13867
13868.ilist
13869.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13870.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13871To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13872interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13873taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13874option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13875defaults to false.
13876
13877
13878.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13879When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13880of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13881by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13882forms:
13883.code
13884${perl{foo}}
13885${perl{foo}{argument}}
13886${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13887.endd
13888which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13889arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13890with an error message of the form
13891.code
13892Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13893.endd
13894The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13895it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13896return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13897an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13898by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13899that was passed to &%die%&.
13900
13901
13902.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13903Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13904is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13905the Perl code
13906.code
13907my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13908.endd
13909makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13910Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13911&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13912
13913If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13914&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13915expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13916an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13917
13918.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13919.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13920Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13921&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13922debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13923&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13924timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13925
13926
13927.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13928.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13929You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13930Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13931before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13932SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13933is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13934error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13935avoided, but the output is lost.
13936
13937.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13938The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13939Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13940you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13941output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13942change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13943For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13944.code
13945$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13946.endd
13947Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13948example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13949include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13950as the first subroutine argument.
13951.ecindex IIDperl
13952
13953
13954. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13955. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13956
13957.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13958 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13959 "Starting the daemon"
13960.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13961.cindex "interface" "listening"
13962.cindex "network interface"
13963.cindex "interface" "network"
13964.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13965.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13966.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13967.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13968A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13969hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13970or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13971works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13972In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13973IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13974knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13975
13976.olist
13977When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13978and ports to listen on.
13979.next
13980When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13981are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13982processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13983same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13984when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13985local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13986option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13987as an error situation.
13988.next
13989When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13990for the outgoing connection.
13991.endlist
13992
13993
13994Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13995of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13996addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13997standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13998rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13999
14000In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14001interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14002options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14003chapter describes how they operate.
14004
14005When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14006actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14007
14008
14009
14010.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14011When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14012option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14013following options:
14014
14015.ilist
14016&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14017or service names.
14018(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14019.next
14020&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14021listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14022.endlist
14023
14024The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14025described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14026it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14027colons. For example:
14028.code
14029local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14030 192.168.23.65 ; \
14031 ::1 ; \
14032 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14033.endd
14034There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14035in &%local_interfaces%&:
14036
14037.olist
14038The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14039on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14040.code
14041local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14042 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14043.endd
14044.next
14045The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14046with a colon separator, for example:
14047.code
14048local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14049 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14050.endd
14051.endlist
14052
14053When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14054default setting contains just one port:
14055.code
14056daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14057.endd
14058If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14059specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14060&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14061&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14062IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14063
14064
14065
14066.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14067The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14068as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14069case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14070instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14071default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14072.code
14073local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14074.endd
14075when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14076.code
14077local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14078.endd
14079Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14080
14081
14082
14083.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14084The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14085&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14086instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14087option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14088the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14089exim.
14090
14091The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14092changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14093If there are any items that do not
14094contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14095&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14096items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14097replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14098.code
14099-oX 1225
14100.endd
14101overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14102whereas
14103.code
14104-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14105.endd
14106overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14107(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14108value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14109
14110
14111
14112.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14113.cindex "submissions protocol"
14114.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14115.cindex "smtps protocol"
14116.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14117.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14118Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14119&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14120For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14121STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14122the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14123If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14124(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14125the 465 TCP ports.
14126
14127If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14128service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14129proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14130
14131The common use of this option is expected to be
14132.code
14133tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14134.endd
14135per RFC 8314.
14136There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14137to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14138
14139&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14140daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14141&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14142because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14143connections via the daemon.)
14144
14145
14146
14147
14148.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14149.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14150IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14151can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14152interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14153address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14154percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14155adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14156.code
14157fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14158.endd
14159To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14160allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14161to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14162percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14163address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14164&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14165.code
14166IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14167.endd
14168is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14169Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14170instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14171function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14172&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14173
14174.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14175.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14176Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14177run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14178using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14179connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14180.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14181&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14182activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14183that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14184etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14185to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14186
14187On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14188disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14189option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14190and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14191IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14192
14193
14194
14195.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14196The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14197.code
14198daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14199local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14200.endd
14201This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14202Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14203the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14204read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14205
14206To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14207.code
14208daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14209.endd
14210(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14211.code
14212local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14213 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14214.endd
14215To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14216IPv4 loopback address only:
14217.code
14218local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14219.endd
14220To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14221.code
14222local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14223.endd
14224&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14225
14226
14227
14228.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14229The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14230whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14231addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14232treated as local.
14233
14234For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14235the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14236available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14237(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14238
14239Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14240many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14241email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14242interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14243&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14244&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14245used for listening. Consider this example:
14246.code
14247local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14248 192.168.53.235 ; \
14249 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14250
14251extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14252.endd
14253The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14254address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14255Exim is routing.
14256
14257In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14258address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14259desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14260these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14261This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14262during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14263host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14264addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14265
14266
14267
14268.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14269Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14270allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14271there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14272&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14273description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14274details.
14275
14276
14277
14278
14279. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14280. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14281
14282.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14283.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14284.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14285The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14286
14287.ilist
14288Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14289&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14290.next
14291Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14292&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14293section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14294.next
14295Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14296(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14297&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14298only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14299settings.
14300.endlist
14301
14302This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14303types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14304in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14305are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14306an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14307listed in more than one group.
14308
14309.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14310.table2
14311.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14312.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14313.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14314.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14315.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14316.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14317.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14318.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14319.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14320.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14321.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14322.endtable
14323
14324
14325.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14326.table2
14327.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14328.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14329.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14330.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14331.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14332.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14333.endtable
14334
14335
14336
14337.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14338.table2
14339.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14340.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14341.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14342.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14343.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14344.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14345.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14346.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14347.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14348.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14349.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14350.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14351.endtable
14352
14353
14354
14355.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14356.table2
14357.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14358.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14359.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14360.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14361.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14362.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14363.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14364.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14365.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14366.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14367.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14368.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14369.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14370.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14371.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14372.endtable
14373
14374
14375
14376.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14377.table2
14378.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14379.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14380.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14381.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14382.endtable
14383
14384
14385
14386.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14387.table2
14388.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14389.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14390.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14391.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14392.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14393.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14394.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14395.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14396.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14397.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14398.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14399.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14400.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14401.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14402.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14403.endtable
14404
14405
14406
14407.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14408.table2
14409.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14410.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14411.endtable
14412
14413
14414
14415.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14416.table2
14417.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14418.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14419.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14420.endtable
14421
14422
14423
14424.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14425.table2
14426.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14427.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14428.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14429.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14430.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14431.row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14432.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14433.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14434.endtable
14435
14436
14437
14438.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14439.table2
14440.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14441.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14442.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14443.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14444.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14445.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14446.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14447.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14448.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14449.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14450.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14451.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14452.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14453.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14454.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14455.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14456 connection"
14457.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14458.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14459.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14460.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14461.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14462.endtable
14463
14464
14465
14466.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14467.table2
14468.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14469.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14470.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14471.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14472.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14473.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14474.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14475.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14476.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14477.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14478.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14479.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14480.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14481.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14482.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14483.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14484.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14485.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14486.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14487.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14488.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14489.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14490 words""&"
14491.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14492.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14493.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14494.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14495.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14496.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14497.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14498.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14499.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14500.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14501.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14502.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14503.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14504.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14505.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14506.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14507.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14508.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14509.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14510.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14511.endtable
14512
14513
14514
14515.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14516.table2
14517.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14518 item"
14519.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14520 item"
14521.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14522.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14523.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14524.endtable
14525
14526
14527
14528.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14529.table2
14530.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14531.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14532.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14533.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14534.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14535.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14536.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14537.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14538.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14539.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14540.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14541.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14542.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14543.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14544.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14545.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14546.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14547.endtable
14548
14549
14550
14551.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14552.table2
14553.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14554.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14555.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14556.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14557.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14558.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14559.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14560.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14561.endtable
14562
14563
14564
14565.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14566.table2
14567.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14568.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14569.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14570.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14571.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14572.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14573.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14574.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14575.endtable
14576
14577
14578
14579
14580.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14581.table2
14582.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14583.endtable
14584
14585
14586
14587
14588
14589.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14590See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14591
14592.table2
14593.row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14594.row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14595.row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14596.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14597.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14598.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14599.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14600.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14601.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14602.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14603.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14604.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14605.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14606.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14607.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14608.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14609.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14610.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14611 connection"
14612.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14613.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14614.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14615.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14616.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14617.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14618.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14619.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14620.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14621.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14622.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14623.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14624.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14625.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14626.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14627.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14628.endtable
14629
14630
14631
14632.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14633.table2
14634.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14635.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14636.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14637.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14638.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14639.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14640.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14641.row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14642.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14643.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14644.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14645.endtable
14646
14647
14648
14649.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14650.table2
14651.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14652.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14653.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14654.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14655 words""&"
14656.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14657.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14658.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14659.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14660.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14661.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14662.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14663.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14664.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14665.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14666.endtable
14667
14668
14669
14670.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14671.table2
14672.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14673.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14674 directory"
14675.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14676.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14677.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14678.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14679.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14680.endtable
14681
14682
14683
14684.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14685.table2
14686.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14687.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14688.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14689.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14690.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14691.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14692.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14693.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14694.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14695.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14696.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14697.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14698.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14699.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14700.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14701.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14702.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14703.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14704.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14705.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14706.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14707.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14708.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14709.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14710.endtable
14711
14712
14713
14714.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14715.table2
14716.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14717.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14718.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14719.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14720.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14721.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14722.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14723.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14724.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14725.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14726.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14727.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14728.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14729.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14730.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14731.endtable
14732
14733
14734
14735.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14736Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14737&dagger;.
14738
14739.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14740.cindex "8BITMIME"
14741.cindex "8-bit characters"
14742.cindex "log" "selectors"
14743.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14744This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14745EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14746However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14747takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14748
14749Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14750feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14751It now defaults to true.
14752A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14753.display
14754&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14755.endd
14756
14757To log received 8BITMIME status use
14758.code
14759log_selector = +8bitmime
14760.endd
14761
14762.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14763.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14764.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14765This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14766read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14767further details.
14768
14769.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14770This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14771messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14772SMTP messages.
14773
14774.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14775.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14776.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14777This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14778non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14779
14780.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14781.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14782.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14783This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14784received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14785
14786.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14787.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14788This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14789See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14790
14791.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14792.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14793This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14794processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14795acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14796
14797.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14798.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14799.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14800.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14801.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14802This option defines the ACL that,
14803if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14804is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14805processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14806acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14807
14808.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14809.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14810This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14811(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14812of a received message.
14813See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14814
14815.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14816.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14817This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14818received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14819
14820.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14821.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14822This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14823received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14824
14825.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14826.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14827.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14828This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14829command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14830
14831
14832.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14833.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14834This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14835received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14836
14837.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14838.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14839This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14840a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14841&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14842
14843.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14844.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14845This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14846extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14847section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14848
14849.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14850.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14851This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14852ends without a QUIT command being received.
14853See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14854
14855.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14856This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14857received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14858further details.
14859
14860.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14861.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14862This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14863received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14864
14865.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14866.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14867This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14868received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14869
14870.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14871.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14872This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14873received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14874
14875.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14876.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14877This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14878received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14879
14880.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14881.cindex "environment" "set values"
14882This option adds individual environment variables that the
14883currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14884Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14885
14886See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14887
14888.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14889.cindex "admin user"
14890This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14891current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14892colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14893programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14894admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14895not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14896To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14897
14898.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14899.cindex "domain literal"
14900If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14901email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14902format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14903has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14904
14905Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14906format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14907addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14908&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14909domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14910configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14911the local host's IP addresses.
14912
14913
14914.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14915.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14916It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14917and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14918MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14919that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14920practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14921&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14922recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14923
14924.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14925.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14926.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14927Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14928camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14929that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14930This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14931
14932If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14933UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14934letters, digits, and hyphens.
14935
14936If Exim is built with internationalization support
14937and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14938this option can be left as default.
14939Without that,
14940if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14941adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14942suitable setting is:
14943.code
14944dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14945 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14946.endd
14947Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14948.code
14949dns_check_names_pattern =
14950.endd
14951That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14952
14953
14954.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14955.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14956.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14957If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14958response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14959Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14960Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14961advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14962authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14963&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14964authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14965
14966Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14967and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14968not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14969authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14970to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14971which Exim advertises AUTH.
14972
14973.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14974If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14975is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14976option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14977.code
14978auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14979.endd
14980.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14981If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14982the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14983expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14984
14985
14986.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14987.cindex "thawing messages"
14988.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14989If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14990new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14991this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14992being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14993saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14994
14995&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14996&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14997thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14998
14999
15000.option av_scanner main string "see below"
15001This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15002It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15003.code
15004sophie:/var/run/sophie
15005.endd
15006If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15007before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15008
15009
15010.option bi_command main string unset
15011.oindex "&%-bi%&"
15012This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15013the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15014just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15015required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15016
15017
15018.option bounce_message_file main string unset
15019.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15020.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15021This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15022for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15023chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15024
15025
15026.option bounce_message_text main string unset
15027When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15028message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15029delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15030
15031.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15032.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15033This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15034bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15035causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15036value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15037message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15038error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15039point at which the error was detected are returned.
15040.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15041
15042.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15043.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15044.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15045.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15046This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15047that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15048when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15049The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15050If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15051treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15052
15053The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15054during reception of a message.
15055In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15056
15057The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15058
15059
15060.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15061If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15062bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15063&%bounce_return_body%&.
15064
15065
15066.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15067.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15068.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15069.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15070This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15071senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15072limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15073any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15074that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15075
15076When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15077greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15078added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15079to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15080size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15081messages.
15082
15083.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15084.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15085.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15086.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15087This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15088bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15089connection. A typical setting might be:
15090.code
15091bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15092.endd
15093which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15094.code
15095MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15096.endd
15097The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15098address.
15099
15100.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15101.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15102.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15103This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15104domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15105section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15106
15107
15108.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15109This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15110domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15111section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15112
15113
15114.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15115This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15116address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15117section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15118
15119
15120.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15121This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15122address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15123section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15124
15125
15126.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15127This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15128callout verification. The default value is
15129.code
15130$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15131.endd
15132See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15133
15134
15135.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
15136See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15137
15138
15139.option check_log_space main integer 10M
15140See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15141
15142.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15143.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15144.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15145RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15146system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15147word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15148multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15149exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15150of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15151set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15152
15153
15154.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15155See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15156
15157
15158.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15159.cindex "checking disk space"
15160.cindex "disk space, checking"
15161.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15162The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15163message is accepted.
15164
15165.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15166.vindex "&$log_space$&"
15167.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15168.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15169When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15170want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15171testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15172&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15173
15174
15175&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15176either value is greater than zero, for example:
15177.code
15178check_spool_space = 100M
15179check_spool_inodes = 100
15180.endd
15181The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15182SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15183transit.
15184
15185&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15186files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15187&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15188
15189If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15190incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15191error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15192SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15193&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15194&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15195
15196The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15197number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15198If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15199
15200For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15201failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15202it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15203
15204There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15205Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15206high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15207may wish to deliberately disable them.
15208
15209.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15210.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15211.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15212The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15213these hosts.
15214Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15215
15216.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15217.cindex "restricting access to features"
15218This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15219administrative user.
15220This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15221
15222.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15223.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15224.cindex memory debugging
15225This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15226management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15227it should normally be left as default.
15228
15229.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15230.cindex "port" "for daemon"
15231.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15232This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15233listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15234backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15235
15236.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15237.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15238This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15239the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15240(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15241defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15242&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15243
15244.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15245See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15246
15247.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15248.cindex "warning of delay"
15249.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15250.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15251When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15252intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15253after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15254string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15255message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15256between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15257with
15258.code
15259delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15260.endd
15261the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15262the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15263because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15264just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15265.code
15266delay_warning = 6h
15267.endd
15268messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15269a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15270.code
15271delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15272.endd
15273Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15274which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15275Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15276
15277.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15278.vindex "&$domain$&"
15279The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15280deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15281expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15282forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15283&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15284not sent. The default is:
15285.code
15286delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15287 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15288 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15289 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15290 } {no}{yes}}
15291.endd
15292This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15293&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15294&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15295&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15296
15297.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15298.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15299.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15300If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15301delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15302the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15303of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15304chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15305
15306.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15307.cindex "load average"
15308.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15309When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15310becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15311ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15312See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15313
15314
15315.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15316.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15317Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15318message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15319handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15320should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15321removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15322occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15323
15324.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15325.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15326This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15327ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15328a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15329build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15330really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15331distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15332
15333When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15334updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15335such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15336Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15337
15338
15339.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15340.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15341If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15342activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15343that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15344etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15345to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15346
15347
15348.new
15349.option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15350.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15351This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15352.wen
15353and an order of processing.
15354Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15355
15356Acceptable values include:
15357.code
15358sha1
15359sha256
15360sha512
15361.endd
15362
15363Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15364
15365.option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15366This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15367and an order of processing.
15368Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15369
15370
15371.new
15372.option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15373This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15374The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15375Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15376
15377The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15378.wen
15379
15380.option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15381If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15382first success.
15383
15384.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15385.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15386This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15387It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15388the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15389See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15390
15391
15392.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15393.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15394DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15395&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15396keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15397incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15398may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15399anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15400This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15401by a setting such as this:
15402.code
15403dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15404.endd
15405This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15406&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15407since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15408&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15409when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15410options are applied after this global option.
15411
15412.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15413.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15414When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15415names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15416the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15417contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15418a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15419done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15420value of this option. The default pattern is
15421.code
15422dns_check_names_pattern = \
15423 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15424.endd
15425which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15426they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15427permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15428accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15429&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15430empty string.
15431
15432.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15433This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15434DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15435
15436.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15437This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15438reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15439section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15440
15441.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15442.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15443This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15444not do it internally.
15445As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15446If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15447
15448The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15449thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15450given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15451
15452
15453.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15454.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15455.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15456If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15457DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15458default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15459
15460If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15461
15462.new
15463On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15464will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15465This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15466Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15467glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15468&_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15469.code
15470options trust-ad
15471.endd
15472.wen
15473
15474
15475.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15476.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15477.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15478.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15479When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15480looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15481(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15482domain matches this list.
15483
15484This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15485not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15486servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15487Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15488this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15489only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15490
15491
15492.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15493.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15494.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15495.cindex "DNS" timeout
15496The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15497retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15498defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15499time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15500totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15501take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15502parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15503but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15504to set in them.
15505See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15506
15507
15508.option dns_retry main integer 0
15509See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15510
15511
15512.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15513.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15514.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15515If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15516(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15517DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15518match with this expanded domain list.
15519
15520Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15521authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15522bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15523mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15524Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15525a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15526
15527Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15528to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15529zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15530
15531If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15532in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15533authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15534authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15535record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15536
15537.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15538.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15539.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15540.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15541.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15542If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15543DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15544the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15545on.
15546
15547If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15548
15549OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15550means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15551is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15552
15553
15554.option drop_cr main boolean false
15555This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15556handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15557described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15558
15559.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15560.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15561.cindex "DSN" "success"
15562.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15563DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15564and accepted from, these hosts.
15565Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15566and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15567A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15568A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15569are sent.
15570
15571.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15572.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15573.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15574This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15575bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15576Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15577.code
15578dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15579.endd
15580The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15581panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15582
15583.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15584.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15585Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15586message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15587handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15588message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15589be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15590the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15591delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15592
15593
15594.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15595.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15596.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15597Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15598generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15599coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15600items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15601a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15602must be enclosed in double quotes.
15603
15604Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15605(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15606the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15607items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15608are examined. For example:
15609.code
15610errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15611 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15612 postmaster@mydomain.example
15613.endd
15614.vindex "&$domain$&"
15615.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15616The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15617and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15618there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15619.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15620variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15621
15622
15623.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15624.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15625By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15626.display
15627&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15628.endd
15629.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15630where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15631A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15632&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15633overrides the default.
15634
15635Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15636&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15637and warning messages. For example:
15638.code
15639errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15640.endd
15641The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15642address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15643&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15644own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15645not used.
15646
15647
15648.option event_action main string&!! unset
15649.cindex events
15650This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15651For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15652
15653
15654.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15655.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15656.cindex "Exim group"
15657This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15658privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15659option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15660of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15661configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15662security issues.
15663
15664
15665.option exim_path main string "see below"
15666.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15667This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15668needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15669the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15670is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15671other place.
15672&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15673you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15674where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15675settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15676
15677
15678.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15679.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15680.cindex "Exim user"
15681This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15682privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15683time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15684options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15685
15686Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15687&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15688not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15689used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15690
15691
15692.option exim_version main string "current version"
15693.cindex "Exim version"
15694.cindex customizing "version number"
15695.cindex "version number of Exim" override
15696This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15697various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15698
15699
15700.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15701This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15702routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15703&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15704
15705
15706. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15707. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15708
15709.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15710 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15711.oindex "&%-t%&"
15712.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15713.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15714According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15715are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15716envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15717line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15718behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15719command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15720&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15721argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15722addresses.
15723
15724
15725.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15726.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15727On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15728distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15729related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15730Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15731errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15732many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15733retries.
15734
15735.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15736You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15737a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15738search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15739
15740
15741
15742.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15743.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15744On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15745ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15746delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15747&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15748feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15749warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15750freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15751is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15752supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15753message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15754freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15755log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15756logging that you require.
15757
15758
15759.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15760.cindex "HP-UX"
15761.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15762Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15763password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15764looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15765headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15766of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15767it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15768upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15769
15770When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15771expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15772login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15773user's name.
15774
15775.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15776Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15777pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15778name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15779.code
15780gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15781gecos_name = $1
15782.endd
15783
15784.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15785See &%gecos_name%& above.
15786
15787
15788.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15789This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15790server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15791implementations of TLS.
15792
15793
15794.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15795This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15796the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15797
15798See
15799&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15800for documentation.
15801
15802
15803
15804.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15805This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15806&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15807default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15808ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15809insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15810
15811
15812
15813.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15814.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15815.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15816This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15817section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15818&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15819sections are rejected.
15820
15821
15822.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15823.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15824.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15825This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15826all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15827header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15828zero means &"no limit"&.
15829
15830
15831
15832
15833.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15834.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15835.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15836Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15837mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15838some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15839this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15840if you want to do semantic checking.
15841See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15842set.
15843
15844
15845.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15846.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15847.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15848.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15849This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15850all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15851hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15852.code
15853helo_allow_chars = _
15854.endd
15855Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15856
15857
15858.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15859.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15860.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15861If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15862list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15863default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15864its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15865do.
15866
15867
15868.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15869.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15870.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15871By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15872&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15873to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15874condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15875Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15876to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15877necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15878encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15879Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15880
15881When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15882&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15883EHLO command either:
15884
15885.ilist
15886is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15887.next
15888.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15889.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15890matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15891calling host address, or
15892.next
15893when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15894.endlist
15895
15896However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15897fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15898be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15899
15900If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15901.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15902&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15903
15904.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15905.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15906.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15907Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15908backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15909name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15910&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15911rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15912If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15913error.
15914
15915.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15916.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15917.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15918This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15919manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15920&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15921verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15922item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15923it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15924
15925This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15926delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15927configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15928domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15929&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15930
15931A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15932messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15933time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15934retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15935
15936
15937.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15938.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15939Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15940is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15941&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15942option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15943default configuration file contains
15944.code
15945host_lookup = *
15946.endd
15947which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15948is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15949
15950After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15951has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15952this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15953
15954.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15955.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15956After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15957unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15958&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15959&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15960
15961
15962.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15963This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15964to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15965first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15966if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15967if you want.
15968
15969&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15970multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15971&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15972case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15973
15974
15975
15976.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15977.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15978If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15979as soon as the connection is made.
15980This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15981nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15982connections immediately.
15983
15984The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15985ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15986sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15987incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15988chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15989
15990
15991.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15992.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15993This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15994happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15995you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15996127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15997the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15998list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15999local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16000.code
16001hosts_connection_nolog = :
16002.endd
16003If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
16004
16005
16006
16007.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16008.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16009This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16010connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16011
16012
16013.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16014.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16015.cindex "host" "treated as local"
16016If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16017if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16018records
16019or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16020host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16021
16022This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16023&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16024section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16025&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16026that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16027chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16028interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16029
16030
16031.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16032.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16033This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16034to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16035The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16036
16037
16038
16039.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16040.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16041.cindex "discarding bounce message"
16042This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16043that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16044suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16045
16046After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16047because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16048message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16049the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16050again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16051bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16052for frozen messages. For example,
16053.code
16054ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16055.endd
16056retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16057failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16058failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16059value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16060dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16061&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16062
16063
16064.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16065.cindex "&""From""& line"
16066.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16067Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16068the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16069message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16070such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16071match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16072process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16073&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16074
16075
16076.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16077See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
16078
16079.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16080.cindex "environment" "values from"
16081This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16082You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16083these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16084during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16085installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16086environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16087external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16088
16089Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16090(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16091
16092WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16093FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16094unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16095that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16096
16097Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16098&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16099current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16100anymore.
16101
16102See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16103environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16104transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16105details.
16106
16107
16108.option keep_malformed main time 4d
16109This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16110have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16111next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16112logged.
16113
16114
16115.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16116.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16117.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16118This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16119a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16120While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16121Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16122and constrained to be a directory.
16123
16124
16125.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16126.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16127.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16128This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16129a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16130While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16131Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16132and constrained to be a file.
16133
16134
16135.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16136.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16137.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16138This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16139Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16140Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16141
16142
16143.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16144.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16145.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16146This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16147to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16148Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16149identity to be proven.
16150
16151
16152.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16153.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16154This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16155the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16156cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16157
16158
16159.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16160.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16161This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16162LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16163details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16164with LDAP support.
16165
16166
16167.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16168.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16169This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16170A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16171See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16172Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16173to hard/demand.
16174
16175
16176.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16177.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16178If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16179connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16180"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16181of SSL-on-connect.
16182In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16183by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16184This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16185
16186
16187.option ldap_version main integer unset
16188.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16189This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16190LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16191-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16192the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16193has been built with LDAP support.
16194
16195
16196
16197.option local_from_check main boolean true
16198.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16199.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16200When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16201an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16202checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16203the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16204
16205&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16206locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16207&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16208
16209You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16210on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16211&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16212and the default qualify domain.
16213
16214If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16215and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16216&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16217&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16218
16219.cindex "envelope from"
16220.cindex "envelope sender"
16221These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16222is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16223&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16224
16225For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16226request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16227has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16228
16229
16230
16231
16232.option local_from_prefix main string unset
16233When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16234matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16235ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16236done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16237appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16238&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16239example, if
16240.code
16241local_from_prefix = *-
16242.endd
16243is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16244.code
16245From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16246.endd
16247will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16248matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16249qualify domain.
16250
16251
16252.option local_from_suffix main string unset
16253See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16254
16255
16256.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16257This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16258listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16259&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16260options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16261&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16262&%local_interfaces%& is
16263.code
16264local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16265.endd
16266when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16267.code
16268local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16269.endd
16270
16271.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16272.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16273.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16274This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16275&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16276the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16277message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16278non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16279
16280
16281
16282.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16283.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16284When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16285an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16286do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16287also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16288See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16289&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16290
16291
16292
16293
16294.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16295.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16296.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16297.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16298Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16299uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16300value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16301after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16302host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16303range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16304systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16305&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16306characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16307time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16308section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16309
16310
16311
16312.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16313.cindex "log" "file path for"
16314This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16315files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16316when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16317name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16318or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16319they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16320A path must start with a slash.
16321To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16322Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16323section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16324used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16325variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16326configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16327&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16328early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16329
16330
16331.option log_selector main string unset
16332.cindex "log" "selectors"
16333This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16334writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16335minus characters. For example:
16336.code
16337log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16338.endd
16339A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16340logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16341
16342
16343.option log_timezone main boolean false
16344.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16345.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16346.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16347By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16348timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16349in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16350avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16351&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16352timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16353of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16354&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16355another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16356
16357
16358.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16359.cindex "too many open files"
16360.cindex "open files, too many"
16361.cindex "file" "too many open"
16362.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16363.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16364This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16365lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16366Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16367file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16368recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16369actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16370as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16371open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16372&%lookup_open_max%&.
16373
16374
16375.option max_username_length main integer 0
16376.cindex "length of login name"
16377.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16378.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16379Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16380&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16381this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16382an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16383
16384
16385.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16386.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16387.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16388.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16389.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16390By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16391the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16392option is set true, this no longer happens.
16393
16394
16395.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16396.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16397.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16398.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16399.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16400This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16401&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16402
16403
16404.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16405.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16406If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16407(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16408locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16409means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16410Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16411Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16412replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16413empty string, the option is ignored.
16414
16415
16416.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16417If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16418the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16419message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16420take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16421the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16422it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16423yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16424before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16425that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16426means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16427colons will become hyphens.
16428
16429
16430.option message_logs main boolean true
16431.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16432.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16433If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16434&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16435Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16436minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16437per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16438which is not affected by this option.
16439
16440
16441.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16442.cindex "message" "size limit"
16443.cindex "limit" "message size"
16444.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16445This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16446value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16447to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16448TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16449optionally followed by K or M.
16450
16451&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16452other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16453the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16454error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16455&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16456
16457Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16458exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16459failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16460an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16461the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16462message that an individual transport can process.
16463
16464If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16465maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16466failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16467virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16468probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16469default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16470some problems may result.
16471
16472A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16473SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16474SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16475
16476
16477.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16478.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16479This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16480.code
16481SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16482.endd
16483in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16484moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16485and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16486standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16487lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16488
16489
16490.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16491Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16492it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16493contains a full description of this facility.
16494
16495
16496
16497.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16498.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16499This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16500be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16501option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16502
16503
16504.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16505This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16506message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16507recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16508It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16509safety precaution.
16510
16511When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16512list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16513the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16514contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16515can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16516
16517If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16518&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16519example is
16520.code
16521never_users = root:daemon:bin
16522.endd
16523Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16524harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16525transport driver.
16526
16527
16528.new
16529.option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16530This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16531listens for work and information-requests.
16532Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16533should need to modify the default.
16534
16535The option is expanded before use.
16536If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16537is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16538Otherwise, it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16539to Exim.
16540
16541If the Exim command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&
16542then a notifier socket is not created.
16543.wen
16544
16545
16546.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16547.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16548This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16549by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16550each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16551
16552This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16553available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16554The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16555the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16556list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16557&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16558names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16559
16560Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16561SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16562yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16563adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16564invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16565
16566The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16567
16568Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16569"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16570with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16571some now infamous attacks.
16572
16573Examples:
16574.code
16575# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16576openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16577 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16578
16579# Disable older protocol versions:
16580openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16581.endd
16582
16583Possible options may include:
16584.ilist
16585&`all`&
16586.next
16587&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16588.next
16589&`cipher_server_preference`&
16590.next
16591&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16592.next
16593&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16594.next
16595&`legacy_server_connect`&
16596.next
16597&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16598.next
16599&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16600.next
16601&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16602.next
16603&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16604.next
16605&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16606.next
16607&`no_compression`&
16608.next
16609&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16610.next
16611&`no_sslv2`&
16612.next
16613&`no_sslv3`&
16614.next
16615&`no_ticket`&
16616.next
16617&`no_tlsv1`&
16618.next
16619&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16620.next
16621&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16622.next
16623&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16624.next
16625&`single_dh_use`&
16626.next
16627&`single_ecdh_use`&
16628.next
16629&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16630.next
16631&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16632.next
16633&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16634.next
16635&`tls_d5_bug`&
16636.next
16637&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16638.endlist
16639
16640As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16641all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16642to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16643to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16644release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16645where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16646
16647
16648.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16649.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16650This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16651to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16652The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16653
16654
16655.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16656.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16657.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16658.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16659The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16660percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16661replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16662also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16663option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16664but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16665an ACL.
16666
16667&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16668trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16669if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16670implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16671routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16672a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16673local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16674
16675
16676.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16677.cindex "Perl"
16678This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16679interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16680
16681
16682.option perl_startup main string unset
16683.cindex "Perl"
16684This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16685interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16686
16687.option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16688.cindex "Perl"
16689This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16690
16691
16692.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16693.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16694This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16695data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16696&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16697PostgreSQL support.
16698
16699
16700.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16701.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16702.cindex "pid file, path for"
16703This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16704process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16705to the host name:
16706.code
16707pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16708.endd
16709If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16710spool directory.
16711The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16712option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16713of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16714
16715
16716.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16717.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16718This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16719PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16720control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16721&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16722for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16723that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16724not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16725
16726.option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16727.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16728.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16729If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16730this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16731and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16732commands are acceptable.
16733When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16734
16735See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16736
16737Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16738
16739
16740.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16741.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16742This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16743to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16744If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16745If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16746an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16747is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16748
16749.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16750.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16751If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16752completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16753called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16754purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16755volume of mail. Use with care!
16756
16757
16758.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16759.cindex "name" "of local host"
16760.cindex "host" "name of local"
16761.cindex "local host" "name of"
16762.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16763This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16764HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16765option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16766The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16767server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16768
16769If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16770name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16771contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16772&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16773version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16774explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16775
16776
16777.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16778.cindex "printing characters"
16779.cindex "8-bit characters"
16780By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1678132&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16782when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16783sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16784is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16785characters.
16786
16787This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16788&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16789the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16790described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16791Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16792standards.
16793
16794
16795.option process_log_path main string unset
16796.cindex "process log path"
16797.cindex "log" "process log"
16798.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16799This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16800&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16801utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16802in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16803can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16804different spool directories.
16805
16806
16807.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16808.cindex "restricting access to features"
16809.oindex "&%-M%&"
16810.oindex "&%-R%&"
16811.oindex "&%-q%&"
16812The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16813admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16814&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16815
16816
16817.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16818.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16819.cindex "address" "qualification"
16820This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16821addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16822recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16823are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16824also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16825locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16826
16827Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16828unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16829&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16830addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16831necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16832addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16833&%primary_hostname%& value.
16834
16835
16836.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16837This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16838addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16839
16840
16841
16842.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16843.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16844.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16845.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16846This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16847A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16848domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16849next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16850
16851
16852.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16853.cindex "restricting access to features"
16854.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16855The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16856queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16857&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16858See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16859
16860
16861.option queue_only main boolean false
16862.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16863.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16864If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16865whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16866next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16867delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16868
16869The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16870and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16871&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16872&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16873
16874
16875.option queue_only_file main string unset
16876.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16877.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16878This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16879one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16880it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16881each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16882For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16883&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16884.code
16885queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16886.endd
16887causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16888&_/some/file_& exists.
16889
16890
16891.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16892.cindex "load average"
16893.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16894.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16895If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16896all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16897happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16898the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16899the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16900false.
16901
16902Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16903option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16904determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16905&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16906
16907
16908.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16909.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16910When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16911because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16912all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16913This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16914threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16915connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16916circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16917where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16918should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16919re-evaluated for each message.
16920
16921
16922.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16923.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16924When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16925setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16926&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16927to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16928
16929
16930.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16931.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16932If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16933in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16934must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16935single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16936and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16937single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16938the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16939avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16940&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16941when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16942large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16943
16944
16945
16946.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16947.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16948This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16949can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16950but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16951start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16952very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16953however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16954started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16955
16956Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16957the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16958run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16959the daemon's command line.
16960
16961.cindex queues named
16962.cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
16963To set limits for different named queues use
16964an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16965
16966.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16967.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16968.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16969.cindex "first pass routing"
16970When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16971received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16972However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16973&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16974message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16975has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16976when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16977over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16978SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16979&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16980&%queue_domains%&.
16981
16982
16983.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16984.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16985This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16986maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16987the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16988&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16989controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16990
16991.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16992.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16993.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16994This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16995added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16996on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16997used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16998added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16999&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17000header lines.
17001The default setting is:
17002
17003.code
17004received_header_text = Received: \
17005 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17006 {${if def:sender_ident \
17007 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17008 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17009 by $primary_hostname \
17010 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17011 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17012 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17013 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17014 ${if def:sender_address \
17015 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17016 id $message_exim_id\
17017 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17018.endd
17019
17020The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17021omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17022support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17023locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17024header lines such as the following:
17025.code
17026Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17027by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17028(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17029id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17030for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17031Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17032id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17033.endd
17034Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17035the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17036checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17037message was accepted.
17038
17039
17040.option received_headers_max main integer 30
17041.cindex "loop" "prevention"
17042.cindex "mail loop prevention"
17043.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17044When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17045counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17046have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17047This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17048
17049
17050.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17051.cindex "unqualified addresses"
17052.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17053This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17054recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17055qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17056affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17057addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17058host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17059or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17060option was not set.
17061
17062
17063.option recipients_max main integer 0
17064.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17065.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17066If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17067original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17068by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17069all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17070Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17071done.
17072
17073.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17074&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17075RCPT commands in a single message.
17076
17077
17078.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17079If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17080recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17081error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17082error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17083initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17084for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17085
17086
17087.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
17088.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17089This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17090hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17091does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17092message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17093have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17094deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17095deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17096each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17097same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17098&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17099with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17100tagged with its process id.
17101
17102This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17103message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17104manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17105deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17106is received.
17107
17108.cindex "number of deliveries"
17109.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17110If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17111need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17112are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17113daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17114fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17115runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17116delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17117then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17118&%remote_max_parallel%&.
17119
17120If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17121&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17122doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17123host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17124
17125
17126.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17127.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17128.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17129When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17130domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17131.code
17132remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17133.endd
17134would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17135then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17136
17137
17138.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17139.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17140This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17141database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17142host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17143past failures.
17144
17145
17146.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17147.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17148.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17149Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17150intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17151straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17152retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17153the default value.
17154
17155
17156.option return_path_remove main boolean true
17157.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17158RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17159&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17160The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17161MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17162in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17163&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17164received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17165the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17166
17167
17168.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17169This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17170
17171
17172.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17173.cindex "RFC 1413"
17174.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17175RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17176an item in the list.
17177The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17178for the system.
17179
17180.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17181.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17182.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17183This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17184no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17185
17186
17187.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17188.cindex "unqualified addresses"
17189.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17190This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17191sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17192&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17193not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17194it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17195&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17196using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17197
17198
17199.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17200.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17201.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17202This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17203If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17204and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17205Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17206
17207
17208
17209.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17210.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17211This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17212TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17213connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17214other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17215still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17216this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17217connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17218tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17219hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17220
17221
17222
17223.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17224.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17225.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17226.cindex "inetd"
17227This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17228that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17229control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17230value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17231non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17232set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17233
17234A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17235has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17236that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17237and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17238
17239
17240.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17241.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17242.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17243Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17244the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17245check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17246client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17247client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17248
17249When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17250allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17251but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17252or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17253starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17254counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17255following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17256MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17257
17258
17259.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17260You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17261check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17262changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17263live with.
17264
17265
17266. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17267. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17268. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17269. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17270. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17271. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17272. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17273. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17274. the option name to split.
17275
17276.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17277 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17278.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17279.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17280The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17281prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17282results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17283response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17284precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17285seen).
17286
17287
17288.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17289.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17290.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17291This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17292host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17293expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17294reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17295connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17296is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17297of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17298required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17299
17300&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17301constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17302happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17303without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17304could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17305doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17306
17307
17308
17309.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17310.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17311.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17312.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17313If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17314listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17315in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17316fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17317subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17318to all messages received in the same connection.
17319
17320A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17321if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17322also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17323various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17324
17325
17326. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17327
17328.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17329 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17330.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17331.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17332This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17333automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17334the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17335and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17336number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17337are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17338restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17339systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17340dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17341
17342
17343.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17344.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17345.cindex "host" "reserved"
17346When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17347number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17348that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17349&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17350restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17351of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17352of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17353the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17354individual host.
17355
17356For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17357set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17358connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17359provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17360
17361
17362.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17363.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17364.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17365.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17366This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17367several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17368is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17369responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17370incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17371
17372.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17373The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17374is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17375in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17376
17377If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17378expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17379used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17380panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17381value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17382For example:
17383.code
17384smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17385 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17386.endd
17387
17388Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17389messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17390verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17391&%helo_data%& value.
17392
17393.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17394.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17395.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17396.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17397.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17398This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17399positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17400.code
17401smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17402 $version_number $tod_full
17403.endd
17404Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17405multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17406appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17407in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17408multiline response).
17409
17410
17411.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17412.cindex "checking disk space"
17413.cindex "disk space, checking"
17414.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17415When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17416option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17417spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17418leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17419is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17420
17421
17422.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17423.cindex "connection backlog"
17424.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17425.cindex "backlog of connections"
17426This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17427this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17428of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17429attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17430say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17431out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17432value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17433attacks by SYN flooding.
17434
17435
17436.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17437.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17438.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17439The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17440the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17441synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17442fewer, but they still exist.
17443
17444Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17445for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17446client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17447SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17448for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17449input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17450does detect many instances.
17451
17452The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17453If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17454hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17455(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17456
17457
17458
17459.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17460.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17461.vindex "&$domain$&"
17462If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17463command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17464chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17465are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17466argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17467example:
17468.code
17469smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17470 $sender_host_address
17471.endd
17472.new
17473If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17474be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17475In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17476if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17477.wen
17478
17479A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17480complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17481run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17482a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17483receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17484the command.
17485
17486
17487.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17488.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17489When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17490one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17491section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17492
17493
17494.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17495.cindex "load average"
17496If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17497accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17498If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17499the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17500systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17501&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17502
17503
17504
17505.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17506.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17507.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17508Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17509particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17510.code
17511RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17512.endd
17513causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17514(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17515example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17516too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17517dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17518
17519.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17520When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17521&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17522Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17523&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17524not count towards the limit.
17525
17526
17527
17528.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17529.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17530.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17531If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17532Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17533that subvert web
17534clients
17535into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17536non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17537
17538
17539
17540.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17541.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17542.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17543.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17544Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17545can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17546recipients.
17547
17548Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17549facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17550&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17551&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17552
17553When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17554&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17555rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17556respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17557values:
17558
17559.ilist
17560A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17561.next
17562An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17563fractional parts are allowed here.
17564.next
17565A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17566.next
17567A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17568because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17569.endlist
17570
17571For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17572first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17573.code
17574smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17575smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17576.endd
17577The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17578two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17579seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17580delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17581
17582
17583.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17584See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17585
17586
17587.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17588See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17589
17590
17591.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17592.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17593.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17594This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17595input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17596data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17597the message is abandoned.
17598A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17599.code
17600SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17601SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17602.endd
17603The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17604means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17605
17606If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17607expanded before use and may depend on
17608&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17609
17610
17611.oindex "&%-os%&"
17612The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17613&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17614this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17615of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17616timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17617
17618
17619.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17620This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17621&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17622
17623
17624.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17625.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17626.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17627In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17628&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17629reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17630to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17631policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17632&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17633example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17634.code
17635550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17636550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17637.endd
17638
17639
17640.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17641.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17642When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17643the availability thereof is advertised in
17644response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17645chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17646
17647
17648.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17649This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17650extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17651See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17652
17653
17654
17655.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17656This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17657See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17658
17659
17660
17661.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17662.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17663.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17664.cindex "directories, multiple"
17665If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17666subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17667sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17668subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17669arrival of the message.
17670
17671Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17672where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17673directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17674directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17675are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17676
17677It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17678changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17679&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17680after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17681automatically deleted.
17682
17683When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17684changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17685trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17686sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17687sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17688spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17689particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17690if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17691entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17692
17693
17694.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17695.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17696This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17697it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17698configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17699string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17700&$primary_hostname$&.
17701
17702If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17703that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17704log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17705Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17706as failures in the configuration file.
17707
17708By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17709tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17710
17711.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17712.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17713If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17714for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17715Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17716Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17717option.
17718
17719The following variables will not have useful values:
17720.code
17721$max_received_linelength
17722$body_linecount
17723$body_zerocount
17724.endd
17725
17726Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17727and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17728(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17729will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17730
17731Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17732(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17733The transmission benefit is maintained.
17734
17735.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17736.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17737This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17738access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17739
17740.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17741.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17742This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17743variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17744is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17745&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17746
17747.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17748.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17749If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17750items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17751treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17752passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17753option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17754
17755
17756.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17757.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17758.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17759If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17760ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17761MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17762domain causes a syntax error.
17763However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17764syntax checking.
17765
17766
17767.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17768.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17769When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17770separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17771be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17772separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17773nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17774particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17775both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17776containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17777Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17778the LOG_ALERT priority.
17779
17780
17781.option syslog_facility main string unset
17782.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17783This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17784syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17785&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17786If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17787details of Exim's logging.
17788
17789
17790.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17791.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17792If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17793omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17794the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17795to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17796into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17797
17798
17799
17800.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17801.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17802This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17803syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17804&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17805
17806
17807
17808.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17809.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17810If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17811omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17812details of Exim's logging.
17813
17814
17815.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17816.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17817.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17818.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17819This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17820the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17821must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17822generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17823appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17824which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17825&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17826A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17827
17828
17829.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17830.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17831This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17832&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17833implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17834During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17835
17836
17837.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17838.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17839This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17840command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17841the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17842
17843.option system_filter_group main string unset
17844.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17845This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17846gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17847with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17848
17849.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17850.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17851.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17852This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17853is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17854contains the pipe command.
17855
17856
17857.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17858.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17859This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17860is used in a system filter.
17861
17862
17863.option system_filter_user main string unset
17864.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17865If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17866delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17867process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17868Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17869is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17870configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17871specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17872&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17873
17874If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17875under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17876transport option overrides.
17877
17878
17879.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17880.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17881.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17882.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17883If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17884TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17885turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17886performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17887should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17888However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17889this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17890daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17891TCP_NODELAY.
17892
17893
17894.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17895.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17896.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17897If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17898message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17899is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17900bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17901sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17902If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17903frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17904
17905&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17906frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17907messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17908
17909
17910.option timezone main string unset
17911.cindex "timezone, setting"
17912.cindex "environment" "values from"
17913The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17914running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17915created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17916to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17917.code
17918timezone = UTC
17919.endd
17920The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17921or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17922is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17923time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17924runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17925unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17926
17927
17928.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17929.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17930.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17931.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17932When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17933of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17934response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17935chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17936Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17937using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17938is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17939
17940
17941.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17942.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17943.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17944The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17945files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17946Commonly only one file is needed.
17947The server's private key is also
17948assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17949&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17950
17951&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17952receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17953use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17954option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17955
17956&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17957separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17958
17959&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17960when a list of more than one
17961file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17962The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17963
17964If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17965if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17966Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17967&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17968
17969If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17970generated for every connection.
17971
17972.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17973.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17974.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17975This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17976be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17977
17978Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17979
17980&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17981for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17982For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17983
17984See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17985
17986
17987.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17988.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17989The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17990the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17991interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17992suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17993
17994The value must be at least 1024.
17995
17996The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17997hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17998by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17999
18000If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18001number.
18002
18003Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18004little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18005larger prime than requested.
18006
18007
18008.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18009.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18010The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18011to be used by Exim.
18012
18013This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
18014The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
18015
18016&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
18017for other TLS library versions,
18018using a filename with site-generated
18019local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18020other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18021"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18022
18023If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18024then it names a file from which DH
18025parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18026PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18027OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18028fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18029loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18030and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18031
18032If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18033loaded by Exim.
18034
18035If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18036Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18037does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18038See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18039
18040If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18041a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18042
18043In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
180442.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18045in IKE is assigned number 23.
18046
18047Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18048of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18049sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18050the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18051&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18052
18053The available standard primes are:
18054&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18055&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18056&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18057&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18058
18059The available additional primes are:
18060&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18061
18062Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18063Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18064The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18065of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18066(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18067
18068At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18069they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18070candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18071
18072The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18073to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18074whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18075tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18076need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18077userbase.
18078
18079Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18080is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18081applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18082used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18083mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18084prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18085acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18086
18087
18088.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
18089.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18090This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18091It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
18092
18093After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
18094&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
18095for valid selections.
18096
18097For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18098&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18099&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18100
18101If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
18102
18103
18104.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18105.cindex TLS "certificate status"
18106.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18107This option
18108must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18109status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18110Certificate Authority.
18111
18112Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18113The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18114
18115For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18116for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18117of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18118The ordering of the two lists must match.
18119The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18120
18121The file(s) should be in DER format,
18122except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18123or for OpenSSL,
18124when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18125The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18126a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18127files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18128If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18129(this only works under TLS1.3)
18130they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18131
18132Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18133PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18134TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18135although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18136
18137.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18138.cindex SSMTP
18139.cindex SMTPS
18140This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18141operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18142set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18143further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18144
18145
18146
18147.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
18148.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18149The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18150files which contains the server's private keys.
18151If this option is unset, or if
18152the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18153key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18154&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18155
18156See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18157
18158
18159.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18160.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18161.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18162If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18163&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18164support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18165TLS session.
18166
18167
18168.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18169.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18170.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18171This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18172The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18173connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18174different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18175permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18176in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18177preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18178&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18179
18180
18181.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18182.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18183.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18184See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18185
18186
18187.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18188.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18189.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18190The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18191word "system"
18192or the absolute path to
18193a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18194match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18195
18196The "system" value for the option will use a
18197system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18198This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18199and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18200must be specified.
18201
18202The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18203preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18204
18205With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18206explicitly
18207either by file or directory
18208are added to those given by the system default location.
18209
18210These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18211than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18212the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18213connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18214Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18215use the explicit directory version.
18216
18217See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18218
18219A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18220being unset.
18221
18222
18223.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18224.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18225.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18226This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18227certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18228&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18229either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18230&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18231
18232Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18233&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18234present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18235aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18236the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18237connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18238ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18239
18240A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18241matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18242certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18243abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18244state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18245such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18246but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18247certificate"&.
18248
18249Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18250certificates.
18251
18252
18253.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18254.cindex "trusted groups"
18255.cindex "groups" "trusted"
18256This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18257option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18258which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18259specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18260details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18261&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18262are trusted.
18263
18264.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18265.cindex "trusted users"
18266.cindex "user" "trusted"
18267This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18268option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18269trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18270&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18271If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18272Exim user are trusted.
18273
18274.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18275.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18276.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18277This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18278the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18279gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18280used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18281can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18282is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18283&%-F%& option.
18284
18285.option unknown_username main string unset
18286See &%unknown_login%&.
18287
18288.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18289.cindex "trusted users"
18290.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18291.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18292.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18293.cindex "envelope from"
18294.cindex "envelope sender"
18295When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18296normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18297default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18298senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18299is used) is ignored.
18300
18301However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18302to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18303.code
18304exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18305.endd
18306.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18307The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18308other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18309users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18310patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18311identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18312users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18313followed by a hyphen
18314by a setting like this:
18315.code
18316untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18317.endd
18318If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18319restriction, you can use
18320.code
18321untrusted_set_sender = *
18322.endd
18323The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18324only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18325to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18326parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18327&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18328necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18329overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18330described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18331
18332The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18333&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18334&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18335envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18336sender address.
18337
18338
18339.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18340.cindex "&""From""& line"
18341.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18342Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18343an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18344particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18345of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18346matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18347&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18348default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18349.code
18350From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18351From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18352.endd
18353The pattern can be seen by running
18354.code
18355exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18356.endd
18357It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18358year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18359regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18360&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18361(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18362&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18363
18364
18365.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18366See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18367
18368
18369.option warn_message_file main string unset
18370.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18371.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18372This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18373for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18374been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18375&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18376&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18377
18378
18379.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18380.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18381If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18382See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18383.ecindex IIDconfima
18384.ecindex IIDmaiconf
18385
18386
18387
18388
18389. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18390. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18391
18392.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18393.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18394.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18395This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18396Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18397
18398For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18399&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18400which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18401provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18402&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18403
18404
18405
18406.option address_data routers string&!! unset
18407.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18408The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18409precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18410router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18411&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18412delivery of the address to be deferred.
18413
18414.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18415When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18416accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18417routers, and the eventual transport.
18418
18419&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18420that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18421in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18422either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18423put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18424
18425Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18426with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18427on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18428&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18429&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18430
18431The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18432for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18433you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18434.code
18435uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18436.endd
18437In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18438.code
18439file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18440.endd
18441This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18442lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18443
18444See also the &%set%& option below.
18445
18446.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18447.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18448The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18449from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18450&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18451ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18452verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18453
18454
18455
18456.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18457.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18458.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18459If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18460by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18461your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18462having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18463routing.
18464
18465
18466
18467.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18468.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18469.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18470This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18471routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18472&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18473&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18474value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18475includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18476well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18477you could put:
18478.code
18479cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18480.endd
18481on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18482and
18483.code
18484cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18485.endd
18486on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18487this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18488explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18489logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18490
18491
18492.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18493.cindex "case of local parts"
18494.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18495By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18496manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18497If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18498this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18499part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18500turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18501more details.
18502
18503.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18504.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18505.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18506The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18507router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18508an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18509is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18510addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18511and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18512
18513This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18514recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18515modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18516(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18517
18518
18519
18520.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18521.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18522.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18523.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18524.vindex "&$home$&"
18525When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18526address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18527local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18528than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18529holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18530user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18531preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18532given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18533overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18534the router is skipped.
18535
18536If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18537or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18538setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18539two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18540setting to achieve this. For example:
18541.code
18542local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18543.endd
18544Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18545up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18546&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18547
18548
18549
18550.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18551.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18552This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18553router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18554evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18555result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18556&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18557router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18558
18559If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18560precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18561
18562This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18563All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18564
18565The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18566running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18567the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18568.code
18569condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18570.endd
18571Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18572.code
18573condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18574.endd
18575
18576A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18577.code
18578condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18579condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18580condition = foobar
18581.endd
18582
18583If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18584of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18585be specified using &%condition%&.
18586
18587Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18588are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18589they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18590parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18591ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18592Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18593Router rules processing behavior.
18594
18595This is best illustrated in an example:
18596.code
18597# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18598# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18599
18600$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18601true {yes} {no}}
18602
18603$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18604 {yes} {no}}
18605.endd
18606In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18607&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18608default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18609(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18610string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18611with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18612resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18613&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18614
18615In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18616&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18617mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18618conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18619string characters.
18620
18621Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18622true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18623match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18624contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18625expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18626
18627
18628.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18629.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18630If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18631option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18632the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18633If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18634output, and Exim carries on processing.
18635This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18636so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18637option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18638variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18639&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18640are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18641The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18642
18643
18644
18645.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18646If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18647or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18648unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18649transport option of the same name.
18650
18651.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18652.cindex "MX record" "security"
18653.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18654.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18655.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18656DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18657the dnssec request bit set.
18658This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18659
18660.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18661.cindex "MX record" "security"
18662.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18663.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18664.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18665DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18666the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18667(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18668This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18669
18670
18671.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18672.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18673.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18674If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18675the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18676lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18677expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18678a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18679
18680
18681
18682.option driver routers string unset
18683This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18684to be used.
18685
18686
18687.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18688.cindex "DSN" "success"
18689.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18690If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18691Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18692instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18693Not effective on redirect routers.
18694
18695
18696
18697.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18698.cindex "envelope from"
18699.cindex "envelope sender"
18700.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18701If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18702transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18703there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18704message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18705provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18706expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18707
18708The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18709subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18710settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18711setting.
18712
18713If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18714the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18715address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18716expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18717
18718If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18719SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18720any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18721sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18722settings:
18723.code
18724errors_to =
18725errors_to = ""
18726.endd
18727An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18728this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18729no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18730address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18731overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18732
18733.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18734If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18735MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18736path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18737setting &%return_path%&.
18738
18739The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18740manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18741implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18742
18743
18744
18745.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18746.cindex "address" "testing"
18747.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18748.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18749.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18750If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18751as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18752want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18753on for the system alias file.
18754See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18755are evaluated.
18756
18757The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18758&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18759an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18760
18761
18762
18763.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18764.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18765Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18766&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18767
18768
18769
18770.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18771If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18772verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18773
18774
18775
18776.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18777If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18778verifying a sender, verification fails.
18779
18780
18781
18782.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18783.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18784.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18785String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18786colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18787changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18788each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18789defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18790&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18791
18792If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18793associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18794list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18795randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18796transport for further details.
18797
18798
18799.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18800.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18801.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18802.cindex "transport" "local"
18803.cindex "router" "setting group"
18804When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18805specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18806process.
18807The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18808error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18809The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18810is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18811and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18812
18813
18814
18815.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18816.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18817.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18818This option specifies a list of text headers,
18819newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18820that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18821Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18822option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18823the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18824&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18825message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18826header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18827&"see"& the added header lines.
18828
18829The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18830&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18831an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18832failures are treated as configuration errors.
18833
18834Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18835for a router; all listed headers are added.
18836
18837&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18838router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18839
18840.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18841.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18842&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18843additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18844For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18845address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18846modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18847circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18848which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18849avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18850
18851
18852
18853.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18854.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18855.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18856This option specifies a list of text headers,
18857colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18858that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18859However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
18860Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
18861.new
18862If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
18863.wen
18864The way in which
18865the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18866section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18867the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18868to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18869&"see"& the original header lines.
18870
18871The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
18872&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18873the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18874errors.
18875
18876Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18877for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18878
18879&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18880router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18881
18882&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18883removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18884routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18885warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18886
18887&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18888items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18889To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18890
18891
18892
18893.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18894.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18895.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18896Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18897entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18898IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18899address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18900like
18901.code
18902remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18903.endd
18904by setting
18905.code
18906ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18907.endd
18908on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18909discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18910attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18911domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18912Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18913router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18914
18915You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18916means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18917.code
18918ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18919ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18920.endd
18921The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18922in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18923
18924This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18925addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18926is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18927domain that is being routed.
18928
18929.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18930During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18931checked.
18932
18933.option initgroups routers boolean false
18934.cindex "additional groups"
18935.cindex "groups" "additional"
18936.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18937.cindex "transport" "local"
18938If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18939the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18940&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18941any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18942and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18943
18944
18945
18946.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18947.cindex affix "router precondition"
18948.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18949.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18950If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18951one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18952section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18953evaluated.
18954
18955The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18956used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18957asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18958the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18959some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18960.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18961.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18962Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18963section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18964
18965.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18966.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18967During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18968running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18969expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18970the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18971a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18972command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18973This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18974the relevant transport.
18975
18976.new
18977.vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
18978If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
18979wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
18980.wen
18981
18982When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18983behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18984means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18985callout.
18986
18987The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18988&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18989&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18990to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18991immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18992.code
18993real_localuser:
18994 driver = accept
18995 local_part_prefix = real-
18996 check_local_user
18997 transport = local_delivery
18998.endd
18999For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19000router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19001.code
19002 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19003 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19004.endd
19005
19006If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19007both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19008are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19009separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19010
19011
19012.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19013See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19014
19015
19016
19017.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19018.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19019.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19020This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19021local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19022&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19023mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19024character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19025parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19026&%username-foo%&.
19027
19028
19029.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19030See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19031
19032
19033
19034.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19035.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19036.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19037The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19038See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19039are evaluated, and
19040section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19041string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19042example:
19043.code
19044local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
19045.endd
19046.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19047If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
19048for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19049expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
19050example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19051send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19052each virtual domain:
19053.code
19054postmaster:
19055 driver = redirect
19056 local_parts = postmaster
19057 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19058.endd
19059
19060
19061.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19062.cindex "log" "delivery line"
19063.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19064Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19065deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19066recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19067this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19068router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19069router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19070redirect addresses.
19071
19072
19073
19074.option more routers boolean&!! true
19075The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19076that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19077result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19078fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19079delivery to be deferred.
19080
19081If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19082further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19083.oindex "&%self%&"
19084However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19085means of the setting
19086.code
19087self = pass
19088.endd
19089or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19090does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19091case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19092
19093Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19094expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19095controls what happens next.
19096
19097
19098.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19099.cindex "timeout" "of router"
19100.cindex "router" "timeout"
19101If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19102address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19103router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19104intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19105host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19106
19107There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19108lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19109applies to all of them.
19110
19111
19112
19113.option pass_router routers string unset
19114.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19115Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19116&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19117routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19118these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19119router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19120of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19121be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19122to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19123&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19124
19125
19126
19127.option redirect_router routers string unset
19128.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19129Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19130generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19131example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19132point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19133
19134The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19135It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19136instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19137which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19138
19139
19140
19141.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19142.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19143.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19144This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19145router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19146Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19147through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19148
19149Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19150be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19151(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19152If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19153failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19154
19155If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19156below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19157&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19158existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19159preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19160
19161.cindex "NFS"
19162If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19163the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19164unavailable.
19165
19166This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19167options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19168look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19169full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19170these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19171to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19172that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19173transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19174
19175During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19176facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19177This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19178operates as follows:
19179
19180If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19181characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19182comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19183but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19184used. For example:
19185.code
19186require_files = mail:/some/file
19187require_files = $local_part_verified:$home/.procmailrc
19188.endd
19189If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19190&%require_files%& condition fails.
19191
19192Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19193checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19194directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19195access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19196
19197&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19198incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19199may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19200may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19201user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19202
19203&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19204&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19205without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19206is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19207check again in that process.
19208
19209The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19210be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19211existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19212circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19213not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19214for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19215as if the file did not exist. For example:
19216.code
19217require_files = +/some/file
19218.endd
19219If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19220handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19221option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19222
19223
19224
19225.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19226.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19227.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19228When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19229in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19230domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19231other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19232Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19233latter kind.
19234
19235This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19236hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19237router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19238&%check_local_user%&,
19239&%local_parts%&,
19240&%condition%&,
19241&%local_part_prefix%&,
19242&%local_part_suffix%&,
19243&%senders%& or
19244&%require_files%&
19245set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19246for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19247same name.
19248
19249Failing to set this option when it is needed
19250(because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19251can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19252
19253The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19254appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19255independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19256
19257
19258
19259.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19260.cindex "router" "home directory for"
19261.cindex "home directory" "for router"
19262.vindex "&$home$&"
19263This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19264&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19265transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19266sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19267forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19268cause the router to defer.
19269
19270Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19271&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19272place.
19273(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19274are evaluated.)
19275While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19276&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19277
19278When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19279the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19280delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19281of these values that is set:
19282
19283.ilist
19284The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19285.next
19286The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19287.next
19288The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19289.next
19290The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19291.endlist
19292
19293In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19294router, but not for the transport.
19295
19296
19297
19298.option self routers string freeze
19299.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19300.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19301This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19302list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19303and &(manualroute)& routers.
19304Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19305of remote hosts.
19306Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19307&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19308host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19309The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19310&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19311
19312Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19313example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19314error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19315reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19316freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19317cases:
19318
19319.vlist
19320.vitem &%defer%&
19321Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19322
19323.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19324The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19325be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19326behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19327
19328.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19329The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19330reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19331rewritten.
19332
19333.vitem &%pass%&
19334.oindex "&%more%&"
19335.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19336The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19337&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19338subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19339name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19340distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19341combination
19342.code
19343self = pass
19344no_more
19345.endd
19346ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19347Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19348be passed to the next router.
19349
19350.vitem &%fail%&
19351Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19352
19353.vitem &%send%&
19354.cindex "local host" "sending to"
19355The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19356setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19357makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19358is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19359different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19360.endlist
19361
19362
19363
19364.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19365.cindex "router" "checking senders"
19366If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19367address matches something on the list.
19368See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19369are evaluated.
19370
19371There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19372dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19373setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19374to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19375set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19376verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19377SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19378matters.
19379
19380
19381.option set routers "string list" unset
19382.cindex router variables
19383This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19384because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19385The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19386usual way.
19387
19388Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19389and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19390Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19391When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19392to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19393the address.
19394The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19395The variables can be used by the router options
19396(not including any preconditions)
19397and by the transport.
19398Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19399Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19400
19401This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19402many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19403
19404
19405.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19406.cindex "IP address" "translating"
19407.cindex "packet radio"
19408.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19409There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19410it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19411mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19412routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19413is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19414code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19415SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19416
19417.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19418The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19419by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19420expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19421For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19422If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19423address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19424up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19425produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19426addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19427.code
19428translate_ip_address = \
19429 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19430 {$value}fail}}
19431.endd
19432The file would contain lines like
19433.code
1943410.2.3.128/26 some.host
1943510.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19436.endd
19437You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19438are doing.
19439
19440
19441
19442.option transport routers string&!! unset
19443This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19444and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19445only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19446after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19447and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19448delivery is deferred.
19449
19450The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19451have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19452(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19453
19454
19455
19456.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19457.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19458This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19459to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19460explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19461file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19462option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19463overridden by a setting on the transport.
19464If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19465logged, and delivery is deferred.
19466See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19467environment.
19468
19469
19470
19471
19472.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19473.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19474This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19475local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19476configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19477pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19478string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19479setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19480If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19481logged, and delivery is deferred.
19482
19483If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19484&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19485the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19486the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19487is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19488
19489See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19490environment.
19491
19492
19493
19494
19495.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19496.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19497The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19498that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19499result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19500fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19501delivery to be deferred.
19502
19503When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19504address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19505overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19506&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19507the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19508sometimes true and sometimes false).
19509
19510.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19511Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19512qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19513delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19514In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19515&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19516to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19517&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19518
19519&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19520this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19521only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19522no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19523a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19524duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19525duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19526&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19527so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19528&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19529
19530Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19531&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19532subsequent routers.
19533
19534
19535.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19536.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19537.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19538.cindex "transport" "local"
19539.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19540.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19541When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19542specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19543The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19544error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19545This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19546The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19547the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19548a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19549See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19550&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19551
19552
19553
19554.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19555Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19556&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19557
19558
19559.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19560.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19561.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19562.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19563If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19564delivering in cutthrough mode or
19565testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19566with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19567restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19568&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19569
19570&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19571SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19572accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19573user or group.
19574
19575
19576.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19577If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19578addresses,
19579delivering in cutthrough mode
19580or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19581See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19582are evaluated.
19583See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19584
19585
19586.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19587If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19588or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19589See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19590are evaluated.
19591See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19592.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19593.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19594
19595
19596
19597
19598
19599
19600. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19601. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19602
19603.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19604.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19605.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19606The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19607used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19608be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19609specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19610it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19611up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19612.code
19613localusers:
19614 driver = accept
19615 domains = mydomain.example
19616 check_local_user
19617 transport = local_delivery
19618.endd
19619The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19620&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19621When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19622address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19623
19624
19625
19626
19627
19628
19629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19631
19632.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19633.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19634.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19635The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19636recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19637unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19638
19639If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19640SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19641MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19642However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19643records.
19644
19645MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19646looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19647When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19648except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19649IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19650generic option, the router declines.
19651
19652Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19653to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19654are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19655
19656.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19657.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19658.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19659If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19660address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19661happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19662
19663
19664.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19665There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19666Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19667SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19668MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19669problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19670
19671For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19672&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19673&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19674an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19675domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19676such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19677proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19678look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19679case routing fails.
19680
19681
19682.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19683.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19684There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19685an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19686domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19687
19688The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19689is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19690
19691Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19692.ilist
19693The domain does not exist in DNS
19694.next
19695The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19696convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19697for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19698.next
19699Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19700.next
19701MX record points to a non-existent host.
19702.next
19703MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19704&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19705.next
19706MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19707addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19708.next
19709The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19710&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19711.next
19712&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19713not be found in the MX records (see below)
19714.endlist
19715
19716
19717
19718
19719.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19720.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19721The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19722
19723.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19724.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19725If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19726(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19727process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19728differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19729the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19730
19731
19732.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19733.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19734The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19735addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19736enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19737required. For example,
19738.code
19739check_srv = smtp
19740.endd
19741looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19742expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19743to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19744submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19745option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19746normal way.
19747
19748When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19749the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19750host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19751this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19752SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19753according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19754
19755When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19756the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19757records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19758this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19759defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19760and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19761have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19762trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19763
19764See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19765when there is a DNS lookup error.
19766
19767
19768
19769
19770.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19771.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19772DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19773which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19774rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19775This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19776domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19777However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19778also being queued.
19779
19780
19781.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19782.cindex IPv6 disabling
19783.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19784The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19785or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19786(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19787only A records are used.
19788
19789.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19790.cindex IPv4 preference
19791.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19792The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19793or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19794(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19795A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19796
19797.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19798.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19799.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19800A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19801record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19802For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19803records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19804setting:
19805.code
19806mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19807.endd
19808This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19809has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19810the address record.
19811
19812
19813.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19814If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19815DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19816&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19817
19818
19819
19820
19821.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19822.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19823.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19824When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19825lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19826single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19827called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19828&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19829resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19830&'resolv.conf'&.
19831
19832
19833
19834.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19835.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19836.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19837If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19838qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19839an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19840expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19841occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19842&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19843any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19844header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19845
19846This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19847ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19848sense.
19849
19850When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19851servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19852making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19853some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19854name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19855header rewriting.
19856
19857
19858.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19859.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19860Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19861to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19862options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19863default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19864servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19865any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19866
19867If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19868domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19869local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19870lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19871routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19872message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19873without processing them independently,
19874provided the following conditions are met:
19875
19876.ilist
19877No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19878&%headers_remove%&.
19879.next
19880The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19881the domain.
19882.endlist
19883
19884
19885
19886
19887.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19888.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19889When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19890lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19891applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19892the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19893domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19894up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19895&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19896actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19897
19898Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19899record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19900local wildcard.
19901
19902
19903
19904.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19905If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19906DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19907&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19908
19909
19910
19911
19912.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19913.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19914If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19915added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19916if
19917.code
19918widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19919.endd
19920is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19921&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19922&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19923and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19924the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19925when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19926
19927
19928.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19929When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19930of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19931corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19932is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19933
19934These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19935for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19936such as that implied by
19937.code
19938domains = @mx_any
19939.endd
19940that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19941entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19942.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19943.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19944
19945
19946
19947
19948
19949
19950
19951
19952
19953. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19954. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19955
19956.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19957.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19958.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19959.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19960This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19961verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19962generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19963takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19964router handles the address
19965.code
19966root@[192.168.1.1]
19967.endd
19968by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19969consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19970are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19971.code
19972postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19973.endd
19974Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19975grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19976
19977.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19978If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19979declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19980&%self%& option determines what happens.
19981
19982The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19983controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19984also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19985Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19986
19987
19988
19989. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19990. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19991
19992.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19993.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19994.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19995The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19996Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19997not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19998must set
19999.code
20000ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20001.endd
20002in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20003
20004The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20005connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20006a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20007message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20008this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20009can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20010must not be specified for it.
20011
20012.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20013.option hosts iplookup string unset
20014This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20015names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20016(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20017and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20018happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20019
20020
20021.option optional iplookup boolean false
20022If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20023is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20024delivery to the address is deferred.
20025
20026
20027.option port iplookup integer 0
20028.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20029This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20030call.
20031
20032
20033.option protocol iplookup string udp
20034This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20035protocols is to be used.
20036
20037
20038.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20039This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20040default value is:
20041.code
20042$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20043.endd
20044The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20045query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20046
20047
20048.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20049If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20050returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20051string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20052in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20053&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20054whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20055up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20056
20057
20058.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20059This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20060returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20061router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20062response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20063check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20064address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20065the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20066following could be used:
20067.code
20068response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20069reroute = $local_part@$1
20070.endd
20071
20072.option timeout iplookup time 5s
20073This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20074machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20075call. It does not apply to UDP.
20076
20077
20078
20079
20080. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20081. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20082
20083.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20084.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20085.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20086.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20087The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20088routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20089route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20090normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20091route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20092messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20093
20094The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20095it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20096has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20097include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20098&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20099generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20100being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20101
20102.vindex "&$host$&"
20103In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20104router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20105an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20106transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20107with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20108passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20109host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20110text string.
20111
20112The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20113&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20114or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20115any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20116below, following the list of private options.
20117
20118
20119.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20120
20121.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20122The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20123
20124.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20125See &%host_find_failed%&.
20126
20127.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20128This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20129address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20130of the following values:
20131.code
20132decline
20133defer
20134fail
20135freeze
20136ignore
20137pass
20138.endd
20139The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20140error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20141forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20142&%pass_router%&),
20143.oindex "&%more%&"
20144overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20145router only if &%more%& is true.
20146
20147The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20148cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20149controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20150as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20151
20152The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20153state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20154generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20155
20156
20157.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20158.cindex "randomized host list"
20159.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20160If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20161is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20162overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20163crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20164same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20165(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20166deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20167
20168When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20169into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20170set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20171item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20172.code
20173route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20174.endd
20175The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20176randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20177If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20178randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20179&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20180
20181
20182.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20183If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20184Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20185example:
20186.code
20187route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20188.endd
20189If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20190router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20191deferred.
20192
20193
20194.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20195This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20196unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20197that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20198
20199
20200.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20201.cindex "address" "copying routing"
20202Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20203router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20204router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20205default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20206servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20207any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20208
20209If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20210domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20211local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20212lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20213&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20214addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20215same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20216if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20217
20218
20219
20220
20221.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20222The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20223rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20224entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20225described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20226Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20227.display
20228<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20229.endd
20230The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20231no options:
20232.code
20233route_list = \
20234 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20235 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20236.endd
20237The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20238list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20239usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20240single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20241pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20242&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20243except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20244That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20245lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20246in a &%route_list%&).
20247
20248The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20249matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20250then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20251&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20252
20253
20254
20255.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20256The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20257routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20258hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20259The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20260Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20261expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20262like this:
20263.code
20264dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20265thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20266.endd
20267This data can be accessed by setting
20268.code
20269route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20270.endd
20271Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20272decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20273requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20274possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20275be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20276
20277
20278
20279
20280.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20281A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20282always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20283declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20284and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20285If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20286The format of each item
20287in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20288as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20289
20290If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20291variables are set during its expansion:
20292
20293.ilist
20294.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20295If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20296&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20297.code
20298route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20299.endd
20300.next
20301&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20302.next
20303&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20304
20305.next
20306.vindex "&$value$&"
20307If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20308looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20309.code
20310route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20311.endd
20312.endlist
20313
20314Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20315semicolon is the default route list separator.
20316
20317
20318
20319.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20320Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20321optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20322(see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20323When no port is given, an IP address
20324is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20325specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20326by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20327
20328.ilist
20329Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20330the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20331be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20332.code
20333route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20334route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20335.endd
20336.next
20337When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20338colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20339enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20340number follows. For example:
20341.code
20342route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20343.endd
20344.endlist
20345
20346.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20347When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20348the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20349delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20350option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20351transport.
20352
20353Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20354hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20355interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20356records in the DNS. For example:
20357.code
20358route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20359.endd
20360If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20361example:
20362.code
20363route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20364.endd
20365If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20366randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20367that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20368be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20369Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20370happens is controlled by the
20371.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20372&%self%& option of the router.
20373
20374A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20375hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20376lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20377below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20378preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20379randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20380defined by MX preferences.
20381
20382If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20383not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20384preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20385
20386If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20387depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20388is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20389Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20390
20391If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20392most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20393router.
20394
20395DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20396failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20397&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20398
20399The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20400whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20401
20402
20403
20404.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20405The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20406One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20407&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20408other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20409per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20410routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20411
20412.ilist
20413&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20414setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20415.next
20416&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20417overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20418.next
20419&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20420find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20421also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20422.next
20423&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20424no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20425timeout), delivery is deferred.
20426.next
20427&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20428.next
20429&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20430.endlist
20431
20432For example:
20433.code
20434route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20435 domain2 host4:host5
20436.endd
20437If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20438DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20439result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20440or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20441call.
20442
20443&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20444called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20445instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20446lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20447function called.
20448
20449&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20450inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20451option specified.
20452
20453
20454
20455If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20456&%host_find_failed%& option.
20457
20458.vindex "&$host$&"
20459When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20460The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20461
20462
20463
20464.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20465In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20466transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20467
20468.ilist
20469.cindex "smart host" "example router"
20470The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20471&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20472named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20473.code
20474domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20475.endd
20476You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20477your first router something like this:
20478.code
20479smart_route:
20480 driver = manualroute
20481 domains = !+local_domains
20482 transport = remote_smtp
20483 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20484.endd
20485This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20486&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20487they are tried in order
20488(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20489Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20490.code
20491smart_route:
20492 driver = manualroute
20493 transport = remote_smtp
20494 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20495.endd
20496There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20497However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20498example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20499precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20500always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20501would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20502always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20503&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20504
20505.next
20506.cindex "mail hub example"
20507A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20508records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20509the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20510machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20511&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20512to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20513using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20514lookup is easier to manage.
20515
20516If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20517to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20518example:
20519.code
20520hub_route:
20521 driver = manualroute
20522 transport = remote_smtp
20523 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20524.endd
20525This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20526whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20527if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20528that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20529domain can be used to find the host:
20530.code
20531through_firewall:
20532 driver = manualroute
20533 transport = remote_smtp
20534 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20535.endd
20536The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20537hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20538data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20539next router.
20540
20541.next
20542.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20543.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20544You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20545SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20546storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20547can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20548.code
20549save_in_file:
20550 driver = manualroute
20551 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20552 route_list = saved.domain.example
20553.endd
20554though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20555several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20556different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20557.code
20558save_in_file:
20559 driver = manualroute
20560 route_list = \
20561 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20562 *.saved.domain2.example \
20563 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20564 batch_pipe
20565.endd
20566.vindex "&$domain$&"
20567.vindex "&$host$&"
20568The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20569doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20570file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20571the address if the lookup fails.
20572
20573.next
20574.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20575Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20576&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20577one way it can be done:
20578.code
20579# Transport
20580uucp:
20581 driver = pipe
20582 user = nobody
20583 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20584 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20585 return_fail_output = true
20586
20587# Router
20588uucphost:
20589 transport = uucp
20590 driver = manualroute
20591 route_data = \
20592 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20593.endd
20594The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20595.code
20596darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20597.endd
20598It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20599makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20600&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20601.endlist
20602.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20603.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20604
20605
20606
20607
20608
20609
20610
20611
20612. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20613. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20614
20615.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20616.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20617.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20618.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20619The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20620and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20621mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20622However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20623&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20624be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20625options:
20626.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20627
20628.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20629This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20630command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20631expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20632&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20633
20634
20635.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20636.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20637This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20638address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20639uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20640gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20641
20642
20643.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20644.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20645This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20646command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20647it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20648using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20649not set, a value for the gid also.
20650
20651&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20652root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20653However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20654usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20655is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20656the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20657gid.
20658
20659
20660.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20661This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20662before running the command.
20663
20664
20665.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20666If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20667is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20668timeout.
20669
20670
20671The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20672the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20673containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20674the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20675field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20676
20677.ilist
20678&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20679below).
20680.next
20681&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20682&%no_more%& is set.
20683.next
20684&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20685subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20686of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20687included in the SMTP response.
20688.next
20689&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20690subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20691included in any SMTP response.
20692.next
20693&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20694.next
20695&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20696&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20697.next
20698&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20699new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20700or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20701.endlist
20702
20703When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20704number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20705the page):
20706.code
20707ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20708LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20709.endd
20710The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20711is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20712used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20713an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20714
20715The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20716As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20717in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20718&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20719(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20720
20721If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20722find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20723anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20724goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20725result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20726
20727.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20728If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20729variable. For example, this return line
20730.code
20731accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20732.endd
20733routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20734the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20735.ecindex IIDquerou1
20736.ecindex IIDquerou2
20737
20738
20739
20740
20741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20742. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20743
20744.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20745.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20746.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20747.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20748.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20749The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20750common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20751(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20752files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20753redirected in several different ways:
20754
20755.ilist
20756It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20757independently.
20758.next
20759It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20760.next
20761It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20762.next
20763It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20764.next
20765It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20766.next
20767It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20768.next
20769It can be discarded.
20770.endlist
20771
20772The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20773However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20774files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20775&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20776
20777If success DSNs have been requested
20778.cindex "DSN" "success"
20779.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20780redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20781
20782
20783
20784.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20785The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20786expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20787contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20788options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20789aliases, in a configuration like this:
20790.code
20791system_aliases:
20792 driver = redirect
20793 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20794.endd
20795If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20796expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20797expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20798cause delivery to be deferred.
20799
20800A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20801&_.forward_& files, like this:
20802.code
20803userforward:
20804 driver = redirect
20805 check_local_user
20806 file = $home/.forward
20807 no_verify
20808.endd
20809If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20810empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20811is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20812yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20813comments.
20814
20815.new
20816.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20817.cindex redirect "tainted data"
20818Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20819
20820&*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20821directly for redirection,
20822as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20823In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20824on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20825the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20826.wen
20827
20828
20829
20830.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20831.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20832It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20833&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20834
20835.ilist
20836When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20837running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20838the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20839practice the router may not be able to operate.
20840.next
20841However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20842is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20843local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20844saves some resources.
20845.endlist
20846
20847
20848
20849
20850
20851
20852.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20853.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20854.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20855The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20856can be interpreted in two different ways:
20857
20858.ilist
20859If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20860&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20861&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20862respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20863in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20864document is intended for use by end users.
20865.next
20866Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20867described in the next section.
20868.endlist
20869
20870When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20871in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20872generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20873configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20874for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20875
20876
20877
20878.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20879.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20880When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20881comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20882addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20883&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20884disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20885depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20886commas or newlines.
20887If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20888quotes.
20889
20890Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20891also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20892next newline character is ignored.
20893
20894If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20895double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20896(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20897&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20898removed.
20899
20900.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20901&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20902and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20903of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20904special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20905&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20906setting:
20907.code
20908data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20909.endd
20910
20911
20912.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20913.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20914.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20915.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20916A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20917consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20918automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20919is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20920Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20921as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20922complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20923
20924.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20925Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20926filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20927mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20928&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20929.code
20930cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20931.endd
20932.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20933.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20934For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20935preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20936it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20937synonymously.
20938
20939If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
209402822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20941domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20942addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20943force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20944
20945Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20946Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20947contains:
20948.code
20949Sam.Reman: spqr
20950.endd
20951Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20952messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20953this forward file:
20954.code
20955Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20956.endd
20957With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20958&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20959second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20960and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20961should really contain
20962.code
20963spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20964.endd
20965but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20966below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20967&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20968
20969
20970
20971.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20972In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20973lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20974
20975.ilist
20976.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20977.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20978An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20979as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20980command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20981Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20982which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20983
20984Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20985the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20986the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20987in double quotes, for example:
20988.code
20989"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20990.endd
20991since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20992quote just the command. An item such as
20993.code
20994|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20995.endd
20996is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20997
20998Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20999of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21000redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21001quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21002string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21003are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21004data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21005transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21006an &%accept%& router.
21007
21008.next
21009.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21010.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21011An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21012parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21013.code
21014/home/world/minbari
21015.endd
21016is treated as a filename, but
21017.code
21018/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21019.endd
21020is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21021the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21022forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21023filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21024
21025Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21026which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21027
21028.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21029However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21030bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21031instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21032
21033.next
21034.cindex "included address list"
21035.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21036If an item is of the form
21037.code
21038:include:<path name>
21039.endd
21040a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21041point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21042out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21043by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21044item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21045the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21046.code
21047list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21048.endd
21049It must be given as
21050.code
21051list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21052.endd
21053.new
21054.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21055.cindex redirect "tainted data"
21056Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21057.wen
21058.next
21059.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21060.cindex "delivery" "discard"
21061.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21062.cindex "black hole"
21063.cindex "abandoning mail"
21064Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21065&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21066the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21067.code
21068:blackhole:
21069.endd
21070can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21071done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21072&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21073
21074&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21075delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21076are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21077database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21078&_/dev/null_&.
21079
21080.next
21081.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21082.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21083.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21084.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21085.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21086An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21087redirection items of the form
21088.code
21089:defer:
21090:fail:
21091.endd
21092respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21093to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21094text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21095associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21096.code
21097X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21098.endd
21099In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21100of a
21101.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21102VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21103default.
21104.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21105The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21106the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21107
21108.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21109By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21110&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21111space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21112followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21113code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21114incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21115suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21116&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21117ignored.
21118
21119.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21120In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21121default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21122therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21123
21124Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21125not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21126normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21127as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21128lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21129
21130During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21131containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21132whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21133subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21134deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21135rules still apply.
21136
21137.next
21138.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21139Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21140chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21141for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21142&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21143router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21144results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21145.endlist
21146
21147
21148.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21149.cindex "duplicate addresses"
21150.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21151.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21152Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21153to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21154routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21155aliasing scheme of the type
21156.code
21157pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21158localpart1: pipe
21159localpart2: pipe
21160.endd
21161does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21162when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21163discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21164such as
21165.code
21166localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21167localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21168.endd
21169does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21170the pipes are distinct.
21171
21172
21173
21174.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21175.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21176.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21177When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21178leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21179afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21180delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21181members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21182can be used to avoid this.
21183
21184
21185.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21186.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21187If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21188error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21189for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21190detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21191deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21192
21193
21194
21195.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21196
21197.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21198The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21199
21200
21201.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21202Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21203data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21204
21205
21206.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21207.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21208If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21209and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21210
21211
21212.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21213.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21214.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21215Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21216&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21217are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21218lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21219
21220It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21221the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21222
21223
21224The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21225&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21226&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21227files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21228true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21229
21230
21231
21232.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21233.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21234Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21235This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21236default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21237let ordinary users do.
21238
21239
21240
21241.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21242This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21243as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21244Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21245configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21246for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21247
21248When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21249is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21250the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21251and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21252domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21253&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21254.code
21255\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21256.endd
21257Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21258&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21259originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21260(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21261&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21262&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21263file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21264original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21265
21266
21267.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21268When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21269when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21270&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21271&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21272deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21273is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21274&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21275
21276
21277
21278.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21279When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21280this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21281permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21282option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21283&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21284
21285
21286.option data redirect string&!! unset
21287This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21288set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21289list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21290expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21291has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21292
21293When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21294filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21295terminated with newline characters. For example:
21296.code
21297data = #Exim filter\n\
21298 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21299.endd
21300If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21301you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21302choice into a newline.
21303
21304
21305.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21306A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21307ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21308specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21309configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21310
21311
21312.option file redirect string&!! unset
21313This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21314is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21315use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21316failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21317must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21318data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21319entirely of comments), the router declines.
21320
21321.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21322If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21323runs a check on the containing directory,
21324unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21325If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21326happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21327is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21328not, the router declines.
21329
21330
21331.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21332.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21333A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21334ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21335specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21336configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21337it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21338
21339
21340.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21341When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21342relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21343relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21344relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21345
21346
21347.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21348.cindex "restricting access to features"
21349.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21350If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21351redirection list.
21352
21353
21354.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21355.cindex "restricting access to features"
21356.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21357If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21358&%allow_filter%& is true.
21359
21360
21361
21362
21363.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21364.cindex "restricting access to features"
21365.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21366.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21367.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21368.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21369If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21370specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21371conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21372set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21373locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21374
21375
21376.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21377.cindex "restricting access to features"
21378.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21379If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21380make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21381functions.
21382
21383.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21384.cindex "restricting access to features"
21385.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21386.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21387If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21388make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21389
21390.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21391.cindex "restricting access to features"
21392.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21393If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21394permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21395under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21396&_.forward_& files).
21397
21398
21399.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21400.cindex "restricting access to features"
21401.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21402If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21403to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21404
21405
21406.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21407.cindex "restricting access to features"
21408.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21409This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21410it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21411of the embedded Perl support.
21412
21413
21414.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21415.cindex "restricting access to features"
21416.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21417If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21418to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21419
21420
21421.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21422.cindex "restricting access to features"
21423.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21424If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21425to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21426
21427
21428.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21429.cindex "restricting access to features"
21430.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21431If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21432message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21433files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21434&%one_time%& is set.
21435
21436
21437.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21438.cindex "restricting access to features"
21439.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21440If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21441to make use of &%run%& items.
21442
21443
21444.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21445.cindex "restricting access to features"
21446.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21447If this option is true, items of the form
21448.code
21449:include:<path name>
21450.endd
21451are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21452
21453
21454.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21455.cindex "restricting access to features"
21456.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21457.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21458If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21459specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21460forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21461
21462
21463.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21464.cindex "restricting access to features"
21465.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21466If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21467&%allow_filter%& is true.
21468
21469
21470.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21471.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21472If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21473of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21474the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21475
21476
21477
21478
21479.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21480.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21481If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21482generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21483generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21484bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21485bounce may well quote the generated address.
21486
21487
21488.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21489.cindex "EACCES"
21490If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21491EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21492file did not exist.
21493
21494
21495.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21496.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21497If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21498ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21499router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21500
21501Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21502router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21503(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21504against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21505is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21506is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21507a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21508that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21509
21510
21511
21512.option include_directory redirect string unset
21513If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21514redirection list must start with this directory.
21515
21516
21517.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21518This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21519&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21520
21521
21522.option one_time redirect boolean false
21523.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21524.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21525.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21526.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21527.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21528Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21529files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21530of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21531is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21532but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21533message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21534lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21535before they subscribed.
21536
21537If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21538deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21539&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21540&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21541attempt.
21542
21543&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21544router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21545reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21546permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21547
21548&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21549to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21550and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21551
21552&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21553&%one_time%&.
21554
21555The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21556addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21557addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21558&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21559typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21560expansion.
21561
21562
21563.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21564.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21565.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21566.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21567.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21568This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21569This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21570See &%check_owner%& above.
21571
21572
21573.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21574This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21575The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21576&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21577
21578
21579.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21580.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21581A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21582starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21583transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21584name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21585When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21586
21587
21588.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21589.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21590If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21591generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21592in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21593expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21594to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21595&$qualify_recipient$&.
21596
21597This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21598but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21599not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21600addresses.
21601
21602.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21603.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21604.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21605.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21606If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21607set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21608without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21609address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21610&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21611this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21612
21613
21614.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21615If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21616any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21617the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21618only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21619&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21620
21621
21622.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21623A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21624&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21625by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21626transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21627are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21628
21629
21630.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21631.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21632If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21633subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21634and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21635
21636
21637.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21638The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21639:subaddress part of an address.
21640
21641.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21642The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21643of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21644(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21645
21646
21647.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21648.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21649To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21650&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21651(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21652&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21653needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21654
21655
21656
21657.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21658.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21659.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21660.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21661.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21662.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21663.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21664.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21665If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21666non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21667&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21668giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21669are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21670&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21671be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21672&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21673
21674If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21675errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21676the following routers.
21677
21678If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21679error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21680taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21681so it is passed to the following routers.
21682
21683.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21684Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21685action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21686&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21687
21688&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21689lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21690option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21691notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21692.code
21693userforward:
21694 driver = redirect
21695 allow_filter
21696 check_local_user
21697 file = $home/.forward
21698 file_transport = address_file
21699 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21700 reply_transport = address_reply
21701 no_verify
21702 skip_syntax_errors
21703 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21704 syntax_errors_text = \
21705 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21706 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21707 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21708 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21709 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21710 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21711 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21712 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21713 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21714 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21715.endd
21716You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21717&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21718put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21719.code
21720real_localuser:
21721 driver = accept
21722 check_local_user
21723 local_part_prefix = real-
21724 transport = local_delivery
21725.endd
21726For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21727router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21728.code
21729 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21730 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21731.endd
21732
21733
21734.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21735See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21736
21737
21738.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21739See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21740.ecindex IIDredrou1
21741.ecindex IIDredrou2
21742
21743
21744
21745
21746
21747
21748. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21749. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21750
21751.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21752 "Environment for local transports"
21753.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21754.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21755.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21756Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21757transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21758in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21759mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21760
21761Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21762some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21763transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21764&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21765
21766The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21767different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21768settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21769or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21770configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21771
21772
21773
21774.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21775.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21776.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21777If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21778simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21779the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21780rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21781time.
21782
21783However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21784locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21785.code
21786my_transport:
21787 driver = pipe
21788 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21789.endd
21790This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21791messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21792&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21793file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21794
21795
21796
21797
21798.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21799.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21800.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21801All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21802overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21803set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21804delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21805group (set by the transport). For example:
21806.code
21807# Routers ...
21808# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21809local_users:
21810 driver = accept
21811 check_local_user
21812 transport = group_delivery
21813
21814# Transports ...
21815# This transport overrides the group
21816group_delivery:
21817 driver = appendfile
21818 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_verified
21819 group = mail
21820.endd
21821If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21822address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21823gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21824set.
21825
21826.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21827When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21828function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21829&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21830by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21831for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21832
21833.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21834The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21835is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21836receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21837original gid is also used.
21838
21839This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21840following that is set is used:
21841
21842.ilist
21843A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21844.next
21845A &%group%& setting of the router;
21846.next
21847A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21848&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21849.next
21850The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21851.next
21852In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21853the uid is the creator's uid;
21854.next
21855The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21856.endlist
21857
21858If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21859no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21860This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21861The first of the following that is set is used:
21862
21863.ilist
21864A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21865.next
21866In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21867.next
21868A &%user%& setting of the router;
21869.next
21870A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21871.next
21872The Exim uid.
21873.endlist
21874
21875Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21876&%never_users%& list.
21877
21878
21879
21880
21881
21882.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21883.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21884.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21885.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21886.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21887Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21888the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21889However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21890are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21891for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21892
21893.ilist
21894The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21895.next
21896The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21897.next
21898The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21899.next
21900The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21901.endlist
21902
21903The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21904
21905.ilist
21906The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21907.next
21908The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21909.endlist
21910
21911
21912If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21913value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21914directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21915
21916
21917
21918.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21919.vindex "&$domain$&"
21920.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21921.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21922Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21923variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21924deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21925at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21926other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21927never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21928and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21929.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21930.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21931.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21932
21933
21934
21935
21936
21937
21938
21939. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21940. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21941
21942.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21943.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21944.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21945.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21946The following generic options apply to all transports:
21947
21948
21949.option body_only transports boolean false
21950.cindex "transport" "body only"
21951.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21952.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21953If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21954mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21955or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21956&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21957automatically suppress them.
21958
21959
21960.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21961.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21962This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21963transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21964If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21965logged, and delivery is deferred.
21966
21967
21968.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21969If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21970deliveries by the transport or for any
21971transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21972what you are doing.
21973
21974
21975.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21976.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21977If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21978option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21979transport is run.
21980If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21981output, and Exim carries on processing.
21982This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21983so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21984option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21985variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21986one.
21987The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21988transport and the router that called it.
21989
21990.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21991.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21992If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21993This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21994header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21995requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21996safely be resent to other recipients.
21997
21998
21999.option driver transports string unset
22000This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22001There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22002
22003
22004.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22005.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22006If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22007This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22008delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22009configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22010address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22011header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22012its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22013resent to other recipients.
22014
22015
22016.option event_action transports string&!! unset
22017.cindex events
22018This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22019For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22020
22021
22022.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22023.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22024This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22025value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22026&%user%& (see below).
22027
22028
22029.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22030.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22031.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22032This option specifies a list of text headers,
22033newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22034which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22035portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22036&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22037routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22038is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22039errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22040
22041Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22042for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22043
22044
22045.option headers_only transports boolean false
22046.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22047.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22048.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22049If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22050exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22051transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22052checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22053
22054
22055.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22056.cindex "header lines" "removing"
22057.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22058This option specifies a list of text headers,
22059colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22060to be removed from the message.
22061However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22062Each list item is separately expanded.
22063If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22064is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22065errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22066.new
22067If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22068.wen
22069
22070Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22071in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22072routers.
22073
22074Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22075for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22076
22077&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22078items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22079To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22080
22081
22082
22083.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22084.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22085.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22086This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22087that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22088option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22089the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22090message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22091example,
22092.code
22093headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22094 x@y w@z
22095.endd
22096changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22097&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22098header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22099only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22100the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22101filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22102affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22103envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22104change envelope recipients at this time.
22105
22106
22107.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22108.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22109.vindex "&$home$&"
22110This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22111overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22112placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22113used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22114&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22115&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22116for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22117deferred.
22118
22119
22120.option initgroups transports boolean false
22121.cindex "additional groups"
22122.cindex "groups" "additional"
22123.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22124If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22125transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22126to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22127
22128
22129.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22130.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22131.cindex transport "parallel processes"
22132.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22133.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22134If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22135it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22136The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22137
22138.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22139Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22140incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22141is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22142Obviously there is scope for
22143records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22144guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22145
22146If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22147relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22148start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22149may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22150are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22151
22152
22153.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22154.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22155.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22156.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22157This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22158expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22159digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22160including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22161delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22162message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22163the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22164ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22165&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22166delivered.
22167
22168
22169
22170.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22171.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22172.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22173.cindex "local part" "prefix"
22174.cindex "local part" "suffix"
22175When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22176affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22177form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22178that contains
22179.code
22180local_part_prefix = *-
22181.endd
22182routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22183is delivered with
22184.code
22185RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22186.endd
22187This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22188recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22189whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22190deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22191&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22192
22193
22194.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22195.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22196When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22197in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22198is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22199deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22200part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22201temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22202deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22203
22204However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22205as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22206(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22207this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22208
22209For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22210the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22211on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22212
22213
22214.option return_path transports string&!! unset
22215.cindex "envelope sender"
22216.cindex "envelope from"
22217.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22218.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22219If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22220the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22221that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22222designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22223SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22224only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22225header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22226
22227&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22228&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22229
22230.vindex "&$return_path$&"
22231The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22232either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22233&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22234replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22235option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22236section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22237
22238&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22239remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22240the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22241This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22242&%errors_to%& in a router.
22243
22244
22245
22246.option return_path_add transports boolean false
22247.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
22248If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22249Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22250mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22251have easy access to it.
22252
22253RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22254the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22255header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22256option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22257incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22258recipients.
22259
22260
22261.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22262See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22263
22264
22265.option shadow_transport transports string unset
22266.cindex "shadow transport"
22267.cindex "transport" "shadow"
22268A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22269another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22270
22271Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22272&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22273string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22274passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22275expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22276cause a log line to be written.
22277
22278The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22279subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22280provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22281is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22282ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22283of the form
22284.code
22285ST=<shadow transport name>
22286.endd
22287If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22288parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22289purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22290provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22291headers that some sites insist on.
22292
22293
22294.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22295.cindex "transport" "filter"
22296.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22297This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22298at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22299individual users or via a system filter.
22300If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22301
22302When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22303&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22304the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22305input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22306command must be specified as an absolute path.
22307
22308The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22309terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22310SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22311lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22312settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22313&(pipe)& transports.
22314
22315The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22316standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22317destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22318filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22319are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22320
22321The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22322care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22323test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22324SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22325
22326.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22327A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22328at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22329message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22330a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22331not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22332
22333.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22334A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22335being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22336support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22337at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22338more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22339the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22340additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22341
22342.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22343The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22344the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22345parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22346Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22347section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22348to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22349of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22350an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22351&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22352
22353.vindex "&$host$&"
22354.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22355The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22356transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22357which the message is being sent. For example:
22358.code
22359transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22360 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22361.endd
22362
22363Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22364generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22365command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22366.ilist
22367If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22368part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22369expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22370example:
22371.code
22372transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22373.endd
22374This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22375&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22376stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22377the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22378&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22379Exim tried to expand the first one.
22380.next
22381Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22382expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22383arguments. Consider this example:
22384.code
22385transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22386 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22387.endd
22388The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22389if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22390.code
22391transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22392 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22393.endd
22394.endlist
22395
22396The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22397For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22398normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22399A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22400serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22401the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22402bounced from a transport filter.
22403
22404If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22405passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22406message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22407
22408
22409.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22410.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22411When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22412that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22413temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22414&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22415way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22416error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22417becomes a temporary error.
22418
22419
22420.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22421.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22422.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22423This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22424run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22425given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22426associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22427option is not set.
22428
22429For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22430specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22431&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22432
22433.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22434For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22435sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22436to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22437retry data.
22438.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22439.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22440.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22441
22442
22443
22444
22445
22446
22447. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22448. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22449
22450.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22451 "Address batching"
22452.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22453The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22454one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22455remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22456normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22457transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22458copy of the message is delivered each time.
22459
22460.cindex "batched local delivery"
22461.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22462.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22463In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22464local transport, for example:
22465
22466.ilist
22467In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22468delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22469recipients saves space.
22470.next
22471In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22472a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22473.next
22474In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22475to a scanner program or
22476to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22477acceptable.
22478.endlist
22479
22480These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22481(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22482repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22483
22484The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22485delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22486(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22487&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22488(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22489to certain conditions:
22490
22491.ilist
22492.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22493If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22494batching is possible.
22495.next
22496.vindex "&$domain$&"
22497If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22498addresses with the same domain are batched.
22499.next
22500.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22501If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22502addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22503customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22504including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22505from taking place.
22506.next
22507Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22508delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22509group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22510be the same.
22511.endlist
22512
22513In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22514both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22515is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22516course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22517option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22518&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22519&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22520.code
22521check_string = "."
22522escape_string = ".."
22523.endd
22524when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22525given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22526&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22527
22528.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22529If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22530&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22531that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22532transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22533addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22534
22535.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22536.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22537If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22538transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22539the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22540of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22541argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22542delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22543are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22544
22545
22546
22547
22548. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22549. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22550
22551.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22552.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22553.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22554.cindex "directory creation"
22555.cindex "creating directories"
22556The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22557file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22558files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22559format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22560University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22561being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22562to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22563delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22564supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22565directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22566
22567The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22568default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22569SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22570included.
22571
22572.cindex "quota" "system"
22573Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22574also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22575system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22576
22577If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22578partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22579modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22580creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22581
22582Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22583file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22584private options.
22585
22586The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22587users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22588putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22589&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22590option).
22591
22592
22593
22594.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22595The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22596the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22597the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22598normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22599
22600.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22601.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22602However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22603directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22604forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22605user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22606the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22607name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22608operation. There are two cases:
22609
22610.ilist
22611If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22612must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22613common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22614different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22615default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22616name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22617&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22618.next
22619If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22620used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22621contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22622.endlist
22623.new
22624.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
22625.cindex appendfile "tainted data"
22626Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
22627This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
22628as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
22629which returns a path (or component).
22630.wen
22631
22632
22633.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22634.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22635As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22636have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22637form:
22638.code
22639save folder23
22640.endd
22641or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22642.code
22643require "fileinto";
22644fileinto "folder23";
22645.endd
22646In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22647must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22648case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22649is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22650way of handling this requirement:
22651.code
22652file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22653 {/var/mail/$local_part_verified} \
22654 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22655 {$address_file} \
22656 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22657 }} \
22658 }
22659.endd
22660With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22661location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22662&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22663
22664&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22665&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22666the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22667you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22668&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22669path to the transport.
22670
22671&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22672the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22673
22674
22675
22676
22677.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22678.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22679
22680
22681
22682.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22683.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22684.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22685.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22686Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22687regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22688delivery is deferred.
22689
22690
22691.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22692.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22693.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22694By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22695that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22696are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22697what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22698are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22699
22700
22701.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22702See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22703However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22704happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22705file.
22706
22707
22708.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22709See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22710
22711
22712.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22713When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22714option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22715delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22716file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22717
22718
22719.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22720When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22721is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22722process is running.
22723
22724
22725.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22726.cindex "&""From""& line"
22727As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22728matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22729replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22730a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22731contains is significant.
22732
22733If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22734are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22735configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22736&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22737&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22738
22739The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22740suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22741&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22742if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22743.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22744.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22745.code
22746check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22747escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22748message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22749message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22750.endd
22751.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22752.cindex "directory creation"
22753When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22754directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22755is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22756
22757The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22758operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22759example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22760is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22761in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22762
22763
22764
22765.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22766This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22767by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22768directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22769delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22770beneath.
22771
22772The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22773&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22774set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22775given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22776are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22777by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22778&%file_must_exist%&.
22779
22780
22781.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22782This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22783or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22784redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22785
22786When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22787into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22788appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22789(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22790&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22791
22792
22793.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22794.cindex "base62"
22795.vindex "&$inode$&"
22796When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22797&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22798whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22799.code
22800q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22801.endd
22802This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22803inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22804option.
22805
22806
22807.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22808If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22809&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22810
22811
22812.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22813See &%check_string%& above.
22814
22815
22816.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22817This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22818&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22819of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22820specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22821&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22822&%file%&.
22823
22824.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22825.cindex "locking files"
22826.cindex "lock files"
22827If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22828mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22829
22830The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22831path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22832examples:
22833.code
22834file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_verified
22835file = /home/$local_part_verified/inbox
22836file = $home/inbox
22837.endd
22838.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22839In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22840is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22841create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22842deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22843run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22844
22845
22846
22847.option file_format appendfile string unset
22848.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22849This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22850before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22851start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22852colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22853second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22854string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22855transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22856this added to it:
22857.code
22858file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22859 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22860.endd
22861Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22862a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22863to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22864to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22865is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22866match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22867delivery is deferred.
22868
22869
22870.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22871If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22872A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22873If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22874
22875
22876.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22877.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22878.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22879.cindex "locking files"
22880By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22881when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22882sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22883Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22884for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22885deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22886mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22887misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22888
22889On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22890not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22891is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22892and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22893
22894If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22895timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22896retries is
22897.code
22898(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22899.endd
22900rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22901which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22902&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22903
22904You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22905local deliveries because of errors of the form
22906.code
22907failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22908.endd
22909
22910.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22911This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22912&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22913&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22914
22915
22916.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22917This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22918for details of locking.
22919
22920
22921.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22922This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22923is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22924
22925
22926.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22927This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22928used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22929
22930
22931.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22932.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22933When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22934exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22935accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22936
22937
22938.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22939.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22940.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22941If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22942number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22943followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22944external source that maintains the data.
22945
22946
22947.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22948.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22949.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22950If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22951size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22952This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22953maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22954it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22955
22956
22957
22958.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22959.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22960If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22961file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22962transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22963&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22964&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22965directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22966SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22967&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22968
22969
22970.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22971.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22972.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22973This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22974a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22975directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22976calculation. The default value is:
22977.code
22978maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22979.endd
22980This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22981(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22982&_Trash_&
22983folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22984.code
22985maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22986.endd
22987This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22988directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22989calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22990directly into that directory.
22991
22992
22993.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22994This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22995&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22996
22997
22998.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22999This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23000section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23001
23002
23003.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23004.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23005The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23006If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23007creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23008quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23009value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23010&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23011
23012.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23013.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23014.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23015The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23016effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23017matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23018containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23019delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23020&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23021See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23022
23023
23024.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23025.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23026If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23027new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23028SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23029below for further details.
23030
23031
23032.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23033This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23034section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23035
23036
23037.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23038This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23039section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23040
23041
23042.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23043.cindex "locking files"
23044.cindex "file" "locking"
23045.cindex "file" "MBX format"
23046.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23047This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23048set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23049the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23050traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23051IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23052
23053&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23054automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23055empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23056combination:
23057.code
23058mbx_format = true
23059message_prefix =
23060message_suffix =
23061.endd
23062If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23063&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23064is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23065&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23066interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23067should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23068going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23069mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23070
23071If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23072the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23073(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23074append messages to it.
23075
23076
23077.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23078.cindex "&""From""& line"
23079The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23080The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23081in which case it is:
23082.code
23083message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23084 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23085.endd
23086&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23087&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23088
23089.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23090The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23091The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23092in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23093setting
23094.code
23095message_suffix =
23096.endd
23097&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23098&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23099
23100.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23101If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23102has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23103permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23104if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23105a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23106value, and this option is ignored.
23107
23108
23109.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23110This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23111mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23112true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23113continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23114
23115
23116.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23117If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23118successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23119on users about incoming mail.
23120
23121
23122.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23123.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23124This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23125or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23126is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23127all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23128individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23129&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23130have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23131
23132As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23133multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23134For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23135
23136A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23137may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23138If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23139become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23140Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23141the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23142
23143The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23144(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23145for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23146and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23147large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23148be handled.
23149
23150The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23151quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23152
23153&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23154
23155The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23156the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23157be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23158fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23159system quota failures.
23160
23161By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23162mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23163last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23164during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23165refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23166message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23167changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23168for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23169continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23170delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23171
23172
23173.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23174This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23175into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23176called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23177delivery directory.
23178
23179
23180.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23181This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23182number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23183can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23184failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23185&"no quota"&.
23186
23187The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23188quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23189
23190.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23191See &%quota%& above.
23192
23193
23194.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23195This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23196for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23197these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23198If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23199captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23200file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23201
23202This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23203&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23204facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23205the file length to the filename. For example:
23206.code
23207maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23208quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23209.endd
23210An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23211number of lines in the message.
23212
23213The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23214filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23215sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23216
23217Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23218
23219This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23220may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23221will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23222disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23223a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23224as is used to adjust the effective size.
23225
23226
23227.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23228See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23229&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23230.code
23231quota_warn_message = "\
23232 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23233 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23234 This message is automatically created \
23235 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23236 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23237 a warning threshold that is\n\
23238 set by the system administrator.\n"
23239.endd
23240
23241
23242.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23243.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23244.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23245.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23246This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23247resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23248size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23249threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23250may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23251sign. For example:
23252.code
23253quota = 10M
23254quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23255.endd
23256If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23257percent sign is ignored.
23258
23259The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23260and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23261warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23262the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23263can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23264&'From:'& line, the default is:
23265.code
23266From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23267.endd
23268.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23269If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23270option.
23271
23272The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23273are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23274percentage.
23275
23276
23277.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23278.cindex "envelope from"
23279.cindex "envelope sender"
23280If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23281format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23282you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23283so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23284for details of batch SMTP.
23285
23286
23287.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23288.cindex "carriage return"
23289.cindex "linefeed"
23290This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23291(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23292of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23293of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23294
23295&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23296(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23297in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23298carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23299have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23300changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23301
23302
23303.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23304This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23305exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23306&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23307that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23308&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23309
23310
23311.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23312This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23313the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23314&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23315each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23316
23317This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23318&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23319where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23320both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23321
23322.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23323Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23324have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23325&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23326the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23327error.
23328
23329&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23330is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23331
23332
23333.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23334If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23335appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23336&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23337sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23338&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23339delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23340
23341.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23342In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23343necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23344achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23345file corruption.
23346
23347The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23348It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23349except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23350
23351
23352.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23353This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23354set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23355locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23356of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23357are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23358the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23359rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23360does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23361
23362You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23363&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23364MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23365without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23366
23367
23368
23369
23370.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23371.cindex "appending to a file"
23372.cindex "file" "appending"
23373Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23374
23375.ilist
23376If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23377return is given.
23378
23379.next
23380.cindex "directory creation"
23381If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23382&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23383&%directory_mode%& option.
23384
23385.next
23386If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23387indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23388transport.
23389
23390.next
23391.cindex "file" "locking"
23392.cindex "locking files"
23393.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23394If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23395reliably over NFS, as follows:
23396
23397.olist
23398Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23399current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23400as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23401.next
23402Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23403.next
23404If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23405Unlink the hitching post name.
23406.next
23407Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23408then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23409of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23410restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23411.next
23412If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23413up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23414mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23415lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23416existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23417it before trying again.
23418.endlist olist
23419
23420.next
23421A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23422so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23423than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23424
23425.next
23426.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23427.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23428If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23429&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23430checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23431is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23432ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23433directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23434idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23435checked.
23436
23437.next
23438If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23439and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23440different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23441delivery is deferred.
23442
23443.next
23444If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23445If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23446is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23447permissions.
23448
23449.next
23450The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23451If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23452hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23453
23454.next
23455If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23456changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23457have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23458
23459.next
23460If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23461option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23462directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23463open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23464except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23465set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23466the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23467that prevents link following.
23468
23469.next
23470.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23471If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23472existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23473being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23474after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23475
23476.next
23477If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23478
23479.next
23480.cindex "file" "locking"
23481.cindex "locking files"
23482Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23483are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23484&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23485However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23486file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23487.code
23488/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23489.endd
23490using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23491the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23492the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23493
23494If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23495depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23496&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23497
23498If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23499&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23500to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23501delivery is deferred.
23502
23503If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23504&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23505waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23506immediately. It retries up to
23507.code
23508(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23509.endd
23510times (rounded up).
23511.endlist
23512
23513At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23514and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23515
23516
23517.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23518.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23519.cindex "&""From""& line"
23520When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23521delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23522activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23523&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23524router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23525configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23526ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23527
23528No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23529locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23530separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23531of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23532newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23533&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23534any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23535
23536If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23537the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23538different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23539deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23540
23541
23542.cindex "maildir format"
23543.cindex "mailstore format"
23544There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23545done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23546&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23547formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23548SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23549
23550.cindex "directory creation"
23551In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23552sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23553option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23554constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23555the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23556&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23557deferred.
23558
23559
23560
23561.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23562.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23563If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23564it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23565directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23566directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23567&_new_& subdirectory.
23568
23569In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23570<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23571Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23572before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23573filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23574opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23575Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23576
23577Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23578called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23579do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23580path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23581&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23582contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23583&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23584&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23585
23586These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23587and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23588folders. Consider this example:
23589.code
23590maildir_format = true
23591directory = /var/mail/$local_part_verified\
23592 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23593 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23594maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23595.endd
23596If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23597delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23598the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23599not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23600&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23601&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23602
23603However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23604delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23605does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23606&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23607directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23608
23609&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23610not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23611&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23612
23613.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23614.cindex "maildir++"
23615If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23616&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23617the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23618Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23619down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23620the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23621amount of space used.
23622
23623One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23624computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23625checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23626needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23627use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23628of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23629
23630
23631
23632
23633.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23634If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23635When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23636tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23637name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23638the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23639
23640
23641.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23642Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23643&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23644happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23645variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23646forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23647be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23648Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23649empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23650colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23651maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23652backwards compatibility).
23653
23654For one common implementation, you might set:
23655.code
23656maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23657.endd
23658but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23659
23660It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23661as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23662&[stat()]& each message file.
23663
23664
23665.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23666.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23667.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23668If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23669storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23670within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23671creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23672the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23673to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23674
23675The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23676messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23677in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23678value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23679is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23680need to know the quota.
23681
23682If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23683file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23684
23685A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23686maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23687See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23688details.
23689
23690
23691.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23692.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23693If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23694files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23695message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23696this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23697contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23698itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23699
23700During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23701&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23702&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23703mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23704file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23705the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23706
23707The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23708option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23709the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23710There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23711greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23712appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23713
23714If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23715failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23716configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23717&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23718
23719
23720.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23721If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23722file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23723messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23724section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23725.code
23726directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23727.endd
23728might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23729then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23730expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23731.ecindex IIDapptra1
23732.ecindex IIDapptra2
23733
23734
23735
23736
23737
23738
23739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23741
23742.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23743.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23744.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23745The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23746the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23747automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23748&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23749to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23750
23751If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23752&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23753delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23754that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23755another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23756
23757
23758The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23759&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23760directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23761message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23762empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23763
23764The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23765by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23766passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23767transport is run as a consequence of a
23768&%mail%&
23769or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23770supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23771that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23772case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23773is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23774&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23775
23776&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23777command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23778gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23779&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23780
23781There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23782that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23783&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23784address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23785separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23786the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23787message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23788
23789Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23790message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23791immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23792the transport defers.
23793Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23794controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23795
23796If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23797&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23798of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23799&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23800
23801.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23802If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23803the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23804as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23805is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23806problems. They are just discarded.
23807
23808
23809
23810.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23811.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23812
23813.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23814This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23815message when the message is specified by the transport.
23816
23817
23818.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23819This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23820when the message is specified by the transport.
23821
23822
23823.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23824The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23825is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23826string comes first.
23827
23828
23829.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23830If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23831subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23832
23833
23834.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23835If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23836option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23837
23838
23839.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23840This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23841specified by the transport.
23842
23843
23844.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23845This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23846when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23847&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23848
23849
23850.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23851This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23852the message is specified by the transport.
23853
23854
23855.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23856If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23857used.
23858
23859
23860.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23861If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23862item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23863discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23864generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23865
23866
23867
23868.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23869This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23870recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23871This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23872
23873If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23874By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23875is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23876However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23877message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23878this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23879prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23880infinity.
23881
23882If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23883and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23884greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23885Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23886regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23887
23888In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23889which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23890be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23891means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23892unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23893file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23894
23895
23896.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23897See &%once%& above.
23898
23899
23900.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23901See &%once%& above.
23902After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23903
23904
23905.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23906This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23907specified by the transport.
23908
23909
23910.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23911If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23912message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23913configuration option.
23914
23915
23916.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23917This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23918specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23919automatic responses. For example:
23920.code
23921subject = Re: $h_subject:
23922.endd
23923There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23924subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23925bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23926non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23927small.
23928
23929
23930
23931.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23932This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23933message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23934the text comes first.
23935
23936
23937.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23938This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23939when the message is specified by the transport.
23940.ecindex IIDauttra1
23941.ecindex IIDauttra2
23942
23943
23944
23945
23946. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23947. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23948
23949.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23950.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23951.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23952.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23953.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23954The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23955specified command
23956or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23957This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23958transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23959implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23960to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23961has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23962.code
23963TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23964.endd
23965.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23966is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23967included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23968as follows:
23969
23970.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23971See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23972
23973
23974.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23975This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23976Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23977good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23978batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23979
23980
23981.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23982This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23983is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23984arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23985number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23986is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23987LMTP protocol.
23988
23989.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23990.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23991If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23992commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23993in its response to the LHLO command.
23994
23995.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23996This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23997be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23998delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23999
24000
24001.option timeout lmtp time 5m
24002The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24003respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24004is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24005LMTP transport:
24006.code
24007lmtp:
24008 driver = lmtp
24009 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24010 batch_max = 20
24011 user = exim
24012.endd
24013This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24014necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24015
24016
24017
24018. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24019. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24020
24021.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24022.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24023.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24024The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24025running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24026pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24027(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24028their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24029following ways:
24030
24031.ilist
24032.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24033A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24034transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24035contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24036is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24037.next
24038.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24039If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24040transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24041more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24042(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24043(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24044that are routed to the transport.
24045.next
24046.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24047A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24048alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24049pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24050&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24051(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24052this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24053.endlist
24054
24055
24056The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24057deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24058implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24059
24060In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24061&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24062other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24063transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24064directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24065details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24066for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24067
24068.new
24069.cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24070.cindex pipe "tainted data"
24071Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24072.wen
24073
24074
24075.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24076If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24077delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24078any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24079write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24080Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24081of "1" to enforce serialization.
24082
24083
24084
24085
24086.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24087.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24088If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24089have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24090the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24091in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24092later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24093logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24094&"local delivery failed"&.
24095
24096If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24097the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24098will be sent as normal.
24099
24100If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24101script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24102value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24103apply in this case.
24104
24105If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24106return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24107asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24108a non-existent command may be the problem.
24109
24110The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24111set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24112error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24113return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24114included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24115similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24116failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24117&%temp_errors%&.
24118
24119
24120
24121.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24122.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24123The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24124by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24125&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24126run.
24127
24128.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24129Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24130double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24131way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24132
24133String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24134traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24135expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24136For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24137quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24138.code
24139command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24140.endd
24141will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24142arguments. You have to write
24143.code
24144command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24145.endd
24146to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24147argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24148result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24149interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24150generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24151expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24152example:
24153.code
24154command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24155.endd
24156
24157.cindex "transport" "filter"
24158.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24159.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24160Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24161&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24162This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24163place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24164transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24165inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24166avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24167&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24168
24169If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24170for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24171is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24172argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24173&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24174the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24175should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24176run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24177
24178After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24179in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24180message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24181standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24182read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24183may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24184control what is done with it.
24185
24186Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24187in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24188taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24189explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24190where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24191under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24192an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24193works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24194as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24195&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24196with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24197
24198
24199
24200.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24201.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24202.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24203The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24204This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24205the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24206environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24207to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24208.display
24209&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24210&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24211&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24212&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24213&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24214&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24215&`LOGNAME `& see below
24216&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24217&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24218&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24219&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24220&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24221&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24222&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24223&`USER `& see below
24224.endd
24225When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24226router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24227called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24228the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24229removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24230LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24231same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24232
24233.cindex "HOST"
24234HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24235associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24236pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24237the router.
24238
24239.cindex "HOME"
24240If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24241for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24242by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24243user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24244
24245
24246.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24247.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24248
24249
24250
24251.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24252.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24253The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24254permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24255permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24256paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24257&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24258in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24259the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24260&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24261otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24262example, if
24263.code
24264allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24265.endd
24266and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24267&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24268&%use_shell%& is set.
24269
24270
24271.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24272See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24273
24274
24275.option batch_max pipe integer 1
24276This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24277See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24278
24279
24280.option check_string pipe string unset
24281As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24282&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24283by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24284&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24285any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24286of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24287the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24288ignored.
24289
24290
24291.option command pipe string&!! unset
24292This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24293obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24294set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24295the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24296Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24297&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24298
24299
24300.option environment pipe string&!! unset
24301.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24302.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24303This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24304command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24305a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24306environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24307
24308
24309.option escape_string pipe string unset
24310See &%check_string%& above.
24311
24312
24313.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24314.cindex "exec failure"
24315.cindex "failure of exec"
24316.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24317Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24318any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24319is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24320frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24321
24322
24323.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24324.cindex "signal exit"
24325.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24326Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24327a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24328frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24329
24330
24331.option force_command pipe boolean false
24332.cindex "force command"
24333.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24334Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24335the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24336is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24337useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24338command. For example:
24339.code
24340command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24341force_command
24342.endd
24343
24344Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24345&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24346separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24347
24348
24349.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24350If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24351run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24352Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24353from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24354&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24355
24356&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24357See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24358
24359
24360.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24361.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24362If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24363one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24364and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24365written to the main log.
24366
24367
24368.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24369If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24370stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24371the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24372failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24373option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24374be set.
24375
24376
24377.option log_output pipe boolean false
24378If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24379stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24380the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24381exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24382
24383
24384.option max_output pipe integer 20K
24385This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24386standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24387process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24388catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24389the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24390&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24391exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24392
24393
24394.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24395The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24396The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24397.code
24398message_prefix = \
24399 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24400 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24401.endd
24402.cindex "Cyrus"
24403.cindex "&%tmail%&"
24404.cindex "&""From""& line"
24405This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24406However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24407or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24408setting
24409.code
24410message_prefix =
24411.endd
24412&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24413&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24414
24415
24416.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24417The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24418The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24419The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24420.code
24421message_suffix =
24422.endd
24423&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24424&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24425
24426
24427.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24428This option is expanded and
24429specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24430variable of the subprocess.
24431If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24432sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24433apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24434
24435
24436.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24437Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24438a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24439during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24440It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24441for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24442resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24443installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24444of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24445
24446
24447.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24448.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24449If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24450process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24451to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24452&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24453accept the message is used.
24454
24455
24456.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24457When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24458contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24459in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24460command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24461handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24462
24463
24464.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24465If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24466return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24467is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24468However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24469message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24470&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24471
24472
24473
24474.option return_output pipe boolean false
24475If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24476deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24477is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24478However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24479output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24480option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24481of them may be set.
24482
24483
24484
24485.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24486.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24487This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24488asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24489and &%return_output%& is not set,
24490and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24491temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24492numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24493codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24494defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24495compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24496and 73, respectively.
24497
24498
24499.option timeout pipe time 1h
24500If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24501causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24502specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24503command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24504and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24505if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24506
24507.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24508A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24509runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24510treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24511is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24512delivery to be deferred.
24513
24514.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24515This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24516
24517
24518.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24519.cindex "envelope sender"
24520If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24521SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24522commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24523you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24524&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24525
24526.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24527.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24528This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24529BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24530resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24531limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24532class database.
24533
24534
24535.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24536.cindex "carriage return"
24537.cindex "linefeed"
24538This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24539(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24540of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24541of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24542
24543The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24544written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24545are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24546&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24547values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24548
24549
24550.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24551.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24552If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24553instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24554&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24555where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24556modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24557&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24558command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24559its &%-c%& option.
24560
24561
24562
24563.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24564.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24565.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24566.cindex "external local delivery"
24567.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24568.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24569The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24570delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24571this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24572uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24573by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24574necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24575appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24576configuration for &%procmail%&:
24577.code
24578# transport
24579procmail_pipe:
24580 driver = pipe
24581 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24582 return_path_add
24583 delivery_date_add
24584 envelope_to_add
24585 check_string = "From "
24586 escape_string = ">From "
24587 umask = 077
24588 user = $local_part
24589 group = mail
24590
24591# router
24592procmail:
24593 driver = accept
24594 check_local_user
24595 transport = procmail_pipe
24596.endd
24597In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24598&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24599or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24600user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24601&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24602home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24603
24604&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24605.code
24606IFS=" "
24607.endd
24608as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24609use a shell to run pipe commands.
24610
24611.cindex "Cyrus"
24612The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24613deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24614.code
24615# transport
24616local_delivery_cyrus:
24617 driver = pipe
24618 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24619 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24620 user = cyrus
24621 group = mail
24622 return_output
24623 log_output
24624 message_prefix =
24625 message_suffix =
24626
24627# router
24628local_user_cyrus:
24629 driver = accept
24630 check_local_user
24631 local_part_suffix = .*
24632 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24633.endd
24634Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24635&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24636sender.
24637.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24638.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24639
24640
24641. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24642. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24643
24644.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24645.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24646.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24647The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24648or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24649that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24650explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24651&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24652
24653
24654.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24655The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24656two ways:
24657
24658.ilist
24659If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24660routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24661that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24662the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24663does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24664value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24665section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24666.next
24667.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24668When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24669looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24670connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24671for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24672process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24673process.
24674.endlist
24675
24676
24677For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24678incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24679no further messages are sent over that connection.
24680
24681
24682
24683.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24684.vindex "&$host$&"
24685.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24686At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24687&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24688passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24689specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24690&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24691that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24692&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24693
24694
24695.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24696.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24697.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24698.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24699.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24700At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24701&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24702are the values that were set when the message was received.
24703These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24704SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24705variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24706appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24707are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24708&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24709
24710These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24711and will be removed in a future release.
24712
24713
24714.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24715.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24716The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24717
24718
24719.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24720.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24721When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24722is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24723runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24724reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24725setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24726problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24727
24728.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24729.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24730.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24731When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24732to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24733deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24734the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24735configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24736configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24737
24738
24739.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24740.cindex "Cyrus"
24741When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24742is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24743overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24744forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24745to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24746ignored.
24747
24748The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24749started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24750&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24751particular connection.
24752
24753If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24754&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24755deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24756unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24757
24758This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24759deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24760&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24761.code
24762authenticated_sender = $local_part
24763.endd
24764This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24765allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24766
24767Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24768domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24769value.
24770
24771
24772.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24773If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24774is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24775authenticated as a client.
24776
24777
24778.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24779This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24780sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24781remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24782
24783
24784.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24785This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24786to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24787several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24788less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24789systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24790option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24791
24792
24793.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24794.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24795.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24796.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24797This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24798over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24799For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24800option.
24801
24802
24803.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24804.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24805.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24806.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24807This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24808where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24809If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24810Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24811configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24812been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24813TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24814counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24815If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24816be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24817
24818
24819.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24820This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24821the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24822of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24823
24824
24825.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24826DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24827.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24828DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24829.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24830DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24831.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24832DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24833.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24834DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24835.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24836DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24837.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24838DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24839.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24840DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24841.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24842DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24843
24844
24845.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24846.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24847.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24848This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24849domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24850cutoff times.
24851
24852In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24853them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24854Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24855retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24856a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24857unhappy at this prospect, so...
24858
24859If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24860addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24861IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24862none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24863delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24864addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24865continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24866&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24867to them.
24868
24869
24870.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24871If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24872and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24873the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24874in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24875
24876
24877.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24878If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24879&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24880See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24881details.
24882
24883
24884.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24885.cindex "MX record" "security"
24886.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24887.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24888.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24889DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24890the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24891transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24892router option.
24893
24894
24895
24896.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24897.cindex "MX record" "security"
24898.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24899.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24900.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24901DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24902the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24903useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24904&%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24905
24906
24907
24908.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24909.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24910This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24911of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24912The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24913Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24914&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24915
24916The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24917(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24918that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24919equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24920Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24921
24922
24923.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24924.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24925String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24926colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24927port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24928&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24929item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24930in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24931
24932Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24933addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24934&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24935not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24936&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24937However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24938
24939If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24940the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24941transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24942address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24943list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24944
24945Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24946re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24947addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24948copy of the message is sent.
24949
24950The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24951&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24952both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24953from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24954fails"& facility.
24955
24956
24957.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24958This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24959line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24960zero.
24961
24962.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24963If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24964being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24965(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24966instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24967it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24968
24969.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24970This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24971server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24972implementations of TLS.
24973
24974.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24975.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24976.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24977.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24978The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24979been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24980command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24981option is:
24982.code
24983$primary_hostname
24984.endd
24985During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24986the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24987&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24988used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24989servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24990that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24991interface address, you could use this:
24992.code
24993helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24994 {$primary_hostname}}
24995.endd
24996The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24997callouts.
24998
24999.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25000Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25001finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25002&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25003email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25004all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25005
25006The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25007processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25008&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25009&%hosts_override%& is set.
25010
25011The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25012list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25013separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25014&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25015item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25016in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25017of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25018
25019If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25020the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25021well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25022address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25023&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25024&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25025that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25026address are used.
25027
25028During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25029unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25030
25031
25032.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25033.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25034.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25035.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25036.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25037This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25038example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25039matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25040start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25041facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25042
25043
25044.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25045.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25046Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25047that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25048
25049.option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25050.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25051.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
25052If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25053this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25054and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25055
25056The retry hints database is used for the record,
25057and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25058When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25059It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25060so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25061
25062See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25063
25064Note:
25065When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
25066will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25067is filled in.
25068A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25069presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25070can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25071You have been warned.
25072
25073
25074.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25075.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25076Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25077matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25078
25079.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25080.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25081Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25082or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25083to any host that matches this list.
25084
25085
25086.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25087.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25088.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25089.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25090.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25091This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25092delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25093&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25094
25095
25096.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25097This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25098tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25099why it exists.
25100
25101
25102
25103.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25104.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25105.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25106.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25107For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25108been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25109message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25110explanation of when this might be needed.
25111
25112.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25113.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25114.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25115.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25116For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25117been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25118message on the same session.
25119
25120The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25121process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25122sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25123instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25124the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25125The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25126logging.
25127
25128
25129
25130.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25131If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25132attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25133&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25134&%fallback_hosts%&.
25135
25136
25137.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25138.cindex "randomized host list"
25139.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25140.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25141If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25142&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25143were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25144router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25145is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25146list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25147
25148When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25149order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25150behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25151&`+`& in the host list. For example:
25152.code
25153hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25154.endd
25155The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25156randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25157If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25158
25159.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25160.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25161This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25162before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25163servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25164authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25165temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25166hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25167&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25168
25169
25170.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
25171.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25172Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25173TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25174&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25175
25176.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25177.cindex DANE "transport options"
25178.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25179If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25180TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25181and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25182the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25183There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25184See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25185
25186.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25187.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25188Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25189TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25190&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25191
25192.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25193.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25194Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25195matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25196&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25197incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25198
25199.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25200.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25201This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25202authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25203connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
25204unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
25205&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25206
25207.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25208.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25209.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25210.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25211This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25212CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25213.new
25214Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25215.wen
25216BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25217
25218.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25219.cindex DANE "transport options"
25220.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25221If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25222TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25223and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25224the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25225There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25226See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25227
25228.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25229.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25230.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25231.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25232This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25233the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25234perform a TCP Fast Open.
25235No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25236supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25237the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25238
25239The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25240as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25241
25242On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25243in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25244There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25245it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25246such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25247
25248.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25249.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25250This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25251PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25252for multi-recipient messages.
25253The option can usually be left as default.
25254
25255.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25256.cindex "bind IP address"
25257.cindex "IP address" "binding"
25258.vindex "&$host$&"
25259.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25260This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25261call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25262&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25263message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25264&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25265outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25266interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25267unknown.
25268
25269During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25270&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25271during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25272string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25273string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25274separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25275For example:
25276.code
25277interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25278.endd
25279The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25280connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25281&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25282interface to use if the host has more than one.
25283
25284
25285.option keepalive smtp boolean true
25286.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25287This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25288connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25289periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25290of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25291or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25292that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25293that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25294TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25295unreachable hosts.
25296
25297
25298.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25299.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25300If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25301string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25302has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25303
25304.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25305.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25306This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25307SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25308so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25309permits this.
25310
25311
25312.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25313.vindex "&$domain$&"
25314When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25315addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25316to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25317handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25318&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25319is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25320
25321It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25322&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25323&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25324
25325.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25326.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25327.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25328This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25329&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25330received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25331The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25332variable that contains an outgoing port.
25333
25334If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25335otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25336normally &"smtp"&,
25337but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25338and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25339If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25340is deferred.
25341
25342Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25343to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25344
25345
25346
25347.option protocol smtp string smtp
25348.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25349.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25350.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25351.vindex "&$port$&"
25352If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25353the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25354protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25355deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25356over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25357
25358If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25359changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25360connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25361The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25362but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25363(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25364
25365
25366.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25367Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25368constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25369means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25370tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25371addresses is not affected.
25372
25373However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25374each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25375the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25376Exim to use only the host name.
25377Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25378
25379
25380.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25381.cindex "serializing connections"
25382.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25383Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25384host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25385the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25386slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25387Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25388&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25389
25390.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25391Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25392written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25393is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25394records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25395guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25396
25397If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25398relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25399start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25400may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25401are used for ETRN serialization.
25402
25403See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25404
25405
25406.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25407.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25408.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25409.cindex "size" "of message"
25410.cindex "transport" "filter"
25411.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25412If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25413MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25414an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25415sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25416configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25417this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25418
25419Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25420the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25421
25422
25423.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25424.cindex proxy SOCKS
25425This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25426transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25427
25428
25429.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25430.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25431.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25432.vindex "&$host$&"
25433.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25434The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25435client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25436connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25437address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25438details of TLS.
25439
25440&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25441certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25442name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25443assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25444client.
25445
25446
25447.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25448.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25449.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25450This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25451be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25452
25453
25454.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25455.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25456When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25457key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25458for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25459If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25460will fail.
25461
25462Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25463
25464
25465.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25466.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25467.vindex "&$host$&"
25468.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25469The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25470client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25471connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25472&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25473expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25474result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25475the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25476
25477
25478.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25479.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25480.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25481.vindex "&$host$&"
25482.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25483The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25484when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25485the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25486&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25487expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25488is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25489&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25490ciphers is a preference order.
25491
25492
25493
25494.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25495.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25496.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25497If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25498TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25499the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25500certificate and private key for the session.
25501
25502See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25503
25504Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25505TLS extensions.
25506
25507
25508
25509
25510.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25511.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25512When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25513setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25514to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25515current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25516option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25517response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25518TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25519unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25520in clear.
25521
25522
25523.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25524.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25525.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25526This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25527certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25528The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25529Note that unless the host is in this list
25530TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25531when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25532The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25533certificate verification succeeds.
25534
25535
25536.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25537.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25538.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25539This option give a list of hosts for which,
25540while verifying the server certificate,
25541checks will be included on the host name
25542(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25543versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25544limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25545
25546There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25547
25548
25549.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25550.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25551.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25552.vindex "&$host$&"
25553.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25554The value of this option must be either the
25555word "system"
25556or the absolute path to
25557a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25558for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25559
25560The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25561This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25562is taken as empty and an explicit location
25563must be specified.
25564
25565The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25566preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25567
25568With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25569explicitly
25570either by file or directory
25571are added to those given by the system default location.
25572
25573The values of &$host$& and
25574&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25575expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25576
25577For back-compatibility,
25578if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25579(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25580and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25581
25582
25583.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25584.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25585.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25586This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25587certificate verification must succeed.
25588The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25589If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25590operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25591
25592.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25593.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25594.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25595If built with internationalization support,
25596this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25597to a-label form.
25598For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25599
25600
25601
25602
25603.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25604 "SECTvalhosmax"
25605.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25606.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25607There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25608tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25609&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25610
25611
25612The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25613for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25614option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25615multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25616retrying.
25617
25618Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25619multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25620created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25621
25622Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25623several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25624problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25625&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25626delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25627
25628Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25629arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25630limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25631some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25632&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25633that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25634see below for an exception).
25635
25636Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25637list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25638If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25639but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25640that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25641
25642Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25643higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25644hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25645which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25646tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25647reached their retry times.
25648
25649However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25650large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25651Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25652of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25653time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25654without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25655all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25656there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25657the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25658every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25659reached.
25660
25661The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25662particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25663out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25664reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25665been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25666take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25667
25668The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25669Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25670and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25671possible IP addresses have been tried.
25672.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25673.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25674
25675
25676
25677
25678
25679. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25680. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25681
25682.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25683.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25684There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25685addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25686(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25687abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25688
25689Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25690messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25691&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25692appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25693locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25694unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25695lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25696
25697One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25698when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25699such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25700do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25701
25702
25703.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25704This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25705main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25706&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25707
25708Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25709Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25710facility; you do not have to use it.
25711
25712The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25713configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25714addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25715address to which it applies.
25716
25717Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25718the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25719rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25720those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25721by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25722are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25723rules.
25724
25725Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25726applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25727well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25728headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25729
25730
25731In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25732legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25733in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25734used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25735Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25736discouraged.
25737
25738There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25739illustrated by these examples:
25740
25741.ilist
25742The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25743exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25744gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25745&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25746.next
25747A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25748&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25749.endlist
25750
25751
25752
25753.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25754.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25755.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25756Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25757message's processing.
25758
25759.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25760At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25761by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25762ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25763is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25764rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25765rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25766RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25767rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25768
25769.vindex "&$domain$&"
25770.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25771Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25772may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25773rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25774from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25775for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25776value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25777as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25778SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25779
25780As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25781recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25782the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25783any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25784.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25785before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25786
25787When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25788rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25789redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25790
25791.cindex "envelope from"
25792.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25793.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25794.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25795At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25796specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25797This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25798section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25799header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25800applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25801
25802The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25803transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25804transport time.
25805
25806
25807
25808
25809.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25810.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25811.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25812Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25813configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25814&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
258152822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25816transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25817appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25818envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25819.code
25820exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25821.endd
25822might produce the output
25823.code
25824sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25825from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25826to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25827cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25828bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25829reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25830env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25831env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25832.endd
25833which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25834the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25835present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25836set for a particular transport.
25837
25838
25839.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25840.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25841The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25842rules in the form
25843.display
25844<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25845.endd
25846Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25847transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25848takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25849any colons must be doubled, of course).
25850
25851The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25852Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25853case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25854characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25855ignored.
25856
25857For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25858order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25859replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25860
25861The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25862releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25863received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25864lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25865address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25866(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25867that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25868
25869.vindex "&$domain$&"
25870.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25871The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25872string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25873rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25874.code
25875*@* ${lookup ...
25876.endd
25877where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25878refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25879
25880
25881.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25882.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25883.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25884The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25885address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25886single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25887against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25888you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25889facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25890
25891Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25892case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25893can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25894
25895.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25896After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25897depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25898replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25899refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25900numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25901of pattern they are set as follows:
25902
25903.ilist
25904If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25905refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25906the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25907pattern
25908.code
25909*queen@*.fict.example
25910.endd
25911is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25912.code
25913$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25914$1 = hearts-
25915$2 = wonderland
25916.endd
25917Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25918does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25919
25920.next
25921If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25922of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25923for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25924rewriting rule of the form
25925.display
25926&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25927.endd
25928and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25929.code
25930$1 = foo
25931$2 = bar
25932$3 = baz.example
25933.endd
25934If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25935wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25936&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25937partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25938whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25939.endlist
25940
25941
25942.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25943.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25944If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25945match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25946rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25947.code
25948hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25949.endd
25950specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25951&'From:'& headers.
25952
25953.vindex "&$domain$&"
25954.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25955If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25956yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25957&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25958Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25959cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25960matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25961the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25962current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25963expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25964entry written to the panic log.
25965
25966
25967
25968.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25969There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25970
25971.ilist
25972Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25973c, f, h, r, s, t.
25974.next
25975A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25976.next
25977Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25978.endlist
25979
25980For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25981E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25982
25983
25984
25985.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25986 "SECID154"
25987.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25988If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25989&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25990and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25991transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25992rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25993.display
25994&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25995&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25996&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25997&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25998&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25999&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26000&`h`& rewrite all headers
26001&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26002&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26003&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26004.endd
26005"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26006individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26007other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26008
26009You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26010restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26011
26012
26013.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
26014.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
26015.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
26016.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
26017The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26018SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26019before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26020required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26021data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26022
26023.vindex "&$domain$&"
26024.vindex "&$local_part$&"
26025This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26026compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26027input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26028the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26029expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26030original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26031
26032
26033.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
26034There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26035take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26036correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26037
26038.ilist
26039If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26040unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26041absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26042.next
26043If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26044even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26045expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26046(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26047.next
26048The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26049address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26050rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26051.next
26052.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26053When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26054to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26055left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26056.code
26057From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26058.endd
26059into
26060.code
26061From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26062.endd
26063.cindex "RFC 2047"
26064Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26065done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26066causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26067replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
260682822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26069brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26070(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26071is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26072
26073When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26074rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26075.endlist
26076
26077
26078.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26079Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26080.code
26081*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26082*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26083 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26084.endd
26085Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26086the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26087has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26088consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26089present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26090explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26091at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26092error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26093
26094The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26095domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26096.code
26097root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26098.endd
26099were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26100local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26101
26102Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26103&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26104messages that originate outside the local host:
26105.code
26106*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26107 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26108.endd
26109The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26110space.
26111
26112.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26113.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26114Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26115an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26116the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26117remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26118sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26119components. For example, the rule
26120.code
26121\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26122.endd
26123rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26124&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26125a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26126method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26127to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26128use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26129can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26130.ecindex IIDaddrew
26131
26132
26133
26134
26135
26136. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26137. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26138
26139.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26140.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26141.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26142The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26143retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26144be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26145empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26146errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26147general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26148line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26149address, domain and error.
26150
26151The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26152host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26153Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26154address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26155been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26156tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26157log selector is set, the message
26158.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26159&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26160skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26161the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26162
26163Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26164in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26165actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26166failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26167the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26168added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26169same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26170domain are maintained independently.
26171
26172When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26173receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26174always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26175behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26176quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26177suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26178subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26179the local address is reached.
26180
26181.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26182If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26183whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26184files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26185always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26186
26187The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26188rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26189record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26190timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26191and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26192messages that it should now be retaining.
26193
26194
26195
26196.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26197.cindex "retry" "rules"
26198Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26199separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26200addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26201enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26202in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26203present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26204message's sender, respectively.
26205
26206
26207The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26208&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26209which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26210has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26211list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26212which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26213example,
26214.code
26215lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26216.endd
26217provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26218whereas
26219.code
26220alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26221.endd
26222applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26223In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26224part.
26225
26226.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26227&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26228must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26229expressions work in address lists.
26230.display
26231&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26232&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26233.endd
26234
26235
26236.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26237When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26238example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26239against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26240router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26241regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26242A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26243&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26244&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26245
26246Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26247failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26248configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26249&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26250local transports).
26251
26252.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26253However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26254suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26255whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26256rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26257failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26258recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26259reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26260&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26261lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26262commands.
26263
26264
26265
26266.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26267 "SECID160"
26268For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26269example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26270twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26271&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26272the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26273suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26274.code
26275a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26276 MX 6 p.q.r.example
26277 MX 7 m.n.o.example
26278.endd
26279and the retry rules are
26280.code
26281p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26282a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26283.endd
26284and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26285first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26286rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26287to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26288tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26289first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26290
26291In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26292first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26293&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26294routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26295
26296&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26297However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26298host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26299.code
26300route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26301.endd
26302then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26303textual form of the IP address.
26304
26305.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26306.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26307The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26308asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26309
26310.vlist
26311.vitem &%auth_failed%&
26312Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26313&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26314
26315.vitem &%data_4xx%&
26316A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26317after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26318
26319.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26320A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26321
26322.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26323A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26324.endlist
26325
26326For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26327as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26328recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26329and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26330retry rule of this form:
26331.code
26332the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26333.endd
26334These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26335LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26336
26337.vlist
26338.vitem &%lost_connection%&
26339A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26340legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26341for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26342
26343.vitem &%lookup%&
26344A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26345Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26346its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26347Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26348its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26349
26350.vitem &%refused_MX%&
26351A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26352
26353.vitem &%refused_A%&
26354A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26355
26356.vitem &%refused%&
26357A connection was refused.
26358
26359.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26360A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26361
26362.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26363A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26364
26365.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26366A connection attempt timed out.
26367
26368.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26369There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26370obtained from an MX record.
26371
26372.vitem &%timeout_A%&
26373There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26374obtained from an MX record.
26375
26376.vitem &%timeout%&
26377There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26378
26379.vitem &%tls_required%&
26380The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26381&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26382to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26383
26384.vitem &%quota%&
26385A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26386transport.
26387
26388.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26389.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26390.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26391A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26392transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26393&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26394for four days.
26395.endlist
26396
26397.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26398The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26399timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26400it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26401However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26402heuristic rules:
26403
26404.ilist
26405If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26406used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26407quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26408.next
26409.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26410For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26411subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26412the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26413change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26414MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26415time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26416.next
26417For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26418obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26419.endlist
26420
26421The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26422mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26423when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26424error).
26425
26426
26427
26428.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26429.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26430You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26431specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26432apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26433form:
26434.display
26435&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26436.endd
26437The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26438.code
26439* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26440.endd
26441matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26442host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26443For example:
26444.code
26445a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26446.endd
26447&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26448(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26449only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26450its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26451all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26452
26453When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26454&%-f%& command line option, like this:
26455.code
26456exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26457.endd
26458If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26459list is never matched.
26460
26461
26462
26463
26464
26465.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26466.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26467The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26468sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26469.display
26470<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26471.endd
26472The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26473time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26474arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26475time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26476relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26477
26478.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26479.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26480.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26481.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26482The available algorithms are:
26483
26484.ilist
26485&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26486the interval.
26487.next
26488&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26489specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26490is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26491.next
26492&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26493retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26494maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26495the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26496rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26497members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26498queue processing times.
26499.endlist
26500
26501When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26502order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26503used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26504case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26505current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26506computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26507interval is found. The main configuration variable
26508.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26509.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26510.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26511&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26512cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26513
26514A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26515host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26516basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26517for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26518generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26519time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26520time.
26521
26522.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26523Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26524run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26525starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26526new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26527If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26528occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26529messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26530processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26531your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26532number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26533sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26534
26535The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26536&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26537&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26538&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26539are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26540deliveries that have been deferred.
26541
26542
26543.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26544Here are some example retry rules:
26545.code
26546alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26547wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26548wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26549lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26550* refused_A F,2h,20m;
26551* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26552.endd
26553The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26554&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26555mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26556hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26557parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26558effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26559fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26560days.
26561
26562The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26563happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26564intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26565first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26566so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26567
26568The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26569They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26570all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26571were not obtained from an MX record.
26572
26573The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26574first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26575not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26576hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
265771.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26578
26579
26580
26581.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26582.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26583.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26584.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26585.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26586Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26587consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26588set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26589been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26590arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26591failing for the first time.
26592
26593This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26594backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26595Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26596down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26597
26598If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26599every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26600message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26601
26602
26603
26604
26605.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26606.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26607.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26608Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26609that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26610default retry rule:
26611.code
26612* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26613.endd
26614the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26615long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26616failure for the recipient address that counts.
26617
26618When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26619addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26620causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26621In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26622time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26623
26624For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26625messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26626post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26627
26628.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26629.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26630If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26631.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26632&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26633default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26634as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26635reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26636attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26637those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26638the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26639
26640In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26641for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26642times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26643behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26644to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26645notice.
26646
26647If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26648addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26649addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26650no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26651words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26652addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26653If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26654&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26655deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26656true.
26657
26658.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26659.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26660Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26661intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26662its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26663because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26664host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26665failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26666reached.
26667
26668Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26669applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26670Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26671examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26672commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26673time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26674is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26675time out the address.
26676
26677The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26678the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26679given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26680time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26681not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26682considered immediately.
26683.ecindex IIDretconf1
26684.ecindex IIDregconf2
26685
26686
26687
26688
26689
26690
26691. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26692. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26693
26694.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26695.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26696.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26697The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26698with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26699described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26700to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26701permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26702transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26703other.
26704
26705.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26706Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26707
26708.ilist
26709The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26710the client's EHLO command.
26711.next
26712The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26713may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26714.next
26715The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26716appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26717just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26718any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26719with the AUTH command.
26720.next
26721The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26722.next
26723If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26724option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26725mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26726connection.
26727.next
26728If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26729authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26730unauthenticated connection.
26731.endlist
26732
26733If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26734mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26735SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26736includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26737.display
26738&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26739&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26740&`Connected to server.example.`&
26741&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26742&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26743&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26744&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26745&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26746&`250-PIPELINING`&
26747&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26748&`250 HELP`&
26749.endd
26750The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26751authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26752mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26753routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26754controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26755included by setting
26756.code
26757AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26758AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26759AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26760AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26761AUTH_GSASL=yes
26762AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26763AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26764AUTH_SPA=yes
26765AUTH_TLS=yes
26766.endd
26767in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26768authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26769the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26770The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26771work via a socket interface.
26772The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26773as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26774The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26775provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26776The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26777supporting setting a server keytab.
26778The seventh can be configured to support
26779the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26780not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26781The eighth authenticator
26782supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26783The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26784instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26785
26786The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26787section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26788authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26789authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26790is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26791messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26792options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26793
26794To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26795&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26796either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26797functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26798to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26799both sets of options, is required. For example:
26800.code
26801cram:
26802 driver = cram_md5
26803 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26804 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26805 client_name = ph10
26806 client_secret = secret2
26807.endd
26808The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26809&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26810
26811Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26812The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26813authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26814in Exim.
26815
26816&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26817per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26818account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26819authenticating data.
26820
26821Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26822&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26823and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26824Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26825used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26826second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26827user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26828configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26829&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26830as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26831choose to honour.
26832
26833A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26834to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26835mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26836typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26837
26838
26839
26840.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26841.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26842.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26843
26844.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26845When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26846&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26847used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26848encrypted by a setting such as:
26849.code
26850client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26851.endd
26852
26853
26854.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26855When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26856result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26857Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26858
26859
26860.option driver authenticators string unset
26861This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26862authenticators is to be used.
26863
26864
26865.option public_name authenticators string unset
26866This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26867implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26868contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26869but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26870defaults to the driver's instance name.
26871
26872
26873.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26874When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26875is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26876mechanism is not advertised.
26877If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26878forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26879See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26880
26881
26882.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26883This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26884is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26885for details.
26886
26887For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26888mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26889
26890For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26891authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26892authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26893authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26894to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26895error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26896string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26897expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26898other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26899the error text.
26900
26901
26902.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26903If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26904command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26905output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26906out the values of variables.
26907If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26908output, and Exim carries on processing.
26909
26910
26911.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26912.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26913.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26914When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26915expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26916messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26917lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26918configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26919refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26920On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26921the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26922If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26923
26924
26925.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26926This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26927as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26928driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26929as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26930remembered for later use.
26931How it is used is described in the following section.
26932
26933
26934
26935
26936
26937.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26938.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26939.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26940When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26941the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26942message:
26943
26944.ilist
26945If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26946than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26947.next
26948If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26949.next
26950.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26951If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26952running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26953from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26954&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26955return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26956given for the MAIL command.
26957.next
26958If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26959is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26960authenticated.
26961.next
26962If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26963the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26964&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26965valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26966fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26967&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26968the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26969message.
26970.endlist
26971
26972
26973When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26974hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26975&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26976process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26977
26978.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26979Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26980MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26981therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26982value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26983ACL is run.
26984
26985
26986
26987.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26988.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26989When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26990authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26991conditions:
26992
26993.ilist
26994The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26995.next
26996It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26997yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26998.endlist
26999
27000The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27001the mechanisms are advertised.
27002
27003Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27004provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27005even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27006set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27007You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27008For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27009that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27010.code
27011auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27012.endd
27013so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27014
27015The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27016authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27017advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27018such as:
27019.code
27020server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27021.endd
27022.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27023If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27024yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27025
27026When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27027immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27028command. This is the case if
27029
27030.ilist
27031The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27032.next
27033No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27034.next
27035Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27036server authenticators.
27037.endlist
27038
27039
27040Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27041to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27042AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27043
27044If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27045server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27046that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27047the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27048fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27049rejected with a 504 error.
27050
27051.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27052.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27053When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27054&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27055or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27056public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27057client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27058no successful authentication.
27059
27060.cindex authentication "expansion item"
27061Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27062&%authresults%& expansion item.
27063
27064
27065
27066
27067.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27068.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27069.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27070.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27071Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27072configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27073encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27074script:
27075.code
27076use MIME::Base64;
27077printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27078.endd
27079.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27080This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27081interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27082some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27083command line to run this script on such data might be
27084.code
27085encode '\0user\0password'
27086.endd
27087Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27088backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27089whose code value is zero.
27090
27091&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27092digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27093you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27094interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27095
27096&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27097specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27098example, a command such as
27099.code
27100encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27101.endd
27102gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27103
27104If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
27105base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27106.code
27107echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27108.endd
27109The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27110in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27111output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27112should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27113
27114
27115
27116.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27117.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27118The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27119&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27120announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27121of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27122
27123.ilist
27124For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27125they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27126mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27127of the authenticator.
27128.next
27129.vindex "&$host$&"
27130.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27131When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27132variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27133that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27134any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27135Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27136delivery to be deferred.
27137.next
27138If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27139Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27140try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27141usual way.
27142.next
27143If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27144carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27145possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27146no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27147what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27148&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27149delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27150turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27151deliver the message unauthenticated.
27152.endlist
27153
27154Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27155confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27156upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27157router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27158the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27159running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27160check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27161No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27162
27163For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27164
27165.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27166When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27167parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27168the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27169is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27170incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27171allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27172to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27173&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27174&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27175the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27176.ecindex IIDauthconf1
27177.ecindex IIDauthconf2
27178
27179
27180
27181
27182
27183
27184. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27185. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27186
27187.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27188.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27189.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27190The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27191LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27192plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27193security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27194(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27195use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27196connections as you do for login accounts.
27197
27198.section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27199The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27200TLS is not being used:
27201.code
27202 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27203 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27204.endd
27205
27206&*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27207but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27208(including their names) have been properly verified.
27209
27210.section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27211.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27212When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27213
27214.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27215This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27216configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27217
27218.option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27219The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27220prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27221given.
27222
27223.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27224.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27225.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27226.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27227 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27228.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27229.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27230
27231When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27232expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27233response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27234values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27235a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27236are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27237(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27238
27239For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27240the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27241variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27242string expansions that also use them for other things.
27243
27244If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27245supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27246data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27247
27248.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27249Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27250&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27251authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27252to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27253&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27254expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27255generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27256For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27257string as the error text.
27258
27259&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27260password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27261There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27262
27263
27264
27265.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27266.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27267.cindex authentication PLAIN
27268.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27269The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27270sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27271separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27272subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27273
27274The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27275Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27276configured as follows:
27277.code
27278fixed_plain:
27279 driver = plaintext
27280 public_name = PLAIN
27281 server_prompts = :
27282 server_condition = \
27283 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27284 server_set_id = $auth2
27285.endd
27286Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27287are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27288password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27289or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27290
27291The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27292the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27293AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27294authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27295.code
27296250-AUTH PLAIN
27297.endd
27298and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27299.code
27300AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27301.endd
27302As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27303data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27304.code
27305AUTH PLAIN
27306.endd
27307to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27308prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27309
27310The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27311when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27312represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27313is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27314second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27315
27316Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27317realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27318authenticating clients it could make sense.
27319
27320A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27321&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27322comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27323this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27324This is an incorrect example:
27325.code
27326server_condition = \
27327 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27328.endd
27329The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27330which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27331incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27332non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27333strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27334the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27335name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27336.code
27337server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27338 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27339.endd
27340In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27341fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27342used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27343always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27344writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27345
27346
27347.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27348.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27349.cindex authentication LOGIN
27350The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27351in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27352user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27353plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27354.code
27355fixed_login:
27356 driver = plaintext
27357 public_name = LOGIN
27358 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27359 server_condition = \
27360 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27361 server_set_id = $auth1
27362.endd
27363Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27364with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27365if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27366strings are used to obtain two data items.
27367
27368Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27369example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27370&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27371strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27372name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27373.code
27374login:
27375 driver = plaintext
27376 public_name = LOGIN
27377 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27378 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27379 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27380 ldapauth{\
27381 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27382 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27383 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27384 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27385.endd
27386We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27387does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27388operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27389&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27390correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27391the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27392uninterpreted string.
27393
27394
27395.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27396A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27397interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27398traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27399Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27400&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27401
27402
27403
27404
27405.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27406.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27407The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27408
27409.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27410If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27411authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27412the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27413usual.
27414
27415.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27416The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27417string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27418string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27419to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27420most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27421with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27422way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27423(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27424so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27425&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27426&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27427
27428&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27429splitting takes priority and happens first.
27430
27431Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27432the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27433there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27434NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27435the string.
27436
27437This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27438authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27439.code
27440fixed_plain:
27441 driver = plaintext
27442 public_name = PLAIN
27443 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27444.endd
27445The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27446command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27447that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27448.code
27449fixed_login:
27450 driver = plaintext
27451 public_name = LOGIN
27452 client_send = : username : mysecret
27453.endd
27454The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27455the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27456prompts.
27457.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27458.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27459
27460
27461
27462
27463. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27464. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27465
27466.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27467.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27468.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27469.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27470.cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
27471The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27472sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27473name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27474string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27475is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27476secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27477available in plain text at either end.
27478
27479
27480.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27481.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27482This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27483authenticator as a server:
27484
27485.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27486.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27487When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27488the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27489obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27490that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27491string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27492fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27493returned to the client.
27494
27495For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27496in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27497deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27498numeric variables for other things.
27499
27500For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27501client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27502user name, authentication fails.
27503.code
27504fixed_cram:
27505 driver = cram_md5
27506 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27507 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27508 server_set_id = $auth1
27509.endd
27510.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27511If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27512name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27513secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27514.code
27515lookup_cram:
27516 driver = cram_md5
27517 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27518 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27519 {$value}fail}
27520 server_set_id = $auth1
27521.endd
27522Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27523because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27524
27525As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27526using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27527lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27528realm, with:
27529.code
27530cyrusless_crammd5:
27531 driver = cram_md5
27532 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27533 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27534 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27535 server_set_id = $auth1
27536.endd
27537
27538.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27539.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27540When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27541
27542
27543
27544.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27545This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27546computing the response to the server's challenge.
27547
27548
27549.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27550This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27551expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27552
27553
27554.vindex "&$host$&"
27555.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27556Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27557to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27558expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27559prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27560authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27561send the message to the current server.
27562
27563A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27564strings, is:
27565.code
27566fixed_cram:
27567 driver = cram_md5
27568 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27569 client_name = ph10
27570 client_secret = secret
27571.endd
27572.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27573.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27574
27575
27576
27577. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27578. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27579
27580.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27581.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27582.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27583.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27584.cindex "Kerberos"
27585The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27586at A L Digital Ltd.
27587
27588The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27589library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27590Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27591including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27592directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27593
27594The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27595the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27596then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27597name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27598
27599Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27600or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27601user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27602by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27603depending on the driver you are using.
27604
27605The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27606be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27607Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27608changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27609layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27610implementation.
27611
27612For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27613may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27614variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27615Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27616With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27617environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27618is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27619the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27620
27621
27622.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27623The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27624(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27625previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27626use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27627confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27628things.
27629
27630
27631.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27632This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27633library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27634SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27635
27636
27637.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27638This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27639default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27640you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27641example:
27642.code
27643sasl:
27644 driver = cyrus_sasl
27645 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27646 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27647 server_set_id = $auth1
27648.endd
27649
27650.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27651This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27652
27653
27654.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27655This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27656
27657
27658For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27659private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27660the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27661PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27662.code
27663sasl_cram_md5:
27664 driver = cyrus_sasl
27665 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27666 server_set_id = $auth1
27667
27668sasl_plain:
27669 driver = cyrus_sasl
27670 public_name = PLAIN
27671 server_set_id = $auth2
27672.endd
27673Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27674not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27675but it is present in many binary distributions.
27676.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27677.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27678
27679
27680
27681
27682. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27683. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27684.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27685.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27686.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27687This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27688Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27689Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27690If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27691to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27692authenticator only. There is only one option:
27693
27694.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27695
27696This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27697authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27698mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27699authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27700.code
27701dovecot_plain:
27702 driver = dovecot
27703 public_name = PLAIN
27704 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27705 server_set_id = $auth1
27706
27707dovecot_ntlm:
27708 driver = dovecot
27709 public_name = NTLM
27710 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27711 server_set_id = $auth1
27712.endd
27713If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27714&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27715option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27716connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27717option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27718who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27719
27720.new
27721The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27722something like:
27723.code
27724conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27725
27726service auth {
27727...
27728#SASL
27729 unix_listener auth-client {
27730 mode = 0660
27731 user = mail
27732 }
27733...
27734}
27735
27736conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27737
27738auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27739.endd
27740.wen
27741
27742.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27743.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27744
27745
27746. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27747. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27748.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27749.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27750.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27751.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27752.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27753.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27754.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27755.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27756.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27757.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27758.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27759.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
27760The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27761library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27762and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27763scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27764made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27765without code changes in Exim.
27766
27767.new
27768The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27769realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27770The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27771when this happens.
27772
27773
27774.option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27775This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27776which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27777by &%client_username%& option.
27778If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27779which is the common case.
27780
27781.option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27782See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27783
27784.option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27785This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27786the password to be used, in clear.
27787
27788.option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27789This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27790the account name to be used.
27791.wen
27792
27793.new
27794.option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
27795If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
27796it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
27797The value after expansion should be
27798a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
27799with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
27800Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
27801supplied by the server.
27802.wen
27803
27804
27805
27806.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27807Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27808without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27809
27810Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27811of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27812authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27813ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27814context.
27815
27816This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27817non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27818server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27819
27820.new
27821This is
27822only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27823writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27824When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27825.wen
27826
27827This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27828this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27829of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27830
27831However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27832Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27833with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27834
27835
27836.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27837This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27838library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27839Some mechanisms will use this data.
27840
27841
27842.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27843This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27844default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27845you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27846example:
27847.code
27848sasl:
27849 driver = gsasl
27850 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27851 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27852 server_set_id = $auth1
27853.endd
27854
27855
27856.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27857Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27858that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27859the password itself.
27860
27861The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27862In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27863The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27864if available, else the empty string.
27865The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27866else the empty string.
27867
27868A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27869
27870If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27871option to be simply "true".
27872
27873
27874.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27875This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27876Some mechanisms will use this data.
27877
27878
27879.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27880This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27881.new
27882The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27883when this option is expanded.
27884
27885The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27886and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27887a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27888(if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27889either the iteration count or the salt).
27890A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
27891for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
27892.wen
27893
27894.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27895This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27896.new
27897The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27898when this option is expanded.
27899The value should be a base64-encoded string,
27900of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
27901If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
27902protocol conversation.
27903.wen
27904
27905
27906.new
27907.option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
27908.option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
27909These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
27910to provide stored information related to a password,
27911the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
27912
27913&%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
27914&%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
27915
27916They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
27917When this is so, the macros
27918_OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
27919and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
27920will be defined.
27921
27922The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
27923
27924If set, the results of expansion should for each
27925should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
27926of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
27927&%server_password%& option.
27928If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
27929
27930The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
27931to generate these values.
27932.wen
27933
27934
27935.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27936This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27937Some mechanisms will use this data.
27938
27939
27940.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27941.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27942These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27943They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27944
27945Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27946meanings for these variables:
27947
27948.ilist
27949.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27950&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27951.next
27952.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27953&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27954.next
27955.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27956&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27957.endlist
27958
27959On a per-mechanism basis:
27960
27961.ilist
27962.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27963EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27964the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27965.next
27966.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27967ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27968the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27969.next
27970.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27971GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27972&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27973the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27974.endlist
27975
27976An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27977identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27978email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27979
27980
27981An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27982and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27983.code
27984gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27985 driver = gsasl
27986 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27987 server_realm = imap.example.org
27988 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27989 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27990 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27991 server_condition = yes
27992.endd
27993
27994
27995. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27996. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27997
27998.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27999.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28000.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28001.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28002.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28003The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28004Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28005reliably.
28006
28007.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28008This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28009for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28010identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28011
28012.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28013If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28014&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28015The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28016
28017.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28018This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28019&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28020from the keytab.
28021
28022
28023.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28024Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28025to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28026not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28027
28028The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28029Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28030Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28031role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28032
28033.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28034.ilist
28035.vindex "&$auth1$&"
28036&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28037.next
28038.vindex "&$auth2$&"
28039&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28040authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28041GSS Display Name.
28042.endlist
28043
28044
28045. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28046. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28047
28048.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28049.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28050.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28051.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28052.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28053.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28054.cindex "NTLM authentication"
28055The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28056Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28057which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28058this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28059taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28060server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28061follows:
28062
28063.ilist
28064After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28065authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28066.next
28067The server sends back a challenge.
28068.next
28069The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28070and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28071.endlist
28072
28073Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28074
28075
28076
28077.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28078.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28079The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28080
28081.option server_password spa string&!! unset
28082.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28083This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28084authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28085compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28086&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28087it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28088for other things. For example:
28089.code
28090spa:
28091 driver = spa
28092 public_name = NTLM
28093 server_password = \
28094 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28095.endd
28096If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28097failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28098
28099
28100
28101
28102
28103.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28104.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28105The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28106
28107
28108
28109.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28110This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28111
28112
28113.option client_password spa string&!! unset
28114This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28115
28116
28117.option client_username spa string&!! unset
28118This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28119configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28120&'msn.com'&:
28121.code
28122msn:
28123 driver = spa
28124 public_name = MSN
28125 client_username = msn/msn_username
28126 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28127 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28128.endd
28129.ecindex IIDspaauth1
28130.ecindex IIDspaauth2
28131
28132
28133
28134
28135
28136. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28137. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28138
28139.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28140.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28141.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28142.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28143.cindex "authentication" "X509"
28144.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28145The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28146authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28147The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28148(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28149It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28150the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28151by the server configuration.
28152
28153The client presents an identity in-clear.
28154It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28155and for clients to only attempt,
28156this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28157
28158One possible use, compatible with the
28159K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28160is for using X509 client certificates.
28161
28162It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28163(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28164but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28165rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28166client certificates only.
28167
28168The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28169client-certificate authentication is being done.
28170
28171The client must present a certificate,
28172for which it must have been requested via the
28173&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28174(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28175For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28176verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28177
28178.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28179.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28180The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28181
28182.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28183.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28184.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28185These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28186and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28187If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28188failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28189
28190They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28191
28192.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28193.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28194.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28195 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28196.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28197.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28198
28199When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28200expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28201response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28202values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28203an identity for authentication and
28204placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28205
28206For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28207the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28208variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28209string expansions that also use them for other things.
28210
28211.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28212Once an identity has been received,
28213&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28214authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28215to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28216&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28217expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28218generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28219For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28220string as the error text.
28221
28222Example:
28223.code
28224ext_ccert_san_mail:
28225 driver = external
28226 public_name = EXTERNAL
28227
28228 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28229 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28230 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28231 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28232 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28233 server_set_id = $auth1
28234.endd
28235This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28236of your configured trust-anchors
28237(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28238and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28239
28240&*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28241The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28242TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28243in this way.
28244
28245
28246.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28247.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28248The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28249
28250.option client_send external string&!! unset
28251This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28252identity being asserted.
28253
28254Example:
28255.code
28256ext_ccert:
28257 driver = external
28258 public_name = EXTERNAL
28259
28260 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28261 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28262.endd
28263
28264
28265.ecindex IIDexternauth1
28266.ecindex IIDexternauth2
28267
28268
28269
28270
28271
28272. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28273. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28274
28275.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28276.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28277.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28278.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28279.cindex "authentication" "X509"
28280.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28281The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28282authentication based on client certificates.
28283
28284It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28285advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28286It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28287the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28288by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28289the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28290
28291The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28292for which it must have been requested via the
28293&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28294(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28295
28296If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28297run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28298and can authenticate the connection.
28299If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28300
28301A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28302
28303
28304.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28305The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28306
28307.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28308.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28309This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28310the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28311If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28312failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28313
28314.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28315.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28316As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28317
28318&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28319
28320
28321Example:
28322.code
28323tls:
28324 driver = tls
28325 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28326 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28327 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28328 {forany {$auth1} \
28329 {!= {0} \
28330 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28331 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28332 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28333 } } } }}}
28334 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28335.endd
28336This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28337of your configured trust-anchors
28338(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28339and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28340
28341Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28342The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28343TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28344in this way.
28345Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28346
28347. An alternative might use
28348. .code
28349. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28350. .endd
28351. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28352. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28353. This would help for per-device use.
28354.
28355. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28356. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28357
28358.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28359.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28360
28361
28362Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28363the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28364a connect- or helo-ACL.
28365
28366
28367
28368. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28369. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28370
28371.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28372 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28373.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28374.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28375.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28376.cindex "OpenSSL"
28377.cindex "GnuTLS"
28378Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28379Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28380GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28381cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28382order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28383version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28384You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28385level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28386certificates are used.
28387
28388RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28389connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28390server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28391mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28392between them is encrypted.
28393
28394Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28395and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28396certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28397possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28398encryption state.
28399
28400&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28401disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28402in order to get TLS to work.
28403
28404
28405
28406.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28407 "SECID284"
28408.cindex "submissions protocol"
28409.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28410.cindex "smtps protocol"
28411.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28412.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28413.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28414The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28415contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28416allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28417instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28418by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28419
28420The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28421clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28422Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28423
28424This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28425standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28426reassigned for other use.
28427Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28428this port.
28429In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28430not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28431Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28432
28433Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28434global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28435the most common use is expected to be:
28436.code
28437tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28438.endd
28439The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28440via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28441the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28442the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28443an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28444defined elsewhere.
28445
28446There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28447&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28448
28449
28450
28451
28452
28453
28454.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28455.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28456TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28457To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28458.code
28459USE_OPENSSL=yes
28460.endd
28461in Local/Makefile.
28462
28463To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28464.code
28465USE_GNUTLS=yes
28466.endd
28467in Local/Makefile.
28468
28469You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28470include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28471
28472There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28473
28474.ilist
28475The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28476cannot be the path of a directory
28477for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28478(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28479.next
28480The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28481.next
28482.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28483.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28484Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28485separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28486affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28487.next
28488OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28489DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28490RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28491in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28492for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28493to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28494&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28495option).
28496.next
28497The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28498sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28499.next
28500The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28501When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28502(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28503let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28504.next
28505With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28506main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28507.next
28508Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28509This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28510explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28511implementation, then patches are welcome.
28512.endlist
28513
28514
28515.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28516This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28517an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28518but not the chosen filename.
28519By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28520See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28521
28522GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28523to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28524Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28525&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28526of bits requested.
28527The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28528its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28529parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28530that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28531renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28532this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28533place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28534
28535For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28536recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28537If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28538are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28539not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28540
28541Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28542values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28543parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28544If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28545until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28546a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28547
28548The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28549in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28550generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28551
28552To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28553and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28554&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28555renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28556.code
28557# ls
28558[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28559# rm -f new-params
28560# touch new-params
28561# chown exim:exim new-params
28562# chmod 0600 new-params
28563# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28564# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28565[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28566 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28567 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28568# chmod 0400 new-params
28569# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28570.endd
28571If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28572stalling is removed.
28573
28574The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28575Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28576the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28577a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28578and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28579failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28580of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28581which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28582GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28583to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28584limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28585
28586The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28587value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28588&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
285892432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28590
28591In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28592increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28593bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28594procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28595the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28596
28597
28598.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28599.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28600.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28601There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28602suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28603are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28604The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28605DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28606directly to this function call.
28607Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28608&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28609The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28610documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28611
28612.ilist
28613It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28614.next
28615It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28616or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28617ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28618SSL v3 algorithms.
28619.next
28620Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28621the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28622SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28623algorithms.
28624.endlist
28625
28626Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28627&`-`& or &`+`&.
28628.ilist
28629If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28630ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28631stated.
28632.next
28633If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28634of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28635.next
28636If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28637option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28638.endlist
28639
28640If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28641a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28642includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28643not be moved to the end of the list.
28644.endlist
28645
28646The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28647string:
28648.code
28649# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28650$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28651.endd
28652
28653This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28654there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28655submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28656choice of clients used:
28657.code
28658# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28659tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28660 {DEFAULT}\
28661 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28662.endd
28663
28664This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28665.code
28666tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28667.endd
28668
28669For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28670and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28671The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28672TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28673
28674As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28675.code
28676TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28677.endd
28678
28679
28680.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28681 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28682.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28683.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28684.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28685.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28686.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28687.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28688.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28689The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28690as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28691ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28692
28693The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28694and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28695
28696The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28697controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28698&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28699the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28700the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28701aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28702
28703Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28704"Priority strings". This is online as
28705&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28706but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28707installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28708then the example code
28709&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28710on that site can be used to test a given string.
28711
28712For example:
28713.code
28714# Disable older versions of protocols
28715tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28716.endd
28717
28718Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28719additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28720"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28721
28722This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28723there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28724by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28725where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28726used:
28727.code
28728# GnuTLS variant
28729tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28730 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28731 {SECURE128}}
28732.endd
28733
28734
28735.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28736.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28737When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28738the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28739but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28740that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28741this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28742
28743If STARTTLS is to be used you
28744need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28745
28746If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28747problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28748persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28749with the error
28750.code
28751554 Security failure
28752.endd
28753If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28754rejected with a 554 error code.
28755
28756To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28757must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28758
28759If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28760meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28761You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28762from someone able to intercept the communication.
28763
28764Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28765
28766To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28767.code
28768tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28769tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28770.endd
28771These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28772the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28773contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28774that goes with it. These files need to be
28775PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28776always be given as full path names.
28777The key must not be password-protected.
28778They can be the same file if both the
28779certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28780set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28781is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28782certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28783the server's certificate.
28784
28785For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28786colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28787algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28788public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28789client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28790ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28791
28792If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28793source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28794few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28795
28796&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28797they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28798Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28799transport.
28800
28801With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28802require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28803this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28804.code
28805tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28806.endd
28807is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28808with the parameters contained in the file.
28809Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28810available:
28811.code
28812tls_dhparam = none
28813.endd
28814This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28815DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28816used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28817documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28818
28819See the command
28820.code
28821openssl dhparam
28822.endd
28823for a way of generating file data.
28824
28825The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28826host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28827for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28828in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28829forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28830
28831.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28832.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28833.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28834The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28835an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28836incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28837also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28838&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28839condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28840
28841Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28842can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28843cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28844example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28845contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28846documentation for more details.
28847
28848For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28849(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28850
28851
28852.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28853.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28854.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28855If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28856session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28857&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28858apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28859Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28860contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28861expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28862These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28863an explicit file or,
28864depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28865&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28866
28867A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28868directory is used
28869(OpenSSL only),
28870each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28871of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28872certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28873.code
28874openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28875.endd
28876where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28877
28878There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28879Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28880
28881The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28882what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28883does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28884&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28885attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28886dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28887session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28888fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28889example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28890relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28891
28892.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28893When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28894the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28895&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28896
28897.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28898Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28899&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28900&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28901&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28902certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28903
28904
28905.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28906.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28907.cindex "revocation list"
28908.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28909.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28910Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28911certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28912server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28913an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28914of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28915CRL in PEM format.
28916The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28917file from every certificate authority they know of.
28918
28919The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28920Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28921against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28922usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28923private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28924is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28925
28926The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28927comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28928connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28929re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28930
28931The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28932issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28933the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28934negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28935CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28936resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28937starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28938proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28939
28940Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28941or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28942support for OCSP stapling is included.
28943
28944There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28945The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28946an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28947option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28948contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28949
28950Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28951proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28952Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28953contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28954on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28955next connection.
28956
28957When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28958in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28959ignored.
28960
28961For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28962also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28963certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28964of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28965intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28966file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28967
28968Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28969not any of the chain from CA to it.
28970
28971There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28972
28973.code
28974 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28975 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28976 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28977
28978 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28979 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28980 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28981.endd
28982
28983
28984
28985
28986.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28987.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28988.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28989.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28990.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28991The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28992deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28993server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28994within the &(smtp)& transport.
28995
28996It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28997transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28998server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28999this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29000transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29001
29002If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29003to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29004&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29005those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29006set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29007usual way.
29008
29009When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29010the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29011a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29012session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29013&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29014delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29015it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29016STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29017negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29018unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29019unencrypted.
29020
29021The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29022transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29023if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29024&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29025
29026&*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29027for client use (they are usable for server use).
29028As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29029in failed connections.
29030
29031If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29032specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29033These may be
29034the system default set (depending on library version),
29035a file,
29036or (depending on library version) a directory.
29037The client verifies the server's certificate
29038against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29039in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29040Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29041&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29042
29043The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29044certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29045or need not succeed respectively.
29046
29047The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29048checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
29049is valid for the certificate.
29050The option defaults to always checking.
29051
29052The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29053&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29054is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29055value is empty.
29056&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29057a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29058value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29059otherwise.
29060
29061The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29062&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29063for OCSP to be relevant.
29064
29065If
29066&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29067list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29068the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29069alternative hosts, if any.
29070
29071 &*Note*&:
29072These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29073is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29074by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29075client.
29076
29077.vindex "&$host$&"
29078.vindex "&$host_address$&"
29079All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29080&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29081which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29082behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29083
29084.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29085.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29086.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29087.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29088Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29089&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29090variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29091that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29092successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29093outgoing connection.
29094
29095
29096
29097.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29098.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29099.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29100.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29101With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29102information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29103extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29104&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29105client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29106within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29107for this session.
29108
29109This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29110which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29111address.
29112
29113With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29114against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29115provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29116be of limited use in that environment.
29117
29118With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29119connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29120choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29121wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29122different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29123
29124The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29125if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29126nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29127only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29128for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29129
29130Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29131received from a client.
29132It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29133
29134If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29135option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29136during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29137
29138.ilist
29139&%tls_certificate%&
29140.next
29141&%tls_crl%&
29142.next
29143&%tls_privatekey%&
29144.next
29145&%tls_verify_certificates%&
29146.next
29147&%tls_ocsp_file%&
29148.endlist
29149
29150Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29151attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29152can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29153arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29154Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29155an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29156when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29157
29158The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29159are re-expanded.
29160
29161When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29162for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29163enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29164see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29165
29166When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
291670.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29168built, then you have SNI support).
29169
29170
29171
29172.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
29173 "SECTmulmessam"
29174.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
29175.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
29176Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
29177an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
29178one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
29179of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
29180connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
29181to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
29182starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
29183unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
29184
29185An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
29186&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
29187this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
29188shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
29189before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
29190try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
29191if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
29192
29193The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
29194after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
29195just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
29196reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
29197successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
29198SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
29199should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
29200subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
29201and delay other deliveries to that host.
29202
29203To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
29204closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
29205closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
29206information is recorded.
29207
29208There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
29209&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
29210connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
29211
29212
29213
29214
29215.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
29216.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
29217In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29218certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29219This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29220reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29221
29222The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29223documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29224document is currently at
29225.display
29226&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29227.endd
29228and their FAQ is at
29229.display
29230&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29231.endd
29232
29233Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
292340-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29235descriptions.
29236More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29237published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29238Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29239&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29240
29241
29242.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
29243The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29244certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29245sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29246not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29247First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29248certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29249intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29250certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29251The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29252validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29253root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29254install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29255
29256Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29257even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29258server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29259diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29260
29261
29262
29263.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
29264.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29265You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29266with OpenSSL, like this:
29267. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29268. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29269.code
29270openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29271 -days 9999 -nodes
29272.endd
29273&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29274delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29275specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29276important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29277that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29278prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29279this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29280
29281. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29282. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29283. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29284. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29285. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29286. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29287. ==== -pdp, 2012
29288NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29289epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29290the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29291the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29292of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29293writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29294progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29295be a sensible resolution).
29296
29297A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29298may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29299encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29300
29301However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29302user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29303certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29304must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29305authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29306signed with that self-signed certificate.
29307
29308For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29309user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29310Open-source PKI book, available online at
29311&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29312.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
29313.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
29314
29315
29316
29317.section DANE "SECDANE"
29318.cindex DANE
29319DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
29320it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
29321operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
29322you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
29323Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
29324certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
29325
29326What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29327that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29328by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29329
29330It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29331fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29332
29333DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
29334for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29335client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29336
29337DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29338that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29339to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29340DNSSEC.
293412) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
293423) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29343
29344There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29345Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29346in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29347If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29348
29349A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29350"Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29351For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29352&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29353
29354The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29355These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29356The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29357(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29358this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29359DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29360well-known one.
29361A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29362attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29363does require careful arrangement.
29364With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29365the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29366DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29367all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29368DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29369
29370Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29371because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29372your certificate.
29373You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29374"MTA-STS", described below.
29375
29376When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29377outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29378connections to you.
29379If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29380technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29381In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29382operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29383Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29384because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29385
29386When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29387and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29388than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29389random serial numbers.
29390The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29391If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29392requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29393CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29394
29395The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29396a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29397
29398For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29399
29400.code
29401 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29402 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29403 | openssl sha512 \
29404 | awk '{print $2}'
29405.endd
29406
29407are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29408
29409An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29410
29411.code
29412 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29413.endd
29414
29415At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29416is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29417
29418
29419For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29420
29421The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29422issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29423Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29424re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29425libraries.
29426This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29427interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29428
29429The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29430be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29431default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29432
29433.code
29434 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29435 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29436 {*}{}}
29437.endd
29438
29439The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29440The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29441found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29442string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29443control the OCSP request.
29444
29445This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29446those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29447
29448
29449For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29450and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29451The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29452DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29453the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29454
29455DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29456
29457A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29458If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29459will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29460be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29461
29462If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29463prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29464back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29465This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29466crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29467which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29468limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29469
29470If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29471.code
29472 hosts_require_tls
29473 tls_verify_hosts
29474 tls_try_verify_hosts
29475 tls_verify_certificates
29476 tls_crl
29477 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29478.endd
29479
29480If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29481verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29482
29483The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29484set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29485
29486If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29487
29488There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29489verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29490in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29491and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29492
29493.cindex DANE reporting
29494An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29495to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29496required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29497&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29498The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29499Section 4.3 of that document.
29500
29501Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29502
29503DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29504selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29505to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29506instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29507time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29508Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29509can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29510MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29511information.
29512
29513The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29514which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29515That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29516
29517The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29518&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29519renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29520records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29521information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29522domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29523incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29524
29525
29526
29527. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29528. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29529
29530.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29531.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29532.cindex "control of incoming mail"
29533.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29534.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29535Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29536configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29537name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29538one very small ACL:
29539.code
29540begin acl
29541small_acl:
29542 accept hosts = one.host.only
29543.endd
29544You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29545which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29546
29547The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29548certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29549when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29550option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29551in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29552local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29553a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29554&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29555
29556
29557.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29558The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29559configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29560
29561
29562.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29563.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29564In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29565options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29566.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29567.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29568.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29569.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29570.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29571.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29572.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29573.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29574.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29575.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29576.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29577.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29578.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29579.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29580.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29581.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29582
29583.table2 140pt
29584.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29585.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29586.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29587.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29588.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29589.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29590.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29591.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29592.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29593.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29594.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29595.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29596.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29597.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29598.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29599.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29600.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29601.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29602.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29603.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29604.endtable
29605
29606For example, if you set
29607.code
29608acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29609.endd
29610the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29611in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29612done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29613sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29614command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29615trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29616testing as possible at RCPT time.
29617
29618
29619.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29620.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29621The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29622apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29623really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29624the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29625relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29626are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29627&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29628&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29629in any of these ACLs.
29630
29631The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29632non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29633analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29634batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29635result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29636really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29637on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29638controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29639.code
29640control = suppress_local_fixups
29641.endd
29642This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29643run, it is too late.
29644
29645The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29646content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29647
29648The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29649kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29650temporary error for these kinds of message.
29651
29652
29653.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29654.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29655.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29656The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29657session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29658an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29659accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29660the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29661&%smtp_banner%& option.
29662
29663
29664.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29665.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29666.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29667The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29668EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29669&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29670Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29671session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29672setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29673
29674Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29675mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29676&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29677
29678If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29679modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29680at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29681affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29682an EHLO response.
29683
29684
29685.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29686.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29687Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29688command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29689When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29690is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29691the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29692response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29693added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29694are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29695
29696You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29697in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29698tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29699received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29700the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29701associated with the DATA command.
29702
29703.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29704.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29705.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29706If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29707the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29708. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29709The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29710the data specified is received.
29711
29712For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29713error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29714MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29715before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29716and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29717your resources.
29718
29719The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29720the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29721the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29722and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29723
29724.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29725The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29726enabled (which is the default).
29727
29728The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29729received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29730otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29731
29732This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29733
29734For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29735
29736
29737.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29738The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29739content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29740
29741This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29742
29743
29744.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29745.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29746.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29747The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29748with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29749It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29750client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29751has been accepted.
29752
29753The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29754has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29755with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29756The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29757The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29758can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29759for some or all recipients.
29760
29761PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29762one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29763content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29764.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29765for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29766is &"yes"&.
29767Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29768ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29769will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29770
29771See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29772and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29773
29774This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29775If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29776the feature was not requested by the client.
29777
29778.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29779.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29780The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29781does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29782does not in fact control any access.
29783For this reason, it may only accept
29784or warn as its final result.
29785
29786This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29787session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29788messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29789more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29790
29791&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29792the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29793
29794You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29795&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29796response to QUIT.
29797
29798This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29799failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29800because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29801client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29802connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29803
29804
29805.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29806.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29807The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29808an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29809trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29810because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29811situation even worse.
29812
29813Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29814logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29815modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29816and &%warn%&.
29817
29818.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29819When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29820to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29821connection. The possible values are:
29822.table2
29823.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29824.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29825.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29826.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29827.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29828.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29829.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29830.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29831.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29832.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29833.endtable
29834In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29835Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29836With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29837overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29838&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29839used.
29840
29841
29842.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29843.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29844The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29845you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29846.code
29847acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29848 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29849.endd
29850In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29851providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29852an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29853expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29854more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29855
29856The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29857configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29858string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29859
29860.ilist
29861If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29862contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29863Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29864lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29865If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29866causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29867.code
29868acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29869 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29870 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29871.endd
29872This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29873back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29874file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29875can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29876.next
29877If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29878Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29879matches the string.
29880.next
29881If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29882the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29883want to have something like
29884.code
29885acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29886.endd
29887in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29888newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29889.endlist
29890
29891
29892
29893
29894.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29895.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29896Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29897section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29898&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29899database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29900return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29901&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29902This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29903
29904For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29905&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29906submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29907
29908
29909ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29910has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29911individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29912blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29913
29914If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29915ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29916RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29917recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29918run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29919remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29920&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29921
29922If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29923is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29924
29925
29926.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29927The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29928recipients; it may create new recipients.
29929
29930
29931
29932.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29933.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29934The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29935all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29936not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29937reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29938
29939For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29940these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29941used to accept or reject anything.
29942
29943For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29944&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29945&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29946when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29947
29948For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29949&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29950This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29951messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29952configuration file.
29953
29954
29955
29956
29957.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29958.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29959.vindex &$domain$&
29960.vindex &$local_part$&
29961.vindex &$sender_address$&
29962.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29963.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29964When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29965that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29966&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29967statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29968&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29969is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29970
29971When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29972contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29973set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29974how it is used.
29975
29976.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29977The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29978the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29979that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29980the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29981received).
29982
29983.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29984.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29985The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29986The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29987accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29988of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29989&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29990&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29991
29992
29993
29994
29995
29996.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29997.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29998.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29999.vindex &$smtp_command$&
30000When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
30001the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
30002and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30003These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
30004here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
30005encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
30006does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
30007unencrypted connections.
30008.code
30009acl_check_auth:
30010 accept encrypted = *
30011 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
30012 {CRAM-MD5}}
30013 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
30014.endd
30015(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
30016that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
30017encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
30018option to do this.)
30019
30020
30021
30022.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
30023.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
30024.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
30025An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
30026with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
30027Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
30028set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
30029
30030If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
30031used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
30032provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
30033example:
30034.code
30035deny dnslists = list1.example
30036 dnslists = list2.example
30037.endd
30038If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
30039the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
30040happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
30041all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
30042test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
30043
30044
30045.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
30046The ACL verbs are as follows:
30047
30048.ilist
30049.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
30050&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
30051of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
30052appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
30053is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
30054after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
30055check a RCPT command:
30056.code
30057accept domains = +local_domains
30058 endpass
30059 verify = recipient
30060.endd
30061If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
30062passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
30063the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
30064fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
30065&%endpass%&.
30066
30067The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
30068use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
30069that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
30070configuration.
30071
30072.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
30073If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
30074depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
30075(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
30076statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
30077SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
30078.display
30079&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
30080&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
30081.endd
30082You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
30083response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
30084same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
30085
30086If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
30087an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
30088for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
30089of &%endpass%&.
30090
30091
30092.next
30093.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
30094&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
30095an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
30096&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
30097temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
30098&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
30099be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
30100
30101
30102.next
30103.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
30104&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
30105the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
30106example,
30107.code
30108deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30109.endd
30110rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
30111
30112
30113.next
30114.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
30115&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
30116&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
30117that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
30118the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
30119recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
30120recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
30121message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
30122do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
30123
30124If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
30125its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
30126The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
30127
30128
30129.next
30130.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
30131&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
30132forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
30133.code
30134drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
30135 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
30136.endd
30137There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
30138The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
30139
30140.next
30141.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
30142&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
30143statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
30144example, when checking a RCPT command,
30145.code
30146require message = Sender did not verify
30147 verify = sender
30148.endd
30149passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
30150verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
30151&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
30152discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
30153
30154.next
30155.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30156&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
30157&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
30158to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
30159written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
30160message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
30161duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
30162
30163If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
30164and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
30165&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
30166first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
30167&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30168
30169If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
30170some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
30171This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
30172is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
30173conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
30174is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
30175onwards.
30176
30177
30178.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30179When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
30180text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
30181want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
30182.code
30183warn !verify = sender
30184 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
30185.endd
30186.endlist
30187
30188At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
30189
30190As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
30191written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
30192subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
30193continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
30194mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
30195
30196
30197
30198.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
30199.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
30200There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
30201can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
30202of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
30203transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
30204variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
30205an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
30206alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
30207the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
30208.ilist
30209The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
30210throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
30211while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
30212on the same SMTP connection.
30213.next
30214The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
30215while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
30216reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
30217.endlist
30218
30219When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
30220preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
30221time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
30222.code
30223accept hosts = whatever
30224 set acl_m4 = some value
30225accept authenticated = *
30226 set acl_c_auth = yes
30227.endd
30228&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
30229be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
30230&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
30231
30232.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
30233What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
30234referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
30235false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
30236error is generated.
30237
30238Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
30239their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
30240
30241
30242.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
30243.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
30244.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
30245An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
30246.code
30247deny domains = *.dom.example
30248 !verify = recipient
30249.endd
30250causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
30251&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
30252negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
30253two statements are equivalent:
30254.code
30255deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
30256deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
30257.endd
30258However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
30259side negation of the whole condition is possible.
30260
30261The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
30262of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
30263condition is true. Consider these two statements:
30264.code
30265accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30266 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
30267accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30268 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
30269.endd
30270Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
30271the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
30272different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
30273condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
30274therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
30275the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
30276and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
30277
30278ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
30279specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
30280others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
30281warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
30282message is handled.
30283
30284The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
30285processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
30286modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
30287consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
30288.code
30289require message = Can't verify sender
30290 verify = sender
30291 message = Can't verify recipient
30292 verify = recipient
30293 message = This message cannot be used
30294.endd
30295If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
30296&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
30297so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
30298recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
30299verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
30300because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
30301
30302For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
30303modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
30304happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
30305the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
30306.code
30307deny hosts = ...
30308 !senders = *@my.domain.example
30309 message = Invalid sender from client host
30310.endd
30311The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
30312by which time Exim has set up the message.
30313
30314
30315
30316.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
30317.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
30318The ACL modifiers are as follows:
30319
30320.vlist
30321.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30322This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
30323incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
30324accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30325
30326.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30327.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30328.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30329This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30330continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30331the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30332update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30333write rather ugly lines like this:
30334.display
30335&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30336.endd
30337Instead, all you need is
30338.display
30339&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30340.endd
30341
30342.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30343.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30344This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30345incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30346lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30347lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30348controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30349even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30350
30351As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30352separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30353in several different ways. For example:
30354
30355. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30356. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30357. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30358. ==== way.
30359
30360.ilist
30361It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30362.code
30363 accept ...some conditions
30364 control = queue
30365.endd
30366In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30367other words, when the conditions are all true.
30368
30369.next
30370It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30371.code
30372 accept ...some conditions...
30373 control = queue
30374 ...some more conditions...
30375.endd
30376If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30377statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30378In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30379to be relevant.
30380
30381.next
30382It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30383decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30384example:
30385.code
30386 warn ...some conditions...
30387 control = freeze
30388 accept ...
30389.endd
30390This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30391&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30392log entry.
30393
30394.next
30395If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30396&%require%& verb. For example:
30397.code
30398 require control = no_multiline_responses
30399.endd
30400.endlist
30401
30402.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30403.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30404.oindex "&%-bh%&"
30405This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30406the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30407&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30408output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30409happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30410output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30411
30412Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30413example:
30414.code
30415deny ...some conditions...
30416 delay = 30s
30417.endd
30418The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30419&"deny"&. Compare this with:
30420.code
30421deny delay = 30s
30422 ...some conditions...
30423.endd
30424which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30425can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30426.code
30427warn ...some conditions...
30428 delay = 2m
30429 control = freeze
30430accept ...
30431.endd
30432
30433If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30434responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30435they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30436delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30437appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30438unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30439using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30440
30441
30442.vitem &*endpass*&
30443.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30444This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30445&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30446failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30447failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30448confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30449&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30450
30451
30452.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30453.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30454This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30455ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30456.code
30457require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30458 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30459.endd
30460&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30461example:
30462.display
30463&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30464&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30465.endd
30466When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30467that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30468recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30469message.
30470
30471The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30472the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30473denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30474available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30475variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30476&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30477ignored.
30478
30479.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30480If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30481verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30482error message.
30483
30484If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30485the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30486more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30487actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30488of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30489is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30490
30491If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30492example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30493the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30494logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30495both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30496logging rejections.
30497
30498
30499.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30500.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30501.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30502This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30503about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30504be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30505may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30506ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30507.display
30508&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30509&` log_reject_target =`&
30510.endd
30511This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30512permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30513current ACL.
30514
30515
30516.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30517.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30518.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30519This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30520processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30521&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30522access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30523ACLs. For example:
30524.display
30525&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30526&` control = freeze`&
30527&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30528.endd
30529By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30530with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30531another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30532example:
30533.code
30534logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30535logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30536.endd
30537
30538
30539.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30540.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30541This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30542message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30543or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30544there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30545&%accept%& for details.)
30546
30547The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30548to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30549generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30550&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30551the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30552.code
30553require message = Host not recognized
30554 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30555.endd
30556(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30557processed.)
30558
30559.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30560.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30561For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30562of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30563is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30564is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30565overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30566accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30567truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30568EHLO options.
30569
30570When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30571consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30572of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30573.code
30574deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30575 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30576.endd
30577The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30578by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30579access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
305802&'xx'&.
30581
30582Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30583the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30584
30585The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30586literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30587anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30588response.
30589
30590.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30591For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30592stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30593
30594If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30595specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30596However, the original message is available in the variable
30597&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30598wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30599routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30600use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30601
30602For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30603is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30604modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30605all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30606&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30607&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30608effect.
30609
30610
30611.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30612.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30613.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30614This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30615for the message.
30616It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30617the DATA ACL).
30618This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30619of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30620Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30621If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30622
30623
30624.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30625This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30626 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30627the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30628
30629
30630.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30631.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30632This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30633&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30634
30635
30636.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30637.cindex "UDP communications"
30638This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30639collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30640the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30641of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30642server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30643separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30644example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30645when:
30646.code
30647udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30648 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30649.endd
30650.endlist
30651
30652
30653
30654
30655.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30656.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30657The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30658
30659.vlist
30660.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30661This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30662has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30663apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30664HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30665really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30666not work without it. For example:
30667.code
30668warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30669 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30670.endd
30671Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30672the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30673matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30674mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30675by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30676
30677
30678.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30679 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30680.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30681.cindex "case of local parts"
30682.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30683These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30684(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30685are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30686any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30687for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30688is encountered.
30689
30690These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30691local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30692in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30693handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30694configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30695
30696This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30697containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30698spam score:
30699.code
30700warn control = caseful_local_part
30701 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30702 $acl_m4 + \
30703 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30704 }
30705 control = caselower_local_part
30706.endd
30707Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30708is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30709
30710
30711.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30712.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30713.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30714This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30715
30716The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30717If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30718and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30719is used for all recipients of the message,
30720then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30721and data is copied from one to the other.
30722
30723An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30724for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30725If a recipient-verify callout
30726(with use_sender)
30727connection is subsequently
30728requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30729any subsequent recipients and the data,
30730otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30731
30732Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30733and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30734Note also that headers cannot be
30735modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30736Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30737The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30738rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30739this will affect the timestamp.
30740
30741All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30742rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30743the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30744Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30745message body.
30746
30747Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30748of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30749before the entire message has been received from the source.
30750It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30751or CHUNKING
30752options in use.
30753
30754Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30755a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30756If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30757the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30758before the acceptance "<=" line.
30759
30760If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30761usual fashion.
30762This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30763to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30764&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30765and does not queue the message.
30766Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30767
30768Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30769(possibly faked)
30770sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30771
30772
30773.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30774.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30775.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30776This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30777with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30778by default called &'debuglog'&.
30779The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30780may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30781the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30782option.
30783Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30784with the &'kill'& option.
30785Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30786contexts):
30787.code
30788 control = debug
30789 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30790 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30791 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30792 control = debug/kill
30793.endd
30794
30795
30796.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30797.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30798.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30799This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30800the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30801
30802
30803.vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30804.cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30805.cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30806This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30807the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30808
30809
30810.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30811.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30812.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30813This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30814connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30815strings or to numeric value.
30816The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30817Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30818&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30819
30820The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30821(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30822that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30823equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30824Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30825
30826
30827.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30828 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30829.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30830.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30831These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30832is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30833state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30834in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30835
30836The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30837connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30838messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30839&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30840before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30841synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30842work with.
30843
30844
30845.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30846.cindex "fake defer"
30847.cindex "defer, fake"
30848This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30849except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30850550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30851messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30852use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30853
30854.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30855.cindex "fake rejection"
30856.cindex "rejection, fake"
30857This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30858words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30859message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30860However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30861only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30862the same SMTP connection.
30863
30864The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30865message is supplied, the following is used:
30866.code
30867550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30868550-kept for evaluation.
30869550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30870550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30871.endd
30872This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30873
30874.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30875.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30876This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30877other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30878it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30879current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30880SMTP connection.
30881
30882This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30883&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30884is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30885are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30886
30887.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30888.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30889Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30890avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30891use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30892disables such output flushing.
30893
30894.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30895.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30896Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30897avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30898use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30899that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30900
30901.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30902This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30903extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30904of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30905or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30906needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30907only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30908the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30909to be useful in production.
30910
30911.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30912.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30913This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30914It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30915SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30916
30917If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30918suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30919one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30920(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30921responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30922sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30923
30924.ilist
30925Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30926sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30927verification failed"&) is sent.
30928.next
30929If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30930line is output.
30931.endlist
30932
30933The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30934calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30935
30936.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30937.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30938This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30939the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30940response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30941controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30942&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30943
30944.new
30945.vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
30946 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30947.oindex "&%queue%&"
30948.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30949.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30950.cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
30951.cindex "first pass routing"
30952This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30953other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30954it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30955runner.
30956If used with no options set,
30957no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30958effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
30959
30960If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
30961the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
30962a delivery process is started which stops short of making
30963any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
30964the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
30965able to send all such messages on a single connection.
30966
30967The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
30968 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30969.wen
30970
30971.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30972.cindex "message" "submission"
30973.cindex "submission mode"
30974This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30975latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30976the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30977operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30978necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30979This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30980late (the message has already been created).
30981
30982Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30983messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30984submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30985The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30986that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30987
30988.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30989.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30990This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30991complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30992normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30993
30994.ilist
30995Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30996dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30997.next
30998No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30999.next
31000There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
31001.endlist ilist
31002
31003This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
31004passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
31005used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31006and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
31007data is read.
31008
31009&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
31010that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
31011
31012.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
31013This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
31014to a-label form.
31015For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
31016.endlist vlist
31017
31018
31019.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
31020All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
31021
31022.ilist
31023Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
31024.next
31025Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
31026&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
31027.next
31028Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
31029.next
31030Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
31031.endlist
31032
31033
31034
31035.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
31036.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
31037.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
31038.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
31039The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
31040to an incoming message, as in this example:
31041.code
31042warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31043 dialup.mail-abuse.org
31044 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
31045.endd
31046The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31047MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31048receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31049&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
31050any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
31051RCPT ACL).
31052
31053Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
31054DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31055
31056Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
31057the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
31058contains one or more newlines that
31059are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
31060lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
31061front of any line that is not a valid header line.
31062
31063Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31064They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31065However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
31066is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
31067during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
31068with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
31069lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
31070In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
31071non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
31072message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
31073are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
31074
31075.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
31076Header lines are not visible in string expansions
31077of message headers
31078until they are added to the
31079message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
31080ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
31081header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
31082ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
31083passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
31084this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
31085&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31086
31087The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
31088
31089The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31090processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31091.display
31092&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31093&` `&<&'some condition'&>
31094
31095&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31096&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31097.endd
31098In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
31099condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
31100condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
31101ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
31102honoured.
31103
31104.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31105For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
31106&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
31107effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
31108them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
31109usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
31110are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
31111specifications.
31112
31113By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
31114header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
31115be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
31116after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
31117that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
31118
31119This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
31120&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
31121header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
31122to be a header name first.) For example:
31123.code
31124warn add_header = \
31125 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
31126.endd
31127If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
31128each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
31129you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
31130up in reverse order.
31131
31132&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31133added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
31134system filter or in a router or transport.
31135
31136
31137
31138.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
31139.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
31140.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
31141.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
31142The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
31143from an incoming message, as in this example:
31144.code
31145warn message = Remove internal headers
31146 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31147.endd
31148The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31149MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31150receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31151&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
31152with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
31153any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
31154
31155Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
31156DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31157
31158More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
31159list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
31160not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
31161create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
31162are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
31163.code
31164warn hosts = +internal_hosts
31165 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31166warn message = Remove internal headers
31167 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
31168.endd
31169Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31170Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31171If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
31172There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
31173a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
31174during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
31175if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
31176accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
31177all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
31178ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
31179would have been removed.
31180
31181.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
31182Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
31183is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
31184not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
31185removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
31186this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
31187passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
31188you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
31189&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31190
31191The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31192processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31193.display
31194&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
31195&` `&<&'some condition'&>
31196
31197&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31198&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
31199.endd
31200In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
31201condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
31202condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
31203same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
31204are honoured.
31205
31206&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31207present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
31208in a system filter or in a router or transport.
31209
31210
31211
31212
31213.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
31214.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
31215Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
31216compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
31217for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
31218content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31219
31220Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
31221senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
31222result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
31223done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
31224can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
31225same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
31226The conditions are as follows:
31227
31228
31229.vlist
31230.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
31231.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
31232.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
31233.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
31234.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
31235The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
31236&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
31237&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
31238false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
31239condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
31240condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
31241ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
31242
31243If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
31244can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
31245and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
31246Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
31247The name and values are expanded separately.
31248Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
31249will act as argument separators.
31250
31251If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
31252the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
31253&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
31254conditions are tested.
31255
31256ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
31257loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
31258circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
31259for different local users or different local domains.
31260
31261.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31262.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
31263.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
31264.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
31265If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
31266the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
31267authentication by any authenticator, you can set
31268.code
31269authenticated = *
31270.endd
31271
31272.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
31273.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
31274.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
31275.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
31276.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
31277This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
31278expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
31279&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
31280number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
31281any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
31282&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
31283ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
31284negative.
31285
31286.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
31287.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
31288This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31289content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31290&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
31291If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
31292problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
31293chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31294
31295.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
31296.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
31297.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31298.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31299.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31300This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
31301&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
31302use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
31303different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
31304&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
31305
31306.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31307.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
31308.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
31309.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
31310.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
31311This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
31312of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
31313enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
31314lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
31315&%domains%& test.
31316
31317&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
31318use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
31319
31320
31321.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31322.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
31323.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
31324.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
31325If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
31326name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
31327encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
31328.code
31329encrypted = *
31330.endd
31331
31332
31333.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
31334.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
31335.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
31336.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
31337This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
31338name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
31339you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
31340.code
31341accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31342.endd
31343The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31344the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31345and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31346
31347The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31348Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31349but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31350find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31351opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31352found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31353
31354If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31355address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31356.code
31357accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31358accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31359.endd
31360The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31361is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31362statement can then check the IP address.
31363
31364.vindex "&$host_data$&"
31365If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31366of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31367allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31368.code
31369deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31370message = $host_data
31371.endd
31372which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31373
31374.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31375.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31376.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31377.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31378.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31379This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31380part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31381enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31382result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31383the next &%local_parts%& test.
31384
31385.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31386.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31387.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31388.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31389This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31390content-scanning extension
31391and only after a DATA command.
31392It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31393viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31394
31395.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31396.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31397.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31398This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31399content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31400&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31401with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31402&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31403
31404.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31405.cindex "rate limiting"
31406This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31407messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31408
31409.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31410.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31411.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31412.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31413This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31414recipient address against a list of recipients.
31415
31416.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31417.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31418.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31419This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31420content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31421non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31422any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31423
31424.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31425.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31426.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31427.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31428.vindex "&$domain$&"
31429.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31430This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31431domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31432&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31433of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31434lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31435RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31436influence the sender checking.
31437
31438&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31439relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31440
31441.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31442.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31443.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31444.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31445This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31446for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31447.code
31448senders = :
31449.endd
31450&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31451relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31452
31453.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31454.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31455.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31456This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31457content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31458SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31459
31460.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31461.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31462.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31463.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31464.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31465.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31466This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31467certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31468server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31469or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31470
31471.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31472.cindex "CSA verification"
31473This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31474send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31475&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31476
31477.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31478.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31479.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31480.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31481.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31482This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31483received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31484&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31485there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31486allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31487
31488Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31489problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31490detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31491
31492.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31493.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31494.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31495.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31496.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31497.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31498This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31499received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31500&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31501of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31502is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31503However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31504that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31505to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31506might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31507
31508Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31509section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31510&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31511condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31512.code
31513deny senders = :
31514 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31515 !verify = header_sender
31516.endd
31517
31518.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31519.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31520.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31521.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31522.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31523This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31524received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31525&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31526lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31527and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31528Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31529permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31530&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31531appropriate.
31532
31533Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31534ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31535.code
31536To: @
31537.endd
31538and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31539common as they used to be.
31540
31541.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31542.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31543.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31544.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31545.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31546.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31547.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31548This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31549client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31550attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31551condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31552&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31553independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31554
31555For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31556option), this condition is always true.
31557
31558
31559.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31560.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31561.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31562This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31563Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31564&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31565case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31566&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31567used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31568
31569There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31570local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31571
31572There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31573recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31574
31575
31576.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31577.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31578.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31579.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31580.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31581.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31582This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31583recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31584&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31585of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31586This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31587verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31588address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31589value for the child address.
31590
31591.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31592.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31593.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31594.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31595This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31596address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31597was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31598Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31599one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31600original IP address.
31601
31602There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31603DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31604
31605If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31606is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31607
31608.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31609.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31610.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31611.cindex "sender" "verifying"
31612.cindex "verifying" "sender"
31613This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31614message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31615the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31616condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31617
31618.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31619.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31620If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31621value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31622value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31623statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31624want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31625
31626Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31627&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31628to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31629
31630.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31631.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31632This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31633verified as a sender.
31634
31635Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31636(eg. is generated from the received message)
31637they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31638.code
31639verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31640.endd
31641.endlist
31642
31643
31644
31645.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31646.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31647.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31648.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31649In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31650is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31651address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31652domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31653special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31654address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31655.code
31656deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31657 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31658.endd
31659the following records are looked up:
31660.code
3166143.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3166243.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31663.endd
31664As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31665Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31666to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31667use two separate conditions:
31668.code
31669deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31670 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31671.endd
31672If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31673behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31674record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31675processed.
31676
31677This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31678(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31679blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31680following special items in the list:
31681.display
31682&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31683&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31684&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31685.endd
31686.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31687.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31688.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31689Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31690.code
31691deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31692.endd
31693Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31694warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31695.code
31696deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31697warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31698 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31699.endd
31700.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31701.cindex DNS TTL
31702DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31703(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31704so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31705connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31706Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31707connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31708
31709There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31710or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31711&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31712
31713
31714
31715.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31716.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31717By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31718of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31719after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31720.code
31721deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31722.endd
31723This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31724use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31725MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31726&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31727
31728
31729
31730
31731.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31732.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31733There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31734addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31735&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31736with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31737listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31738.code
31739deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31740 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31741.endd
31742This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31743RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31744example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31745up by this example is
31746.code
31747tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31748.endd
31749A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31750addresses. For example:
31751.code
31752deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31753 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31754.endd
31755The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31756name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31757
31758
31759
31760
31761.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31762.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31763The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31764names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31765name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31766As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31767this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31768either to double the separators like this:
31769.code
31770dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31771.endd
31772or to change the separator character, like this:
31773.code
31774dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31775.endd
31776If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31777blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31778occurs. Consider this condition:
31779.code
31780dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31781.endd
31782The DNS lookups that occur are:
31783.code
317842.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31785a.domain.black.list.tld
31786.endd
31787Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31788address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31789are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31790or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31791only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31792successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31793error for a previous item.
31794
31795The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31796syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31797.code
31798dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31799dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31800.endd
31801However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31802is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31803.code
31804deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31805 $sender_address_domain \
31806 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31807 see $dnslist_text.
31808 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31809 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31810 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31811.endd
31812Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31813multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31814and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31815of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31816.code
31817dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31818.endd
31819Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31820domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31821
31822The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31823&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31824
31825
31826
31827
31828.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31829.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31830DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31831just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31832RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31833The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31834.display
31835127.1.0.1 RBL
31836127.1.0.2 DUL
31837127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31838127.1.0.4 RSS
31839127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31840127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31841127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31842.endd
31843Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31844different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31845see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31846
31847
31848.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31849.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31850.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31851.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31852.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31853.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31854.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31855When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31856the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31857&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31858(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31859the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31860&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31861cases, for example:
31862.code
31863deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31864.endd
31865the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31866&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31867For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31868might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31869.code
31870deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31871.endd
31872If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31873&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31874
31875If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31876addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31877The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31878record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31879very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31880information.
31881
31882You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31883&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31884expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31885.code
31886deny hosts = !+local_networks
31887 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31888 at $dnslist_domain
31889 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31890.endd
31891
31892
31893
31894.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31895.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31896You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31897in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31898For example,
31899.code
31900deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31901.endd
31902rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31903any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31904that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31905describes how multiple records are handled.
31906
31907More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31908separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31909&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31910.code
31911deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31912.endd
31913If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31914addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31915first. For example:
31916.code
31917deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31918 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31919.endd
31920
31921If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31922listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31923In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31924true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31925tested. For example:
31926.code
31927dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31928.endd
31929matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31930want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31931being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31932.code
31933dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31934.endd
31935matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31936an odd number.
31937
31938
31939
31940.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31941You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31942condition. Whereas
31943.code
31944deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31945.endd
31946means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31947IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31948.code
31949deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31950.endd
31951means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31952IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31953words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31954the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31955
31956&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31957host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31958
31959If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31960previous example is precisely equivalent to
31961.code
31962deny dnslists = a.b.c
31963 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31964.endd
31965However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31966Consider this example:
31967.code
31968deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31969 list.dsbl.org : \
31970 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31971 relays.ordb.org
31972.endd
31973Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31974.code
31975deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31976 list.dsbl.org
31977deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31978 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31979deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31980.endd
31981which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31982
31983
31984
31985
31986.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31987A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31988thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31989is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31990the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31991the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31992.code
31993dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31994.endd
31995What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31996127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31997condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31998because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31999affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
32000additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
32001
32002.ilist
32003If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
32004IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
32005condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32006.next
32007If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
32008looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
32009changed to:
32010.code
32011dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
32012.endd
32013and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32014false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
32015.code
32016dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
32017.endd
32018for the condition to be true.
32019.endlist
32020
32021When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
32022the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
32023.ilist
32024If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
32025addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
32026.code
32027dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
32028.endd
32029If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32030false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32031.next
32032If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
32033looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
32034.code
32035dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
32036.endd
32037If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32038true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
32039.code
32040dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32041.endd
32042for the condition to be false.
32043.endlist
32044When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
32045between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
32046
32047
32048
32049
32050.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
32051.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
32052When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
32053the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
32054the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
32055address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
32056only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
32057can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
32058in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
32059lists.
32060
32061A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
32062two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
32063do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
32064If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
32065restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
32066a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
32067domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
32068.code
32069deny message = \
32070 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
32071 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
32072 dnslists = \
32073 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
32074 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32075.endd
32076For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
32077&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
32078match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
32079value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
32080record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
32081The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
32082
32083If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
32084given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
32085the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
32086.code
32087deny dnslists = \
32088 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
32089 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
32090 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
32091 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32092.endd
32093In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
32094values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
32095done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
32096
32097
32098
32099.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
32100.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
32101.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
32102If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
32103nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
321043ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
32105.code
321061.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
32107 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32108.endd
32109(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
32110lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
32111IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
32112.code
32113*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
32114.endd
32115is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
32116Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
32117
32118You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
32119&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
32120.code
32121deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
32122 dnslists = some.list.example
32123.endd
32124
32125If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
32126address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
32127(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
32128.code
32129 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
32130.endd
32131
32132.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
32133.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
32134.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
32135.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
32136The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
32137which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
32138&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
32139commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
32140works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
32141host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
32142.display
32143&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
32144.endd
32145If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
32146period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
32147
32148As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
32149&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
32150configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
32151of &'p'&.
32152
32153The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
32154time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
32155means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
32156parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
32157send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
32158in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
32159constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
32160changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
32161both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
32162
32163There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
32164log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
32165when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
32166instructions when it is run with no arguments.
32167
32168The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
32169sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
32170retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
32171which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
32172By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
32173of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
32174user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
32175&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
32176example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
32177authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
32178
32179The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
32180rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
32181&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
32182ACL.
32183
32184Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
32185specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
32186or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
32187&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
32188using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
32189separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
32190
32191Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
32192any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
32193stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
32194remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
32195remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
32196behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
32197the &%count=%& option.
32198
32199
32200.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
32201.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
32202The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
32203normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
32204&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
32205
32206The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
32207the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
32208&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
32209&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32210
32211The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
32212the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
32213in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
32214used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
32215in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
32216follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
32217in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
32218
32219The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
32220accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32221&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
32222&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
32223ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
32224in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
32225recipients as a large high-speed burst.
32226
32227The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
32228number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
32229last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
32230recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
32231&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
32232
32233The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
32234condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
32235command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
32236multiple different commands.
32237
32238The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
32239measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
32240&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
32241increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
32242other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
32243
32244The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
32245
32246
32247.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
32248.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
32249You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
32250control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
32251mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
32252
32253If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
32254previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
32255
32256For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
32257it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
32258can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
32259in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
32260new rate.
32261.code
32262acl_check_connect:
32263 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
32264 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32265 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32266# ...
32267acl_check_mail:
32268 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
32269 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32270 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32271.endd
32272
32273If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
32274processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
32275it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
32276in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
32277same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
32278multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
32279checks.
32280
32281The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
32282use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
32283update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
32284&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
32285next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
32286
32287
32288.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
32289.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
32290If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
32291engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
32292&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
32293counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
32294rest of the ACL.
32295
32296The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
32297updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
32298client's average rate of successfully sent email,
32299up to the given limit.
32300This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
32301consists of refusing the message, and
32302is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
32303If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
32304likely not what is wanted.
32305
32306The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
32307updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
32308of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
32309actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
32310counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
32311pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
32312again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
32313attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
32314.code
32315 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
32316.endd
32317
32318
32319.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
32320.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
32321The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
32322rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
32323mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
32324sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
32325&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
32326measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
32327options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
32328
32329For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
32330has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
32331rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
32332per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
32333go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
32334recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
32335
32336When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
32337&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
32338rate.
32339
32340The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
32341other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
32342unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32343required increases with larger limits.
32344
32345The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32346will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32347the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32348the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32349events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32350times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32351throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32352limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32353are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32354as intended.
32355
32356
32357.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32358Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32359when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32360(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32361policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32362message. For example:
32363.code
32364# Log all senders' rates
32365warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32366 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32367
32368# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32369# at the decimal point.
32370warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32371 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32372 $sender_rate_limit }s
32373
32374# Keep authenticated users under control
32375deny authenticated = *
32376 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32377
32378# System-wide rate limit
32379defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32380 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32381
32382# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32383# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32384defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32385 messages per $sender_rate_period
32386 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32387 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32388 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32389.endd
32390&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32391especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32392bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32393making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32394RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32395this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32396hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32397
32398
32399
32400.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32401.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32402.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32403Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32404&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32405&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32406The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32407verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32408other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32409.code
32410verify = sender/callout
32411verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32412.endd
32413The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32414address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32415difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32416be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32417(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32418The available options are as follows:
32419
32420.ilist
32421If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32422remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32423check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32424.next
32425If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32426normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32427options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32428verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32429.next
32430The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32431discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32432.next
32433The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32434immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32435generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32436discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32437.endlist
32438
32439.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32440.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32441.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32442.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32443After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32444error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32445coding like this:
32446.code
32447warn !verify = sender
32448 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32449.endd
32450If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32451denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32452verification failure.
32453
32454In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32455appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32456
32457.ilist
32458&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32459was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32460.next
32461&%route%&: Routing failed.
32462.next
32463&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32464occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32465connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32466.next
32467&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32468.next
32469&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32470.endlist
32471
32472The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32473rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32474
32475The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32476address verification to:
32477
32478.ilist
32479&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32480.endlist
32481
32482
32483
32484
32485.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32486.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32487.cindex "callout" "verification"
32488.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32489For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32490checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32491the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32492&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32493a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32494address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32495sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32496deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32497sender's domain.
32498
32499Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32500request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32501described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32502lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32503cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32504caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32505
32506Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32507the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32508callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32509callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32510on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32511
32512If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32513second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32514one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32515&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32516router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32517&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32518&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32519supplies a host list.
32520Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32521
32522The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32523remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32524specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32525specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32526specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32527the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32528&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32529
32530For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32531test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32532following SMTP commands are sent:
32533.display
32534&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32535&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32536&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32537&`QUIT`&
32538.endd
32539LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32540set to &"lmtp"&.
32541
32542The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32543settings.
32544
32545A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32546for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32547the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32548that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32549do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32550&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32551
32552If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32553succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32554Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32555hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32556&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32557
32558.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32559A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32560output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32561clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32562disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32563
32564
32565
32566
32567.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32568.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32569The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32570optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32571.code
32572verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32573.endd
32574The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32575separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32576deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32577
32578
32579.vlist
32580.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32581.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32582This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32583For example:
32584.code
32585verify = sender/callout=5s
32586.endd
32587The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32588remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32589the &%connect%& parameter.
32590
32591
32592.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32593.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32594This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32595for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32596.code
32597verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32598.endd
32599If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32600
32601.vitem &*defer_ok*&
32602.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32603When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32604of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32605updated in this circumstance.
32606
32607.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32608.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32609This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32610&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32611accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32612unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32613
32614
32615.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32616.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32617When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32618verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32619sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32620whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32621MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32622as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32623(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32624address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32625.code
32626require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32627.endd
32628This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32629
32630
32631.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32632.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32633This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32634For example:
32635.code
32636verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32637.endd
32638This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32639commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32640be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32641very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32642(for example, when network connections are timing out).
32643
32644
32645.vitem &*no_cache*&
32646.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32647.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32648When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32649
32650.vitem &*postmaster*&
32651.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32652When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32653check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32654rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32655the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32656used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32657made, until the cache record expires.
32658
32659.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32660The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32661You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32662For example:
32663.code
32664require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32665.endd
32666If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32667one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32668.code
32669require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32670.endd
32671&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32672account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32673a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32674postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32675
32676
32677.vitem &*random*&
32678.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32679When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32680check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32681really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32682&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32683.code
32684$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32685.endd
32686The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32687parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32688specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32689a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32690succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32691
32692.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32693.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32694This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32695.code
32696deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32697.endd
32698.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32699It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32700performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32701that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32702domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32703
32704.vitem &*use_sender*&
32705This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32706.code
32707require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32708.endd
32709It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32710command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32711need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32712sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32713usefulness of callout caching.
32714
32715.vitem &*hold*&
32716This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32717.code
32718require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32719.endd
32720It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32721and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32722Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32723when that is used for the connections.
32724The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32725(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32726if the use_sender option is used,
32727if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32728and if no other callouts intervene.
32729.endlist
32730
32731If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32732command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32733&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32734usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32735that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32736Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32737these circumstances.
32738
32739However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32740host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32741callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32742sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32743callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32744own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32745is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32746
32747Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32748caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32749by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32750actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32751
32752
32753
32754
32755.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32756.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32757.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32758.cindex "caching" "callout"
32759Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32760used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32761option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32762different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32763a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32764entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32765
32766When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32767the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32768is not available.
32769
32770The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32771independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32772(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32773
32774If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32775commands up to and including
32776.code
32777MAIL FROM:<>
32778.endd
32779(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32780any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32781domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32782making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32783separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32784&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32785&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32786
32787Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32788cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32789Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32790ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32791will eventually be noticed.
32792
32793The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32794being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32795behaviour will be the same.
32796
32797
32798
32799.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32800.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32801See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32802verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32803failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32804relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32805you might see:
32806.code
32807MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32808250 OK
32809RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32810550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32811550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32812550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32813550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32814550 Sender verification failed
32815.endd
32816If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32817only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32818out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32819&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32820example:
32821.code
32822verify = sender/no_details
32823.endd
32824
32825.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32826.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32827.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32828A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32829during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32830or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32831it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32832
32833.ilist
32834When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32835continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32836verification also fails.
32837.next
32838When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32839verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32840.endlist
32841
32842This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32843way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32844example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32845.code
32846A.Wol: aw123
32847aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32848.endd
32849work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32850redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32851mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32852verification to succeed.
32853
32854It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32855redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32856generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32857option. For example:
32858.code
32859require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32860.endd
32861In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32862the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32863
32864When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32865redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32866also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32867address and a report is output for each of them.
32868
32869
32870
32871.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32872.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32873Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32874which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32875special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32876domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32877Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32878.code
32879verify = csa
32880.endd
32881This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32882valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32883succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32884&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32885&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32886be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32887
32888The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32889detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32890looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32891address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32892
32893.ilist
32894The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32895.next
32896The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32897.next
32898The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32899(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32900.next
32901The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32902that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32903.endlist
32904
32905The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32906use for the DNS query. The default is:
32907.code
32908verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32909.endd
32910This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32911is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32912address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32913the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32914meaningful to say:
32915.code
32916verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32917.endd
32918In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32919This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32920&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32921
32922If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32923is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32924making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32925using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32926default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32927default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32928(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32929of legitimate HELO domains.
32930
32931The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32932direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32933search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32934addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32935lookup such as:
32936.code
32937${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32938.endd
32939has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32940The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32941authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32942
32943
32944
32945
32946.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32947.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32948Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32949of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32950Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32951recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32952bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32953spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32954
32955There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32956&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32957the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32958address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32959item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32960The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32961&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32962The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32963
32964As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32965database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32966like this:
32967.code
32968PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32969 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32970 }{$value}}
32971.endd
32972Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32973list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32974use this:
32975.code
32976# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32977deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32978 senders = :
32979 recipients = +batv_senders
32980
32981# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32982deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32983 senders = :
32984 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32985 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32986 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32987.endd
32988The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32989to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32990send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32991recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32992the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32993
32994A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32995&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32996prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32997the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32998the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32999timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
33000of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
33001
33002There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
33003you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
33004deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
33005router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
33006.code
33007batv_redirect:
33008 driver = redirect
33009 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
33010.endd
33011This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
33012of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
33013address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
33014local addresses.
33015
33016To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
33017can be used:
33018.code
33019external_smtp_batv:
33020 driver = smtp
33021 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
33022 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
33023 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
33024 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
33025 {$value}fail}}}
33026.endd
33027If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
33028
33029
33030
33031.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
33032.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
33033.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
33034.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
33035An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
33036delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
33037within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
33038passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
33039.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
33040but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
33041
33042Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
33043A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
33044relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
33045a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
33046with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
33047same host is fulfilling both functions,
33048. ///
33049. as illustrated in the diagram below,
33050. ///
33051but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
33052not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
33053system to arbitrary domains.
33054
33055
33056You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
33057runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
33058Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
33059example, suppose you want to do the following:
33060
33061.ilist
33062Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
33063locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
33064&'my.dom2.example'&.
33065.next
33066Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
33067These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
33068.next
33069Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
33070Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
33071.endlist
33072
33073
33074In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
33075.code
33076domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
33077domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
33078hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
33079.endd
33080Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
33081command:
33082.code
33083acl_check_rcpt:
33084 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
33085 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
33086.endd
33087The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
33088the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
33089statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
33090hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
33091than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
33092default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
33093in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
33094
33095
33096
33097.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
33098.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
33099You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
33100that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
33101the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
33102.ecindex IIDacl
33103
33104
33105
33106. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33107. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33108
33109.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
33110.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
33111The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
33112as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
33113was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
33114maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
33115specification.
33116
33117It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
33118&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
33119scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
33120messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
33121chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
33122
33123If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
33124Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
33125&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
33126
33127.ilist
33128Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
33129for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
33130.next
33131Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
33132&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
33133run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
33134.next
33135An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
33136of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
33137.next
33138Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
33139conditions.
33140.next
33141Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
33142.endlist
33143
33144Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
33145added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
33146changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
33147EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
33148this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
33149&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
33150
33151All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
33152temporarily created in a file called:
33153.display
33154<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
33155.endd
33156The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
33157expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
33158first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
33159scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
33160removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
33161.code
33162control = no_mbox_unspool
33163.endd
33164has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
33165same directory by default.
33166
33167
33168
33169.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
33170.cindex "virus scanning"
33171.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
33172.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
33173The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
33174It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
33175specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
33176in memory and thus are much faster.
33177
33178Since message data needs to have arrived,
33179the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
33180&%acl_smtp_data%&,
33181&%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
33182&%acl_smtp_mime%& or
33183&%acl_smtp_dkim%&
33184
33185A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
33186if it expires then a defer action is taken.
33187
33188.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
33189You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
33190to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
33191are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
33192.display
33193&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
33194.endd
33195If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
33196.code
33197av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
33198.endd
33199If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
33200before use.
33201The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
33202The following scanner types are supported in this release,
33203though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
33204
33205.vlist
33206.vitem &%avast%&
33207.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
33208This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
33209Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
33210You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
33211at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
33212This scanner type takes one option,
33213which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33214or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33215The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33216single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33217A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
33218Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
33219the daemon as options before the main scan command.
33220
33221.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
33222If &`pass_unscanned`&
33223is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
33224decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
33225care.
33226
33227For example:
33228.code
33229av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33230av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33231av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
33232.endd
33233If you omit the argument, the default path
33234&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
33235is used.
33236If you use a remote host,
33237you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
33238as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
33239For information about available commands and their options you may use
33240.code
33241$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
33242 FLAGS
33243 SENSITIVITY
33244 PACK
33245.endd
33246
33247If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
33248permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
33249written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
33250
33251.vitem &%aveserver%&
33252.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33253This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
33254at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
33255which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
33256example:
33257.code
33258av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
33259.endd
33260
33261
33262.vitem &%clamd%&
33263.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
33264This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
33265&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
33266unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
33267in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
33268
33269The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
33270a UNIX socket specification,
33271a TCP socket specification,
33272or a (global) option.
33273
33274A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
33275For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
33276for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
33277and the second a port number,
33278Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
33279These per-server options are supported:
33280.code
33281retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33282.endd
33283
33284The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33285a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
33286
33287If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
33288
33289Examples:
33290.code
33291av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
33292av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
33293av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
33294av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
33295av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
33296.endd
33297If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
33298&`local`&
33299option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
33300to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
33301more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
33302Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
33303
33304The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
33305randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
33306that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
33307socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
33308unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
33309When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
33310not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
33311selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
33312email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
33313.code
333142013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
33315 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
33316 (Connection refused)
33317.endd
33318
33319If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
33320contributing the code for this scanner.
33321
33322.vitem &%cmdline%&
33323.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
33324This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
33325used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
33326type takes 3 mandatory options:
33327
33328.olist
33329The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
33330and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
33331
33332.next
33333A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
33334virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
33335absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
33336the &"trigger"& expression.
33337
33338.next
33339Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
33340match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
33341&"name"& expression.
33342.endlist olist
33343
33344For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33345.code
33346Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33347.endd
33348For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33349name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33350for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33351configuration setting:
33352.code
33353av_scanner = cmdline:\
33354 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33355 found in file:'(.+)'
33356.endd
33357.vitem &%drweb%&
33358.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33359The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33360takes one option,
33361either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33362or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33363The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33364single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33365For example:
33366.code
33367av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33368av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33369.endd
33370If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33371is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33372
33373.vitem &%f-protd%&
33374.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33375The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33376One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33377(or port-range).
33378For example:
33379.code
33380av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33381.endd
33382If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33383
33384.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33385.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33386The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33387One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33388For example:
33389.code
33390av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33391.endd
33392If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33393
33394.vitem &%fsecure%&
33395.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33396The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33397argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33398.code
33399av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33400.endd
33401If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33402Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33403
33404.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33405.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33406This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33407Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33408scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33409For example:
33410.code
33411av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33412.endd
33413The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33414
33415.vitem &%mksd%&
33416.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33417This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33418though some documentation was available in English.
33419The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33420and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33421we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33422to integrate.
33423The only option for this scanner type is
33424the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33425provided that mksd has
33426been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33427.code
33428av_scanner = mksd:2
33429.endd
33430You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33431
33432.vitem &%sock%&
33433.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33434This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33435running on the local machine.
33436There are four options:
33437an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33438a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33439the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33440an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33441and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33442For example:
33443.code
33444av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33445.endd
33446Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33447there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33448The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33449Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33450specify an empty element to get this.
33451
33452.vitem &%sophie%&
33453.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33454Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33455You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33456for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33457client communication. For example:
33458.code
33459av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33460.endd
33461The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33462the option.
33463.endlist
33464
33465When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33466the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33467ACL.
33468
33469The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33470makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33471The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33472for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33473However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33474which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33475message.
33476
33477The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33478use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33479The first element can then be one of
33480
33481.ilist
33482&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33483The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33484recommended usage.
33485.next
33486&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33487the condition fails immediately.
33488.next
33489A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33490condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33491expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33492Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33493unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33494.endlist
33495
33496You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33497messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33498Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33499
33500You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33501specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33502For example:
33503.code
33504malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33505.endd
33506A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33507
33508.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33509When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33510is set to record the actual address used.
33511
33512.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33513When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33514&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33515&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33516logging data.
33517
33518Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33519imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33520
33521Here is a very simple scanning example:
33522.code
33523deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33524 malware = *
33525.endd
33526The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33527.code
33528deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33529 malware = */defer_ok
33530.endd
33531The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33532aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33533.code
33534av_scanner = $acl_m0
33535.endd
33536in the main Exim configuration.
33537.code
33538deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33539 set acl_m0 = sophie
33540 malware = *
33541
33542deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33543 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33544 malware = *
33545.endd
33546
33547
33548.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33549.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33550.cindex "spam scanning"
33551.cindex "SpamAssassin"
33552.cindex "Rspamd"
33553The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33554score and a report for the message.
33555Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33556
33557For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33558Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33559&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33560
33561SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33562.code
33563perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33564.endd
33565SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33566documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33567nicely, however.
33568
33569.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33570By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33571intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33572&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33573you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33574configuration as follows (example):
33575.code
33576spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33577.endd
33578The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33579If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33580iptables firewall, consider setting
33581&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33582timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33583server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33584connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33585soon.
33586
33587
33588To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33589on TCP port 11333)
33590you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33591.code
33592spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33593.endd
33594
33595As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33596sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33597filename instead of an address/port pair:
33598.code
33599spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33600.endd
33601You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33602reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33603&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33604option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33605.code
33606spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33607 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33608 192.168.2.12 783
33609.endd
33610Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33611When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33612servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33613condition defers.
33614
33615Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33616Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33617and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33618take care to not double the separator.
33619
33620For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33621subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33622and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33623In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33624
33625Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33626are options.
33627The supported options are:
33628.code
33629pri=<priority> Selection priority
33630weight=<value> Selection bias
33631time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33632retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33633tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33634variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33635.endd
33636
33637The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33638higher values being tried first.
33639The default priority is 1.
33640
33641The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33642Within a priority set
33643servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33644The default value for selection bias is 1.
33645
33646Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33647in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33648Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33649characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33650
33651Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33652are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33653
33654The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33655The default value is two minutes.
33656
33657The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33658a failed connect is made.
33659The default is to not retry.
33660
33661The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33662a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33663used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33664expansion.
33665
33666.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33667When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33668is set to record the actual address used.
33669
33670.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33671Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33672.code
33673deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33674 spam = joe
33675.endd
33676The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33677relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33678to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33679default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33680Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33681right-hand side.
33682
33683The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33684principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33685have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33686&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33687read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33688are not set.
33689Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33690(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33691after the first),
33692or the use of PRDR,
33693.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33694are needed to use this feature.
33695
33696The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33697you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33698&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33699
33700
33701Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33702large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33703are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33704example:
33705.code
33706deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33707 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33708 spam = nobody
33709.endd
33710
33711The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33712SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33713&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33714it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33715
33716.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33717When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33718variables.
33719Except for &$spam_report$&,
33720these variables are saved with the received message so are
33721available for use at delivery time.
33722
33723.vlist
33724.vitem &$spam_score$&
33725The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33726for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33727
33728.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33729The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33730example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33731because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33732The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33733
33734.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33735A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33736integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33737&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33738headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33739spam bar is 50 characters.
33740
33741.vitem &$spam_report$&
33742A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33743message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33744This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33745Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33746when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33747unencoded in headers.
33748
33749.vitem &$spam_action$&
33750For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33751spam score versus threshold.
33752For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33753
33754.endlist
33755
33756The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33757spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33758does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33759
33760The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33761the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33762failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33763statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33764spam condition, like this:
33765.code
33766deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33767 spam = joe/defer_ok
33768.endd
33769This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33770
33771Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33772condition:
33773.code
33774# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33775warn spam = nobody:true
33776 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33777 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33778
33779# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33780# is over threshold
33781warn spam = nobody
33782 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33783
33784# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33785deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33786 spam = nobody:true
33787 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33788.endd
33789
33790
33791
33792.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33793.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33794.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33795.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33796.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33797The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33798each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33799of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33800specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33801options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33802cases.
33803
33804These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33805ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33806the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33807message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33808ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33809result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33810&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33811
33812You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33813only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33814condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33815&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33816&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33817
33818At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33819information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33820of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33821parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33822part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33823syntax is:
33824.display
33825&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33826.endd
33827The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33828the value can be:
33829
33830.olist
33831&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33832.next
33833The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33834&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33835a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33836full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33837.next
33838A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33839directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33840is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33841the full path and filename.
33842.next
33843If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33844filename, and the default path is then used.
33845.endlist
33846The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33847errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33848a file with its original, proposed filename using
33849.code
33850decode = $mime_filename
33851.endd
33852However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33853anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33854automatically unlinked.
33855
33856For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33857content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33858as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33859variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33860before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33861
33862The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33863used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33864respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33865
33866.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33867The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33868available in the MIME ACL:
33869
33870.vlist
33871.vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
33872 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33873.vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
33874.vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33875If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
33876the detected issue.
33877
33878.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33879.vindex &$mime_boundary$&
33880If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
33881have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33882has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33883contains the empty string.
33884
33885.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33886.vindex &$mime_charset$&
33887This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33888&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33889.code
33890us-ascii
33891gb2312 (Chinese)
33892iso-8859-1
33893.endd
33894Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33895case-insensitively.
33896
33897.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33898.vindex &$mime_content_description$&
33899This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33900header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33901implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33902only used for display purposes.
33903
33904.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33905.vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
33906This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33907header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33908
33909.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33910.vindex &$mime_content_id$&
33911This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33912This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33913
33914.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33915.vindex &$mime_content_size$&
33916This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33917successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33918size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33919has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33920
33921.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33922.vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33923This variable contains the normalized content of the
33924&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33925type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33926
33927.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33928.vindex &$mime_content_type$&
33929If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33930value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33931are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33932.code
33933text/plain
33934text/html
33935application/octet-stream
33936image/jpeg
33937audio/midi
33938.endd
33939If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33940empty string.
33941
33942.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33943.vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33944This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33945successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33946containing the decoded data.
33947.endlist
33948
33949.cindex "RFC 2047"
33950.vlist
33951.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33952.vindex &$mime_filename$&
33953This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33954proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33955&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33956RFC2047
33957or RFC2231
33958decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33959 If no filename was
33960found, this variable contains the empty string.
33961
33962.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33963.vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33964This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33965attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33966content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33967
33968The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33969cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33970follows:
33971
33972.olist
33973The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33974
33975.next
33976If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33977so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33978
33979.next
33980If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33981and the rest are attachments.
33982
33983.next
33984All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33985.endlist olist
33986
33987As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33988alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33989coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33990.code
33991deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33992!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33993condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33994condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33995.endd
33996
33997.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33998.vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
33999This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
34000&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
34001Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
34002want to carry out specific actions on them.
34003
34004.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34005.vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34006This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
34007checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
34008decoding is fully recursive.
34009
34010.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
34011.vindex &$mime_part_count$&
34012This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
34013starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
34014counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
34015&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
34016complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
34017parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
34018.endlist
34019
34020
34021
34022.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
34023.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
34024.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
34025You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
34026the message, or on individual MIME parts.
34027
34028The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
34029matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
34030MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
34031linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
34032have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
34033
34034The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
34035to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
34036part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
34037is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
34038and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3403932K characters are checked.
34040
34041The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
34042literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
34043expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
34044with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
34045Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
34046.code
34047deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
34048 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
34049.endd
34050The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
34051&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
34052matching regular expression.
34053The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
34054are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
34055
34056&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
34057CPU-intensive.
34058
34059.ecindex IIDcosca
34060
34061
34062
34063
34064. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34065. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34066
34067.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
34068 "Local scan function"
34069.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
34070.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
34071.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
34072In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
34073want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
34074
34075The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
34076passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
34077a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
34078condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
34079non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
34080
34081To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
34082possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
34083in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
34084can of course use a little C stub to call it.
34085
34086The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
34087when Exim is just about to accept the message.
34088It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
34089well as messages arriving via SMTP.
34090
34091Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
34092option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
34093Zero means &"no timeout"&.
34094Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
34095before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
34096are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
34097incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
34098For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
34099code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
34100
34101
34102
34103.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
34104.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
34105To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
34106function is before building Exim, by setting
34107both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
34108LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
34109&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
34110directory, so you might set
34111.code
34112HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
34113LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
34114.endd
34115for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
34116.new
34117the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
34118and then #include "local_scan.h".
34119.wen
34120It is called by
34121Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
34122be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
34123function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
34124commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
34125_src/local_scan.c_.
34126
34127If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
34128for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
34129.code
34130LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34131.endd
34132in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
34133
34134
34135
34136
34137.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
34138.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
34139.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
34140You must include this line near the start of your code:
34141.code
34142#define LOCAL_SCAN
34143#include "local_scan.h"
34144.endd
34145This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
34146prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
34147almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
34148for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
34149It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
34150strings and pointers to character strings:
34151.code
34152#define CS (char *)
34153#define CCS (const char *)
34154#define CSS (char **)
34155#define US (unsigned char *)
34156#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
34157#define USS (unsigned char **)
34158.endd
34159The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
34160.code
34161extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
34162.endd
34163The arguments are as follows:
34164
34165.ilist
34166&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
34167(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
34168recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
34169
34170The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
34171character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
34172id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
34173macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
34174case this changes in some future version.
34175.next
34176&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
34177string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
34178.endlist
34179
34180The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
34181
34182.vlist
34183.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
34184.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
34185The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
34186the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
34187newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
34188maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
34189
34190.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
34191This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34192queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
34193
34194.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
34195This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34196queued without immediate delivery.
34197
34198.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
34199The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
34200passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
34201they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
34202&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
34203used.
34204
34205.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
34206The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
34207message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
34208problem"& is used.
34209
34210.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34211This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
34212message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
34213&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
34214&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
34215&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
34216same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34217
34218.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34219This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
34220LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34221.endlist
34222
34223If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
34224reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
34225&%-oe%& command line options.
34226
34227
34228
34229.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
34230.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
34231It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
34232that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
34233want to do this, you must have the line
34234.code
34235LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34236.endd
34237in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
34238&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
34239file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
34240to define them.
34241
34242The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
34243&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
34244and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
34245alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
34246variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
34247entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
34248.code
34249static int my_integer_option = 42;
34250static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
34251
34252optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
34253 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
34254 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
34255};
34256
34257int local_scan_options_count =
34258 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
34259.endd
34260The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
34261configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
34262.code
34263begin local_scan
34264my_integer = 99
34265my_string = some string of text...
34266.endd
34267The available types of option data are as follows:
34268
34269.vlist
34270.vitem &*opt_bool*&
34271This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
34272variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
34273that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
34274whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
34275TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
34276values.)
34277
34278.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
34279This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
34280The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
34281multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
34282
34283.vitem &*opt_int*&
34284This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
34285&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
34286Exim.
34287
34288.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
34289This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
34290&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
34291printed with the suffix K or M.
34292
34293.vitem &*opt_octint*&
34294This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
34295octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
34296always output in octal.
34297
34298.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
34299This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
34300variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
34301
34302.vitem &*opt_time*&
34303This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
34304type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
34305.endlist
34306
34307If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
34308out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
34309
34310
34311
34312.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
34313.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
34314The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
34315are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
34316Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
34317including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
34318C variables are as follows:
34319
34320.vlist
34321.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
34322This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
34323It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34324
34325.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
34326This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
34327It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34328
34329.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
34330This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
34331is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
34332&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
34333
34334.ilist
34335The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
34336testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
34337other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
34338
34339.next
34340The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
34341by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
34342of debugging bits.
34343.endlist ilist
34344
34345Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
34346selected, you should use code like this:
34347.code
34348if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34349 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34350.endd
34351.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
34352After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
34353variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
34354
34355.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
34356A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
34357discussed below.
34358
34359.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
34360A pointer to the last of the header lines.
34361
34362.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
34363The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
34364
34365.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34366This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34367&%-bh%& command line option.
34368
34369.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34370The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34371is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34372
34373.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34374The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34375command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34376specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34377
34378.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34379This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34380&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34381
34382.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34383The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34384
34385.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34386The number of accepted recipients.
34387
34388.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34389.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34390.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34391The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34392&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34393can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34394below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34395adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34396&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34397value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34398blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34399and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34400
34401.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34402The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34403
34404.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34405The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34406locally-submitted messages.
34407
34408.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34409The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34410was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34411
34412.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34413The name of the sending host, if known.
34414
34415.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34416The port on the sending host.
34417
34418.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34419This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34420
34421.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34422This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34423
34424.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34425The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34426requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34427.endlist
34428
34429
34430.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34431The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34432You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34433(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34434their type to *.
34435
34436
34437.vlist
34438.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34439A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34440
34441.vitem &*int&~type*&
34442A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34443characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34444Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34445with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34446rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34447lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34448
34449.vitem &*int&~slen*&
34450The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34451internal newlines.
34452
34453.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34454A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34455a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34456.endlist
34457
34458
34459
34460.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34461The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34462
34463.vlist
34464.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34465This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34466
34467.vitem &*int&~pno*&
34468This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34469the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34470and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34471
34472.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34473If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34474recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34475envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34476router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34477an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34478&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34479is NULL for all recipients.
34480.endlist
34481
34482
34483
34484.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34485.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34486The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34487These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34488release:
34489
34490.vlist
34491.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34492 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34493
34494This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34495&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34496be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34497for the process in &%newumask%&.
34498
34499Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34500and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34501standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34502descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34503argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34504
34505The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34506
34507.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34508This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34509seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34510return value is as follows:
34511
34512.ilist
34513>= 0
34514
34515The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34516ending status.
34517
34518.next
34519< 0 and > &--256
34520
34521The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34522signal number.
34523
34524.next
34525&--256
34526
34527The process timed out.
34528.next
34529&--257
34530
34531The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34532.endlist
34533
34534.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34535This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34536Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34537want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34538forks a subprocess that is running
34539.code
34540exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34541.endd
34542and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34543that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34544of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34545recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34546
34547When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34548finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34549fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34550addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34551
34552
34553.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34554 *sender_authentication)*&
34555This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34556that it runs is:
34557.display
34558&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34559.endd
34560The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34561
34562
34563.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34564This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34565output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34566calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34567conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34568.code
34569if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34570 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34571.endd
34572
34573.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34574This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34575expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34576The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34577expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34578the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34579block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34580&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34581
34582.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34583This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34584existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34585character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34586substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34587if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34588
34589.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34590 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34591This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34592chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34593
34594If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34595&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34596NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34597matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34598&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34599found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34600marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34601option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34602top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34603headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34604.code
34605header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34606 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34607.endd
34608Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34609there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34610
34611
34612.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34613This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34614occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34615particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34616match the specification, the function does nothing.
34617
34618
34619.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34620 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34621This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34622a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34623colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34624&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34625.code
34626if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34627.endd
34628.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34629.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34630This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34631The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34632back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34633zero-terminated.
34634
34635.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34636This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34637zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34638to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34639string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34640yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34641easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34642added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34643
34644.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34645This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34646matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34647.display
34648&`OK `& match succeeded
34649&`FAIL `& match failed
34650&`DEFER `& match deferred
34651.endd
34652DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34653inability to contact a database.
34654
34655.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34656 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34657This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34658controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34659&'lss_match_domain()'&.
34660
34661.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34662 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34663This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34664controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34665matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34666
34667.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34668 uschar&~*list)*&"
34669This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34670expected to be
34671.code
34672lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34673.endd
34674.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34675An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34676is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34677looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34678values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34679returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34680failed.
34681
34682.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34683 *format,&~...)*&"
34684This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34685is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34686&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34687them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34688arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34689contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34690
34691
34692.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34693This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34694is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34695with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34696
34697This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34698described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34699the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34700value afterwards. For example:
34701.code
34702 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34703 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34704 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34705.endd
34706
34707.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34708This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34709recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34710matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34711address.
34712.endlist
34713
34714
34715.cindex "RFC 2047"
34716.vlist
34717.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34718 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34719This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34720these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34721from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34722a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34723made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34724binary string is returned with an error message.
34725
34726The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34727maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34728encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34729
34730.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34731.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34732If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34733contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34734not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34735
34736The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34737&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34738which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34739
34740If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34741argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34742set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34743returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34744with translation.
34745
34746
34747.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34748This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34749below.
34750
34751.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34752The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34753output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34754stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34755SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34756is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34757opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34758test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34759is involved.
34760
34761If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34762output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34763
34764The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34765(when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34766This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34767sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34768
34769The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34770Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34771ABI version number was incremented.
34772
34773Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34774must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34775LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34776LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34777initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34778to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34779that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34780.code
34781smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34782return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34783.endd
34784Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34785the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34786&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34787multiple output lines.
34788
34789The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34790does not
34791guarantee a flush of
34792pending output, and therefore does not test
34793the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34794detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34795you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34796dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34797arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34798is an error.
34799
34800.new
34801.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34802This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34803chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34804The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34805data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34806FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34807Exim bombs out if it ever
34808runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34809.wen
34810
34811.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34812This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34813permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34814
34815.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34816See below.
34817
34818.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34819See below.
34820
34821.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34822These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34823The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34824number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34825and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34826pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34827more discussion.
34828.endlist
34829
34830
34831
34832.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34833.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34834No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34835The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34836recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34837to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34838message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34839terminates.
34840
34841Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34842data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34843connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34844one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34845
34846If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34847in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34848.code
34849store_pool = POOL_PERM
34850.endd
34851before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34852restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34853the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34854set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34855
34856The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34857&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34858There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34859block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34860&%store_pool%&.
34861.ecindex IIDlosca
34862
34863
34864
34865
34866. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34867. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34868
34869.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34870.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34871.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34872.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34873The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34874that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34875also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34876they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34877
34878The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34879is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34880It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34881commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34882The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34883
34884The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34885is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34886the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34887If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34888of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34889prevent it happening on retries.
34890
34891.vindex "&$domain$&"
34892.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34893&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34894specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34895&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34896you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34897independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34898described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34899
34900
34901.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34902.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34903.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34904The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34905setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34906other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34907&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34908.code
34909system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34910system_filter_user = exim
34911.endd
34912If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34913&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34914specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34915&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34916&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34917by the &%reply%& command.
34918
34919
34920.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34921You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34922filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34923are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34924
34925If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34926you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34927
34928
34929
34930.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34931The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34932files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34933mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34934available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34935If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34936they cause errors.
34937
34938.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34939There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34940files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34941is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34942&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34943subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34944manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34945
34946&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34947specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34948succeed, it will not be tried again.
34949If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34950arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34951
34952When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34953&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34954users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34955to which users' filter files can refer.
34956
34957
34958
34959.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34960.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34961The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34962of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34963filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34964
34965
34966
34967.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34968.cindex "freezing messages"
34969.cindex "message" "freezing"
34970.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34971.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34972.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34973.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34974There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34975always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34976filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34977for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34978word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34979.code
34980fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34981.endd
34982The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34983
34984The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34985message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34986and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34987delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34988that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34989run.
34990
34991The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34992not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34993filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34994is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34995
34996.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34997.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34998The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34999well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
35000up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
35001log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
35002two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
35003strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
35004message. For example:
35005.code
35006fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
35007 because it contains attachments that we are \
35008 not prepared to receive."
35009.endd
35010
35011.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
35012Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
35013the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
35014the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
35015command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
35016Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
35017use, for example
35018.code
35019if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
35020then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
35021.endd
35022though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
35023alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
35024generated by the filter.
35025
35026The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
35027&%defer%&,
35028&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
35029set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
35030as
35031.code
35032mail ...
35033freeze
35034.endd
35035to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
35036failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
35037take place.
35038
35039
35040
35041.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
35042.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
35043.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
35044.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
35045Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
35046.code
35047headers add <string>
35048headers remove <string>
35049.endd
35050The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
35051added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
35052filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
35053space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
35054forced to fail, the command has no effect.
35055
35056You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
35057continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
35058including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
35059example:
35060.code
35061headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
35062 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
35063 X-header-2: ...."
35064.endd
35065Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
35066be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
35067space after input continuations is ignored.
35068
35069The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
35070This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
35071those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
35072&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
35073header with the same name, they are all removed.
35074
35075The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
35076of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
35077from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
35078modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
35079Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
35080used for all recipients of the message.
35081
35082During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
35083header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
35084that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
35085routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
35086routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
35087until the message is actually being written (see section
35088&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
35089
35090If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
35091added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
35092present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
35093present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
35094message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
35095conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
35096modified more than once.
35097
35098Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
35099use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
35100For example:
35101.code
35102headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
35103headers remove "Subject"
35104headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
35105headers remove "Old-Subject"
35106.endd
35107
35108
35109
35110.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
35111.cindex "envelope from"
35112.cindex "envelope sender"
35113In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
35114.code
35115errors_to <some address>
35116.endd
35117in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
35118delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
35119user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
35120might use
35121.code
35122unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
35123.endd
35124to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
35125address if its delivery failed.
35126
35127
35128
35129.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
35130.vindex "&$domain$&"
35131.vindex "&$local_part$&"
35132In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
35133delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
35134operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
35135such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
35136filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
35137which implements such a filter:
35138.code
35139central_filter:
35140 check_local_user
35141 driver = redirect
35142 domains = +local_domains
35143 file = /central/filters/$local_part_verified
35144 no_verify
35145 allow_filter
35146 allow_freeze
35147.endd
35148The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
35149&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
35150the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
35151use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
35152
35153Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
35154specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
35155its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
35156address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
35157normal way.
35158.ecindex IIDsysfil1
35159.ecindex IIDsysfil2
35160.ecindex IIDsysfil3
35161
35162
35163
35164
35165
35166
35167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35168. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35169
35170.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
35171.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
35172Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
35173all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
35174these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
35175this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
35176removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
35177before it is placed on Exim's queue.
35178
35179Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
35180&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
35181that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
35182its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
35183set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
35184
35185&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
35186or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
35187loopback interface specially in any way.
35188
35189If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
35190that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
35191
35192
35193
35194
35195.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
35196.cindex "message" "submission"
35197.cindex "submission mode"
35198Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
35199&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
35200received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
35201state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
35202.code
35203control = submission
35204.endd
35205in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
35206&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
35207a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
35208known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
35209example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
35210interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
35211.code
35212warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
35213 control = submission
35214.endd
35215.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
35216There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
35217is used to separate options. For example:
35218.code
35219control = submission/sender_retain
35220.endd
35221Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
35222true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
35223of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
35224the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
35225authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
35226&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
35227attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
35228
35229When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
35230domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
35231example:
35232.code
35233control = submission/domain=some.domain
35234.endd
35235The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
35236&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
35237that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
35238&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
35239.code
35240accept authenticated = *
35241 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
35242 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
35243 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
35244.endd
35245Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
35246option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
35247the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
35248.code
35249bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
35250.endd
35251then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
35252line would be:
35253.code
35254Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
35255.endd
35256.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
35257By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
35258used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
35259specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
35260
35261&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
35262ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
35263untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
35264specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
35265does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
35266spoof another's address.
35267
35268.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
35269.cindex "line endings"
35270.cindex "carriage return"
35271.cindex "linefeed"
35272RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
35273linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
35274SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
35275conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
35276use CRLF or just CR.
35277
35278Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
35279using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
35280receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
35281Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
35282MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
35283has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
35284that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
35285other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
35286follows:
35287
35288.ilist
35289LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
35290.next
35291CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
35292is ignored.
35293.next
35294The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
35295nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
35296terminator.
35297.next
35298If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
35299the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
35300is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
35301people trying to play silly games.
35302.next
35303If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
35304bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
35305line.
35306.endlist
35307
35308
35309
35310
35311
35312.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
35313.cindex "unqualified addresses"
35314.cindex "address" "qualification"
35315By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
35316host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
35317SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
35318messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
35319requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
35320
35321Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
35322sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
35323&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
35324cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
35325value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
35326
35327.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
35328.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
35329Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
35330that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
35331line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
35332are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
35333other words, such qualification is also controlled by
35334&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
35335
35336
35337
35338
35339.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
35340.cindex "&""From""& line"
35341.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
35342.cindex "sender" "address"
35343.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
35344.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
35345.cindex "envelope from"
35346.cindex "envelope sender"
35347.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35348Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
35349with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
35350&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
35351.code
35352From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
35353From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
35354.endd
35355This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
35356Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
35357via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
35358such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
35359&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
35360and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
35361regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
35362default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
35363that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
35364
35365.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35366When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35367a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35368contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35369then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35370qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35371the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35372
35373If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35374sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35375that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35376
35377Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35378treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35379as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35380incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35381
35382
35383
35384.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35385.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35386.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35387RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35388&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35389recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35390&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35391&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35392
35393.blockquote
35394&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35395processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35396.endblockquote
35397
35398This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35399address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35400follows:
35401
35402.ilist
35403A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35404is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35405.next
35406If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35407&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35408&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35409.next
35410For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35411also removed.
35412.next
35413For a locally-submitted message,
35414if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35415&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35416the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35417included in log lines in this case.
35418.next
35419The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35420&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35421.endlist
35422
35423
35424
35425
35426.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35427Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35428includes the header line:
35429.code
35430Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35431.endd
35432
35433.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35434.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35435If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35436message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35437extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35438existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35439
35440
35441.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35442.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35443.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35444If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35445Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35446&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35447
35448.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35449.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35450.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35451&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35452set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35453the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35454in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35455set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35456messages.
35457
35458
35459.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35460.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35461.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35462.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35463&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35464Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35465generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35466messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35467(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35468messages.
35469
35470
35471.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35472.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35473.cindex "header lines" "From:"
35474.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35475.cindex "message" "submission"
35476.cindex "submission mode"
35477If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35478adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35479
35480.ilist
35481The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35482message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35483.next
35484.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35485The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35486.olist
35487.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35488If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35489&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35490.next
35491If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35492part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35493.next
35494If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35495&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35496.endlist
35497.endlist
35498
35499A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35500
35501If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35502line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35503containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35504are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35505They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35506&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35507&%qualify_domain%&.
35508
35509For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35510&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35511user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35512name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35513
35514
35515.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35516.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35517.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35518.cindex "message" "submission"
35519.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35520If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35521&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35522&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35523to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35524creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35525message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35526followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35527in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35528&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35529
35530
35531.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35532.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35533.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35534A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35535contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35536Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35537
35538The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35539have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35540line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35541that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35542
35543Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35544changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35545-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35546
35547
35548.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35549.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35550.cindex "header lines" "References:"
35551Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35552header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35553section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35554header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35555responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35556processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35557than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35558incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3555911 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35560
35561
35562
35563.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35564.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35565.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35566.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35567&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35568it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35569transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35570transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35571default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35572
35573
35574
35575.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35576.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35577.cindex "message" "submission"
35578.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35579For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35580existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35581these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35582&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35583control setting.
35584
35585When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35586&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35587control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35588&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35589that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35590&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35591be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35592appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35593line is added to the message.
35594
35595If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35596the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35597&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35598options true at the same time.
35599
35600.cindex "submission mode"
35601By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35602received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35603a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35604not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35605
35606.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35607First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35608authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35609created as follows:
35610
35611.ilist
35612.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35613If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35614&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35615.next
35616If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35617is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35618.next
35619If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35620&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35621.endlist
35622
35623This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35624are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35625added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35626by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35627
35628.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35629&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35630the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35631except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35632
35633
35634
35635.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35636 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35637.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35638.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35639When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35640specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35641process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35642modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35643as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35644
35645In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35646specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35647addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35648changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35649transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35650they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35651
35652&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35653the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35654expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35655
35656For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35657option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35658newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35659.code
35660headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35661 X-added-second: another added header line
35662.endd
35663Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35664
35665Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35666specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35667Each header-line is separately expanded.
35668
35669The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35670list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35671often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35672not part of the names. For example:
35673.code
35674headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35675.endd
35676
35677Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35678specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35679Each item is separately expanded.
35680Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35681form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35682will act as list separators.
35683
35684When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35685items are expanded at routing time,
35686and then associated with all addresses that are
35687accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35688an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35689forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35690
35691.oindex "&%unseen%&"
35692However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35693the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35694&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35695
35696Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35697settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35698dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35699requirements.
35700
35701The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35702with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35703these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35704recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35705consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35706names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35707instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35708
35709After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35710lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35711the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35712header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35713
35714This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35715the following consequences:
35716
35717.ilist
35718The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35719remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35720to it, at all times.
35721.next
35722Header lines that are added by a router's
35723&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35724expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35725.next
35726Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35727in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35728.next
35729Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35730a later router or by a transport.
35731.next
35732An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35733removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35734.code
35735headers_remove = subject
35736headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35737.endd
35738.endlist
35739
35740&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35741for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35742
35743
35744
35745
35746
35747.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35748.cindex "address" "constructed"
35749.cindex "constructed address"
35750When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35751the form
35752.display
35753<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35754.endd
35755For example:
35756.code
35757Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35758.endd
35759The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35760otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35761&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35762ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35763upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35764&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35765The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35766there is no password file entry.
35767
35768.cindex "RFC 2047"
35769In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35770parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35771characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35772including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35773&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35774characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35775&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35776is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35777
35778
35779
35780.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35781.cindex "case of local parts"
35782.cindex "local part" "case of"
35783RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35784be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35785addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35786because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35787routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35788original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35789router option.
35790
35791.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35792If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35793assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35794your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35795correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35796.code
35797correct_case:
35798 driver = redirect
35799 domains = +local_domains
35800 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35801 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35802 @$domain
35803.endd
35804For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35805(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35806up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35807on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35808local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35809
35810
35811
35812.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35813.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35814.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35815RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35816part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35817middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35818empty components for compatibility.
35819
35820
35821
35822.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35823.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35824Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35825happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35826in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35827&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35828
35829Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35830in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35831routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35832example, a header such as
35833.code
35834To: hare@teaparty
35835.endd
35836might get rewritten as
35837.code
35838To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35839.endd
35840Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35841does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35842been routed.
35843
35844Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35845addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35846result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35847deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35848immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35849routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35850.ecindex IIDmesproc
35851
35852
35853
35854. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35855. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35856
35857.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35858.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35859.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35860Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35861LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35862closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35863processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35864
35865.ilist
35866SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35867.next
35868SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35869.next
35870Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35871.endlist
35872
35873For mail delivery, the following are available:
35874
35875.ilist
35876SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35877.next
35878LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35879&"lmtp"&);
35880.next
35881LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35882transport);
35883.next
35884Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35885the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35886.endlist
35887
35888&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35889stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35890used to contain the envelope information.
35891
35892
35893
35894.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35895.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35896.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35897.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35898.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35899.cindex "EHLO"
35900.cindex "HELO"
35901.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35902Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35903The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35904processing is the same in both cases.
35905
35906If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35907parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35908command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35909&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35910such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35911.cindex "transport" "filter"
35912.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35913transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35914suppressed.
35915
35916If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35917pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35918required for the transaction.
35919
35920If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35921was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35922server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35923Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35924is called for verification.
35925
35926If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35927the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35928in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35929
35930.cindex "carriage return"
35931.cindex "linefeed"
35932Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35933LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35934order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35935line terminator.
35936
35937If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35938characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35939same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35940even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35941of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35942they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35943each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35944in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35945significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35946
35947When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35948message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35949records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35950particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35951
35952.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35953Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35954a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35955See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35956
35957.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35958.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35959When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35960looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35961messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35962creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35963a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35964so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35965does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35966turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35967
35968The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35969limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35970
35971.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35972The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35973identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35974square bracket of the IP address.
35975
35976
35977
35978
35979.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35980.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35981.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35982.cindex "host" "error"
35983Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35984message errors, and recipient errors.
35985
35986.vlist
35987.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35988A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35989particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35990
35991.ilist
35992Connection refused or timed out,
35993.next
35994Any error response code on connection,
35995.next
35996Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35997.next
35998Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35999.next
36000I/O errors at any time,
36001.next
36002Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
36003the &"."& at the end of the data.
36004.endlist ilist
36005
36006For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
36007EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
36008error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
36009host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
36010the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
36011alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
36012host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
36013made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
36014
36015.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
36016.cindex "message" "error"
36017A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
36018particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
36019message errors are:
36020
36021.ilist
36022Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
36023the data,
36024.next
36025Timeout after MAIL,
36026.next
36027Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
36028timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
36029connection at any other time.
36030.endlist ilist
36031
36032For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
36033to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
36034temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
36035addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
36036a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
36037message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
36038that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
36039time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
36040affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
36041it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
36042
36043If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
36044to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
36045over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
36046response to MAIL.
36047
36048.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
36049.cindex "recipient" "error"
36050A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
36051recipient errors are:
36052
36053.ilist
36054Any error response to RCPT,
36055.next
36056Timeout after RCPT.
36057.endlist
36058
36059For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
36060recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
36061sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
36062address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
36063used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
36064routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
36065operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
36066to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
36067if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
36068(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
36069have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
36070the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
36071the retry clock is reset.
36072
36073The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
36074host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
36075other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
36076in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
36077proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
36078than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
36079if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
36080through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
36081recipient's retry time.
36082.endlist
36083
36084In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
36085current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
36086tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
36087own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
36088until the next delivery attempt.
36089
36090Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
36091MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
36092would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
36093host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
36094What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
36095is created.
36096
36097The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
36098these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
36099procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
36100response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
36101it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
36102message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
36103helpful to treat this case as a message error.
36104
36105Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
36106host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
36107or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
36108the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
36109then to be treated as a host error.
36110
36111There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
36112terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
36113reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
36114should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
36115host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
36116
36117
36118
36119
36120.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
36121.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
36122.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
36123.cindex "inetd"
36124.cindex "daemon"
36125Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
36126listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
36127&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
36128.code
36129smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
36130.endd
36131Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
36132agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
36133a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
36134the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
36135with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
36136stream and exits with an error code.
36137
36138By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
36139disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
36140unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
36141&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
36142
36143.cindex "carriage return"
36144.cindex "linefeed"
36145Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36146LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
36147order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36148line terminator.
36149Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
36150sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
36151sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
36152
36153.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
36154.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
36155One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
36156HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
36157commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
36158the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
36159Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
36160match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
36161
36162.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
36163.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
36164The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
36165a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
36166&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
36167false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
36168&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
36169value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
36170message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
36171
36172When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
36173its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
36174logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
36175
36176The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
36177prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
36178number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
36179&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
36180rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
36181
36182The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
36183subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
36184for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
36185things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
36186processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
36187sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
36188it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
36189
36190When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
36191and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
36192high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
36193&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
36194applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
36195
36196Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
36197can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
36198&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
36199number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
36200SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
36201&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
36202subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
36203a delivery process.
36204
36205The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
36206&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
36207started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
36208handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
36209however, available with &'inetd'&.
36210
36211Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
36212are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
36213to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
36214section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
36215
36216Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
36217MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
36218&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
36219
36220
36221
36222.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
36223.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
36224If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
36225commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
36226the error response to the last command. The default value for
36227&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
36228abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
36229circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
36230
36231
36232.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
36233.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
36234.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
36235A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
36236something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
36237address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
36238sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
36239&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
36240drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
36241default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
36242broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
36243
36244
36245
36246.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
36247.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
36248The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
36249DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
36250many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
36251denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
36252client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
36253defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
36254
36255When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
36256allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
36257but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
36258or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
36259starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
36260counted.
36261
36262The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
36263STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
36264RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
36265
36266You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
36267&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
36268&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
36269the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
36270specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
36271
36272
36273
36274
36275.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
36276When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
36277runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
36278appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
36279
36280.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
36281When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
36282setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
36283(with a 252 SMTP response code)
36284in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
36285When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
36286called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
36287SMTP response codes.
36288
36289.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
36290If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
36291When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
36292EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
36293than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
36294as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
36295of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
36296VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
36297RCPT failures.
36298
36299
36300
36301.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
36302.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
36303RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
36304overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
36305disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
36306the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
36307should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
36308
36309The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
36310delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
36311the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
36312text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
36313specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
36314the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
36315argument. For example,
36316.code
36317ETRN #brigadoon
36318.endd
36319runs the command
36320.code
36321exim -R brigadoon
36322.endd
36323which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
36324containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
36325default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
36326for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
36327a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
36328
36329.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
36330Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
36331record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
36332the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
36333the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
36334a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
36335left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
36336Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
36337
36338.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
36339For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
36340used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
36341whatever the form of its argument. For
36342example:
36343.code
36344smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
36345 $sender_host_address
36346.endd
36347.vindex "&$domain$&"
36348The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
36349expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
36350and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
36351wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
36352under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
36353for it to change them before running the command.
36354
36355
36356
36357.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
36358.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
36359Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
36360standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
36361line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
36362&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
36363messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
36364sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
36365an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36366identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36367runs for RCPT commands:
36368.code
36369accept hosts = :
36370.endd
36371This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36372
36373
36374
36375.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36376.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36377.cindex "batched SMTP output"
36378Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36379batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36380be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36381delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36382envelope along with the message.
36383
36384The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36385MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36386the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36387HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36388can be used to specify it.
36389
36390Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36391one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36392to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36393this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36394chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36395
36396.vindex "&$host$&"
36397When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36398sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36399transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36400router:
36401.code
36402begin routers
36403route_append:
36404 driver = manualroute
36405 transport = smtp_appendfile
36406 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36407
36408begin transports
36409smtp_appendfile:
36410 driver = appendfile
36411 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36412 batch_max = 1000
36413 use_bsmtp
36414 user = exim
36415.endd
36416This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36417format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36418message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36419
36420
36421
36422.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36423.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36424.cindex "batched SMTP input"
36425The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36426reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36427is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36428sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36429rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36430and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36431as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36432
36433Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36434ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36435
36436If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36437the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36438standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36439make some use of automatically, for example:
36440.code
36441554 Unexpected end of file
36442Transaction started in line 10
36443Error detected in line 14
36444.endd
36445It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36446file, for example:
36447.code
36448An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36449The error message was:
36450
36451501 '>' missing at end of address
36452
36453The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36454The error was detected in line 12.
36455The SMTP command at fault was:
36456
36457rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36458
364591 previous message was successfully processed.
36460The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36461.endd
36462The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36463messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36464accepted.
36465.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36466.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36467
36468
36469
36470. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36471. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36472
36473.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36474 "Customizing messages"
36475When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36476configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36477to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36478the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36479string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36480
36481The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36482cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36483option. Exim also adds the line
36484.code
36485Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36486.endd
36487to all warning and bounce messages,
36488
36489
36490.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36491.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36492.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36493If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36494message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36495delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36496&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36497
36498When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36499constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36500separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36501opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36502logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36503item.
36504
36505.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36506.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36507Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36508expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36509the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36510&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36511option, rounded to a whole number.
36512
36513The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36514
36515.ilist
36516The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36517&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36518.next
36519The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36520failing addresses with their error messages.
36521.next
36522The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36523returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36524.next
36525The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36526The fields exist for back-compatibility
36527.endlist
36528
36529The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36530following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36531other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36532.code
36533Subject: Mail delivery failed
36534 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36535 {: returning message to sender}}
36536****
36537This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36538
36539A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36540 {that you sent }{sent by
36541
36542<$sender_address>
36543
36544}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36545This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36546****
36547The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36548****
36549------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36550 ------
36551****
36552------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36553 only the first
36554------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36555****
36556.endd
36557.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36558.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36559.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36560The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36561warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36562text sections:
36563
36564.ilist
36565The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36566&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36567.next
36568The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36569the delayed addresses.
36570.next
36571The third item then ends the message.
36572.endlist
36573
36574The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36575have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36576.code
36577Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36578 $warn_message_delay
36579****
36580This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36581
36582A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36583{that you sent }{sent by
36584
36585<$sender_address>
36586
36587}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36588more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36589
36590The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36591The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36592The date of the message is: $h_date
36593
36594The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36595****
36596No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36597continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36598intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36599mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36600the message will be returned to you.
36601.endd
36602.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36603.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36604However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36605appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36606&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36607minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36608of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36609multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36610handled them.
36611
36612
36613
36614
36615. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36616. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36617
36618.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36619This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36620common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36621
36622
36623
36624.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36625.cindex "smart host" "example router"
36626If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36627should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36628routing explicitly:
36629.code
36630send_to_smart_host:
36631 driver = manualroute
36632 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36633 transport = remote_smtp
36634.endd
36635You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36636If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36637receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36638synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36639&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36640
36641
36642
36643
36644.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36645.cindex "mailing lists"
36646Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36647requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36648Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36649
36650The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36651is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36652independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36653lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36654.code
36655lists:
36656 driver = redirect
36657 domains = lists.example
36658 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
36659 forbid_pipe
36660 forbid_file
36661 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
36662 no_more
36663.endd
36664This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36665in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36666such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36667routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36668
36669The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36670expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36671a mailing list.
36672
36673.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36674The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36675taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36676original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36677the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36678
36679For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36680&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36681&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36682&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36683There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36684the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36685such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36686or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36687&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36688
36689
36690
36691.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36692.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36693If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36694delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36695list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36696list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36697addresses are not rigorously checked.
36698
36699If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36700entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36701&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36702whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36703&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36704
36705
36706
36707.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36708.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36709Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36710in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36711recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36712cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36713delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36714account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36715the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36716message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36717
36718If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36719on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36720router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36721&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36722&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36723subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36724failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36725pre-existing messages.
36726
36727The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36728addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36729addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36730&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36731one level of expansion anyway.
36732
36733
36734
36735.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36736.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36737The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36738send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36739from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36740&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36741
36742The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36743of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36744.code
36745lists_request:
36746 driver = redirect
36747 domains = lists.example
36748 local_part_suffix = -request
36749 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
36750 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
36751 no_more
36752
36753lists_post:
36754 driver = redirect
36755 domains = lists.example
36756 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36757 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36758 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
36759 forbid_pipe
36760 forbid_file
36761 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
36762 no_more
36763
36764lists_closed:
36765 driver = redirect
36766 domains = lists.example
36767 allow_fail
36768 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36769.endd
36770All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36771they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36772&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36773mailing list.
36774
36775The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36776checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36777checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36778necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36779because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36780not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36781means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36782&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36783&"unrouteable address"& error.
36784
36785The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36786a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36787the address, giving a suitable error message.
36788
36789
36790
36791
36792.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36793.cindex "VERP"
36794.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36795.cindex "envelope from"
36796.cindex "envelope sender"
36797Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36798are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36799address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36800the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36801if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36802original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36803
36804.oindex &%errors_to%&
36805.oindex &%return_path%&
36806Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36807facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36808list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36809these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36810host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36811of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36812of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36813.code
36814verp_smtp:
36815 driver = smtp
36816 max_rcpt = 1
36817 return_path = \
36818 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36819 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
36820.endd
36821This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36822SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36823&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36824local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36825example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36826&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36827&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36828rewritten as
36829.code
36830somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36831.endd
36832.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36833For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36834have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36835achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36836might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36837&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36838
36839Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36840probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36841extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36842can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36843.code
36844dnslookup:
36845 driver = dnslookup
36846 domains = ! +local_domains
36847 transport = \
36848 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36849 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36850 no_more
36851.endd
36852If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36853of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36854routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36855errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36856address.
36857
36858On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36859&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36860SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36861and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36862of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36863.code
36864verp_dnslookup:
36865 driver = dnslookup
36866 domains = ! +local_domains
36867 transport = remote_smtp
36868 errors_to = \
36869 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36870 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
36871 no_more
36872.endd
36873Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36874configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36875Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36876router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36877them.
36878
36879The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36880message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36881host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36882a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36883a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36884than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36885used).
36886
36887
36888
36889
36890
36891
36892.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36893.cindex "virtual domains"
36894.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36895The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36896meanings:
36897
36898.ilist
36899A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36900aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36901top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36902.next
36903One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36904with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36905have login accounts on that host.
36906.endlist
36907
36908The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36909the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36910aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36911virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36912whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36913to a router of this form:
36914.code
36915virtual:
36916 driver = redirect
36917 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36918 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
36919 no_more
36920.endd
36921.new
36922The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36923is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36924domain that is being processed.
36925The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
36926being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
36927.wen
36928
36929When the router runs, it looks up the local
36930part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36931setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36932string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36933
36934This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36935follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36936can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36937a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36938
36939The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36940way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36941valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36942.code
36943my_domains:
36944 driver = accept
36945 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36946 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36947 transport = my_mailboxes
36948.endd
36949The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36950can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36951file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36952option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36953because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36954follows:
36955.code
36956my_mailboxes:
36957 driver = appendfile
36958 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part_data
36959 user = mail
36960.endd
36961This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36962required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36963
36964The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36965requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36966up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36967information about the domains.
36968
36969
36970
36971.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36972.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36973.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36974.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36975.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36976Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36977incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36978allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36979identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36980parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36981&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36982example, consider this router:
36983.code
36984userforward:
36985 driver = redirect
36986 check_local_user
36987 file = $home/.forward
36988 local_part_suffix = -*
36989 local_part_suffix_optional
36990 allow_filter
36991.endd
36992.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36993It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36994&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36995cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36996.code
36997if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36998save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36999endif
37000.endd
37001If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
37002fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
37003&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
37004control over which suffixes are valid.
37005
37006Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
37007&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
37008another MTA:
37009.code
37010userforward:
37011 driver = redirect
37012 check_local_user
37013 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
37014 local_part_suffix = -*
37015 local_part_suffix_optional
37016 allow_filter
37017.endd
37018If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
37019example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
37020does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
37021subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
37022&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
37023
37024
37025
37026.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
37027.cindex "vacation processing"
37028The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
37029a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
37030(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
37031This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
37032that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
37033
37034.ilist
37035A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
37036can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
37037alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
37038&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
37039.code
37040spqr, vacation-spqr
37041.endd
37042.next
37043The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
37044vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
37045user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
37046ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
37047to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
37048message.
37049.endlist
37050
37051Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
37052use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
37053
37054
37055
37056.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
37057.cindex "message" "copying every"
37058Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
37059be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
37060command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
37061each day's messages.
37062
37063There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
37064messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
37065delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
37066notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
37067
37068
37069
37070.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
37071.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
37072It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
37073Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
37074arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
37075permanently connected.
37076
37077Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
37078particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
37079Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
37080
37081
37082.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
37083It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
37084host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
37085approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
37086being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
37087some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
37088to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
37089resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
37090
37091A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
37092intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
37093into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
37094format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
37095destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
37096in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
37097if required.
37098
37099On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
37100you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
37101intermittent host. For example:
37102.code
37103cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
37104.endd
37105This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
37106which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
37107online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
37108options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
37109causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
37110connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
37111immediately.
37112
37113If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
37114issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
37115mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
37116used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
37117avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
37118Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
37119arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
37120
37121
37122
37123.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
37124The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
37125increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
37126connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
37127delivered immediately.
37128
37129.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37130.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
37131.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
37132.cindex "first pass routing"
37133Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
37134not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
37135possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
37136each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
37137avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
37138&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
37139first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
37140normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
37141destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
37142single SMTP connection.
37143
37144
37145
37146. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37147. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37148
37149.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
37150 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
37151.cindex "client, non-queueing"
37152.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
37153On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
37154email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
37155configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
37156However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
37157configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
37158&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
37159messages this way.
37160
37161If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
37162run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
37163any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
37164continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
37165email is not desirable.
37166
37167There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
37168&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
37169any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
37170host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
37171informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
37172to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
37173to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
37174
37175There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
37176that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
37177ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
37178before sending a message to the smart host.
37179
37180Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
37181tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
37182overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
37183
37184.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
37185There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
37186Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
37187assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
37188just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
37189compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
37190router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
37191
37192When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
37193following ways:
37194
37195.ilist
37196A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
37197In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
37198.next
37199Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
37200assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
37201&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
37202does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
37203successful, a zero return code is given.
37204.next
37205Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
37206be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
37207the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
37208must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
37209deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
37210are.
37211.next
37212If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
37213failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
37214successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
37215.next
37216Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
37217is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
37218smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
37219the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
37220there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
37221.next
37222If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
37223connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
37224failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
37225.next
37226When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
37227(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
37228value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
37229are ever generated.
37230.next
37231No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
37232.next
37233A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
37234true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
37235&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
37236.endlist
37237
37238The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
37239the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
37240deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
37241privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
37242to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
37243the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
37244
37245
37246
37247
37248. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37249. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37250
37251.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
37252.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
37253.cindex "log" "types of"
37254Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
37255and the panic log:
37256
37257.ilist
37258.cindex "main log"
37259The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
37260line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
37261down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
37262out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
37263them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
37264they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
37265analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
37266&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
37267.next
37268.cindex "reject log"
37269The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
37270of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
37271The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
37272the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
37273is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
37274lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
37275reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
37276host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
37277can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
37278false.
37279.next
37280.cindex "panic log"
37281.cindex "system log"
37282When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
37283error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
37284are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
37285other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
37286therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
37287regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
37288panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
37289is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
37290message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
37291.endlist
37292
37293Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
37294example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
37295In the log file, this would be all on one line:
37296.code
372972001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
37298 by QUIT
37299.endd
37300By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
37301ways of changing this:
37302
37303.ilist
37304You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
37305you set
37306.code
37307timezone = UTC
37308.endd
37309the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
37310.next
37311If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
37312example:
37313.code
373142003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
37315.endd
37316.endlist
37317
37318.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37319.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37320Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
37321request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
37322&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
37323brackets, immediately after the time and date.
37324
37325
37326
37327
37328.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
37329.cindex "log" "destination"
37330.cindex "log" "to file"
37331.cindex "log" "to syslog"
37332.cindex "syslog"
37333The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
37334should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
37335are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
37336arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
37337It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
37338need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
37339Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
37340
37341The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
37342&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
37343configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
37344references to the host name:
37345.code
37346log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
37347.endd
37348It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
37349rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
37350start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
37351before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
37352configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
37353log at all.
37354
37355The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
37356list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
37357facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
37358colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
37359otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
37360point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
37361implying the use of a default path.
37362
37363When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
37364LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
37365&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
37366mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
37367files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
37368equivalent to the setting:
37369.code
37370log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
37371.endd
37372If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
37373or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37374that is where the logs are written.
37375
37376A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37377are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37378
37379Here are some examples of possible settings:
37380.display
37381&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37382&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37383&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37384&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37385.endd
37386If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37387error is logged.
37388
37389
37390
37391.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37392.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37393.cindex "cycling logs"
37394.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37395.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37396Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37397log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37398provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37399main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37400keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37401
37402An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37403and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37404example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37405message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37406that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37407something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37408ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37409&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37410does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37411tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37412for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37413renamed.
37414
37415
37416
37417.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37418.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37419Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37420periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37421for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37422&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37423the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37424point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37425.code
37426log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37427log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37428log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37429log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37430.endd
37431As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37432examples of names generated by the above examples:
37433.code
37434/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37435/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37436/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37437/var/log/exim/main.200212
37438.endd
37439When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37440files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37441will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37442run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37443
37444The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37445is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37446When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37447the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37448non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37449character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37450log names:
37451.code
37452/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37453/var/log/exim-panic.log
37454/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37455/var/log/exim/panic
37456.endd
37457
37458
37459.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37460.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37461The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37462except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37463Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37464that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37465&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37466by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37467&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37468SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37469&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37470LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37471the time and host name to each line.
37472The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37473
37474.ilist
37475&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37476.next
37477&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37478.next
37479&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37480.endlist
37481
37482Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37483written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37484these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37485by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37486
37487Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37488entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37489these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37490calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37491870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37492additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37493replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37494RFC 3164, you should set
37495.code
37496SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37497.endd
37498in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37499lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37500
37501To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37502entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37503where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37504components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37505because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37506delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37507870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37508&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37509name, and pid as added by syslog:
37510.code
37511[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37512[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37513[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37514[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37515[5/5] mple>)
37516.endd
37517The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37518(LOG_NOTICE):
37519.code
37520[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37521[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37522[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37523[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37524[5\18] .example>)
37525[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37526[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37527[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37528[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37529[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37530[11\18] 09:43 +0100
37531[12\18] F From: <>
37532[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37533[18\18] X-something: this is another header
37534[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37535[16\18] le>
37536[17\18] B Bcc:
37537[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37538.endd
37539Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37540without modification.
37541
37542If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37543display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37544the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37545where it is.
37546
37547
37548
37549.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37550One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37551successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37552picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37553timestamp. The flags are:
37554.display
37555&`<=`& message arrival
37556&`(=`& message fakereject
37557&`=>`& normal message delivery
37558&`->`& additional address in same delivery
37559&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37560&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37561&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37562&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37563.endd
37564
37565
37566.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37567.cindex "log" "reception line"
37568The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37569message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37570several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37571.code
375722002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37573 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37574 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37575.endd
37576The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37577bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37578generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37579.code
37580R=<message id>
37581.endd
37582which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37583
37584.cindex "HELO"
37585.cindex "EHLO"
37586For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37587record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37588received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37589host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37590above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37591&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37592by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37593verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37594EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37595name in parentheses.
37596
37597Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37598without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37599the log containing text like these examples:
37600.code
37601H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37602H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37603.endd
37604This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37605on.
37606
37607For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37608the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37609of Exim.
37610
37611.cindex "authentication" "logging"
37612.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37613For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37614message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37615of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37616extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37617session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37618suite that was used.
37619
37620.cindex log protocol
37621The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37622hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37623value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37624there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37625was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37626&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37627authenticator name.
37628
37629.cindex "size" "of message"
37630The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37631received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37632headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37633message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37634other).
37635
37636The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37637data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37638
37639
37640
37641.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37642.cindex "log" "delivery line"
37643The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37644delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37645deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37646to fit it on the page:
37647.code
376482002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37649 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
376502002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37651 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37652 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37653.endd
37654For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37655after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37656intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37657last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37658fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37659
37660If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37661followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37662If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37663option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37664
37665If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37666for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37667.display
37668&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37669.endd
37670If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37671parentheses afterwards.
37672
37673.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37674When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37675SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37676flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37677down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37678lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37679When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37680DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37681will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37682TLS cipher information is still available.
37683
37684.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37685.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37686When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37687line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37688rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37689
37690The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37691&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37692
37693The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37694data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37695
37696
37697.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37698.cindex "discarded messages"
37699.cindex "message" "discarded"
37700.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37701When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37702obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37703.code
377042002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37705 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37706.endd
37707is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37708because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37709.code
377101999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37711 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37712.endd
37713
37714
37715.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37716When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37717.code
377182002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37719 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37720.endd
37721In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37722last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37723written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37724.code
377252002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37726 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37727.endd
37728When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37729a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37730appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37731
37732
37733
37734.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37735.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37736If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37737following form is logged:
37738.code
377391995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37740 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37741.endd
37742If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37743the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37744.code
377452002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37746 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37747 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37748 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37749 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37750.endd
37751The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37752used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37753disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37754flagged with &`**`&.
37755
37756
37757
37758.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37759.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37760If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37761used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37762&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37763
37764
37765
37766.section "Completion" "SECID257"
37767A line of the form
37768.code
377692002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37770.endd
37771is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37772at the end of its processing.
37773
37774
37775
37776
37777.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37778.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37779A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37780the following table:
37781.display
37782&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37783&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37784&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37785&`CV `& certificate verification status
37786&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37787&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37788&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37789&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37790&`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37791&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37792&`H `& host name and IP address
37793&`I `& local interface used
37794&`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37795&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37796&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37797&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37798&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37799&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37800&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37801&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37802&`Q `& alternate queue name
37803&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37804&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37805&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37806&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37807&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37808&`S `& size of message in bytes
37809&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37810&`ST `& shadow transport name
37811&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37812&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37813&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37814&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37815&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37816.endd
37817
37818
37819.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37820Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37821self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37822
37823.ilist
37824.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37825&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37826during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37827This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37828during the first delivery attempt.
37829.next
37830&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37831temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37832for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37833.next
37834.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37835&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37836some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37837common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37838&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37839doing.
37840.next
37841.cindex "error" "ignored"
37842&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37843message:
37844.olist
37845Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37846&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37847.next
37848A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37849failed. The delivery was discarded.
37850.next
37851A delivery set up by a router configured with
37852. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37853. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37854.code
37855 errors_to = <>
37856.endd
37857failed. The delivery was discarded.
37858.endlist olist
37859.next
37860.cindex DKIM "log line"
37861&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37862logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37863.endlist ilist
37864
37865
37866
37867
37868
37869.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37870.cindex "log" "selectors"
37871By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37872default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37873&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37874example:
37875.code
37876log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37877.endd
37878The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37879selection marked by asterisks:
37880.display
37881&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37882&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37883&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37884&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37885&` arguments `& command line arguments
37886&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37887&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37888&` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
37889&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37890&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37891&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37892&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37893&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37894&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37895&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37896&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37897&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37898&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37899&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37900&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37901&`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37902&` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37903&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37904&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37905&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37906&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37907&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37908&` pid `& Exim process id
37909&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37910&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37911&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37912&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37913&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37914&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37915&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37916&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37917&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37918&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37919&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37920&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37921&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37922&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37923&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37924&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37925&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37926&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37927&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37928&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37929&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37930&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37931&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37932&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37933&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37934
37935&` all `& all of the above
37936.endd
37937See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37938section &<<SECID99>>&
37939
37940More details on each of these items follows:
37941
37942.ilist
37943.cindex "8BITMIME"
37944.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37945&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37946which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37947that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37948&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37949&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37950.next
37951.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37952&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37953its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37954this log selector is set.
37955.next
37956.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37957.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37958&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37959rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37960such users cannot access the log).
37961.next
37962.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37963&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37964delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37965parentheses between them.
37966.next
37967.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37968.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37969&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37970to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37971feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37972&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37973privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37974that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37975are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37976because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37977only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37978between the caller and Exim.
37979.next
37980.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37981&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37982connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37983.next
37984.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37985.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37986&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37987started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37988messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37989process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37990.next
37991.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37992&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37993perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37994If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37995precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37996.next
37997.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37998.cindex "size" "of message"
37999&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
38000the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
38001.next
38002.cindex log "DKIM verification"
38003.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38004&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
38005verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
38006.next
38007.cindex log "DKIM verification"
38008.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38009&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
38010.next
38011.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
38012.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
38013.cindex "black list (DNS)"
38014&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
38015DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
38016.next
38017.cindex log dnssec
38018.cindex dnssec logging
38019&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
38020dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
38021For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
38022It does not cover helo-name verification.
38023For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
38024.next
38025.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
38026.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
38027&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
38028is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
38029command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
38030selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
38031.next
38032.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
38033&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
38034any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
38035log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
38036routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
38037.next
38038.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
38039.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
38040&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
38041client's ident port times out.
38042.next
38043.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
38044.cindex "log" "local interface"
38045.cindex "log" "local address and port"
38046.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38047.cindex "interface" "logging"
38048&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
38049to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
38050followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
38051added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
38052rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
38053The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38054.next
38055.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
38056.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
38057.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
38058&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
38059of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
38060on a proxied connection
38061or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
38062See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
38063.next
38064.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
38065.cindex "port" "logging remote"
38066.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
38067.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
38068.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
38069&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
38070added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
38071in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
38072changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
38073&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
38074important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
38075.next
38076.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
38077&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
38078connection is unexpectedly dropped.
38079.next
38080.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
38081.cindex millisecond logging
38082.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
38083&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
38084appended to the seconds value.
38085.next
38086.cindex "log" "message id"
38087&%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
38088.next
38089&%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
38090This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
38091(submission mode) without one.
38092The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
38093.next
38094.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
38095.cindex "log" "local interface"
38096.cindex "log" "local address and port"
38097.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38098.cindex "interface" "logging"
38099&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
38100interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
38101followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
38102off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38103.next
38104.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
38105.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
38106.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
38107&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
38108containing => tags) following the IP address.
38109The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
38110&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
38111This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
38112configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
38113local port is a random ephemeral port.
38114.next
38115.cindex "log" "process ids in"
38116.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38117&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
38118immediately after the time and date.
38119.next
38120.cindex log pipelining
38121.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
38122&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
38123log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
38124The field is a single "L".
38125
38126On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
38127the field has a minus appended.
38128
38129.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
38130If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
38131accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
38132offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
38133Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
38134
38135.next
38136.cindex "log" "queue run"
38137.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
38138&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
38139.next
38140.cindex "log" "queue time"
38141&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
38142local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
38143&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
38144includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
38145This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
38146delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
38147message has been successfully received.
38148If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38149precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
38150.next
38151&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
38152the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
38153example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
38154message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
38155.next
38156.cindex "log" "receive duration"
38157&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
38158perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
38159If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38160precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
38161.next
38162.cindex "log" "recipients"
38163&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
38164as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
38165that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
38166addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
38167has taken place.
38168Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
38169in the list.
38170.next
38171.cindex "log" "sender reception"
38172&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
38173the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
38174&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
38175.next
38176.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
38177&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
38178rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
38179log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
38180rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
38181.next
38182.cindex "log" "retry defer"
38183&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
38184retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
38185message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
38186attempt.
38187.next
38188.cindex "log" "return path"
38189&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
38190the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
38191This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
38192or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
38193.next
38194.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
38195&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
38196and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
38197This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
38198necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
38199.next
38200.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
38201&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
38202gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
38203the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
38204detail is lost.
38205.next
38206.cindex "log" "size rejection"
38207&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
38208it is too big.
38209.next
38210.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
38211.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
38212&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
38213queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
38214it.
38215.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
38216The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
38217.next
38218.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
38219.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
38220.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
38221&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
38222outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
38223A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
38224response.
38225.next
38226.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
38227.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
38228&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
38229established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
38230&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
38231only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
38232processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
38233dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
38234not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
38235of connections unless this selector is enabled.
38236
38237For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
38238included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
38239reset if the daemon is restarted.
38240Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
38241subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
38242whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
38243match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
38244logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
38245.next
38246.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
38247.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
38248&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
38249RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
38250and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
38251line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
38252.next
38253.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
38254.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
38255&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
38256connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
38257the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
38258does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
38259an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
38260already have their own log lines.
38261
38262The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
38263way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
38264If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
38265an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
38266DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
38267the same logging options.
38268
38269Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
38270is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
38271.code
38272C=EHLO,QUIT
38273.endd
38274shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
38275than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
38276the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
38277setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
38278have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
38279.next
38280&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
38281colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
38282log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
38283was accepted or used.
38284.next
38285.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
38286.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
38287&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
38288encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
38289because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
38290been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
38291it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
38292received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
38293.next
38294.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
38295.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
38296.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
38297.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
38298.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
38299&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
38300encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
38301external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
38302using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
38303.next
38304.cindex "log" "subject"
38305.cindex "subject, logging"
38306&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
38307preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
38308Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
38309specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
38310unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
38311.next
38312.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
38313.cindex log DANE
38314.cindex DANE logging
38315&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
38316when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
38317verified
38318using a CA trust anchor,
38319&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
38320and &`CV=no`& if not.
38321.next
38322.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
38323.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
38324&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38325connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
38326.next
38327.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
38328.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
38329&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38330connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
38331added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
38332.next
38333.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
38334.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
38335&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
38336the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
38337added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
38338.next
38339.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
38340&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
38341result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
38342.endlist
38343
38344
38345.section "Message log" "SECID260"
38346.cindex "message" "log file for"
38347.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
38348.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
38349.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
38350In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
38351that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
38352they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
38353message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
38354makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
38355to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
38356is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
38357only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
38358
38359On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
38360per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
38361&%message_logs%& option false.
38362.ecindex IIDloggen
38363
38364
38365
38366
38367. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38368. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38369
38370.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
38371.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
38372A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
38373described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38374the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38375
38376.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38377.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38378 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38379.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38380.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38381.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38382.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38383 various criteria"
38384.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38385.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38386 "extract statistics from the log"
38387.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38388 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38389.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38390.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38391.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38392.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38393.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38394.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38395.endtable
38396
38397Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38398&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38399&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38400
38401
38402
38403
38404.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38405.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38406.cindex "process, querying"
38407.cindex "SIGUSR1"
38408On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38409(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38410a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38411Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38412processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38413second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38414order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38415send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38416
38417&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38418use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38419script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38420
38421
38422Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38423varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38424but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38425system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38426it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38427options:
38428.display
38429&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38430&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38431&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38432&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38433.endd
38434An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38435.code
38436164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3843710483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3843810492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38439 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3844010592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3844110628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38442.endd
38443The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38444been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38445
38446
38447
38448.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38449.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38450.cindex "queue" "grepping"
38451This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38452.code
38453exim -bpu
38454.endd
38455or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38456.code
38457exim -bp
38458.endd
38459The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38460contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38461
38462to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38463that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38464
38465.vlist
38466.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38467Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38468tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38469.code
38470exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
38471.endd
38472.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38473Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38474tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38475
38476.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38477Match against the size field.
38478
38479.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38480Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38481
38482.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38483Match messages that are older than the given time.
38484
38485.vitem &*-z*&
38486Match only frozen messages.
38487
38488.vitem &*-x*&
38489Match only non-frozen messages.
38490
38491.vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38492Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38493.endlist
38494
38495The following options control the format of the output:
38496
38497.vlist
38498.vitem &*-c*&
38499Display only the count of matching messages.
38500
38501.vitem &*-l*&
38502Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38503the default.
38504
38505.vitem &*-i*&
38506Display message ids only.
38507
38508.vitem &*-b*&
38509Brief format &-- one line per message.
38510
38511.vitem &*-R*&
38512Display messages in reverse order.
38513
38514.vitem &*-a*&
38515Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38516.endlist
38517
38518There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38519
38520
38521
38522.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38523.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38524.cindex "queue" "summary"
38525The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38526-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38527running a command such as
38528.code
38529exim -bp | exiqsumm
38530.endd
38531The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38532it, as in the following example:
38533.code
385343 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38535.endd
38536Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38537volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38538been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38539number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38540
38541A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38542domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38543the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38544respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38545domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38546separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38547sender.
38548
38549The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38550this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38551generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38552option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38553level"& addresses).
38554
38555
38556
38557
38558.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38559 "SECTextspeinf"
38560.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38561.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38562The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38563files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38564extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38565match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38566given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38567The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38568If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38569included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38570.display
38571&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38572.endd
38573If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38574
38575The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38576condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38577they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38578
38579By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38580makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38581large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38582option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38583case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38584
38585The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38586pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38587regular expression.
38588
38589The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38590if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38591
38592The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38593that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38594normally.
38595
38596Example of &%-M%&:
38597user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38598&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38599displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38600the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38601when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38602&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38603search term.
38604
38605If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38606ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38607whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38608If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38609autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38610
38611
38612.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38613.cindex "&'exipick'&"
38614John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38615lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38616of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38617the &%--help%& option.
38618
38619
38620.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38621.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38622.cindex "cycling logs"
38623.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38624The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38625&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38626you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38627&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38628for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38629There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38630.ilist
38631&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38632default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38633.next
38634&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38635&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38636overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38637configuration.
38638.endlist
38639
38640Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38641the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38642run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38643&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38644&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38645logs are handled similarly.
38646
38647If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38648&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38649to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38650any existing log files.
38651
38652If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38653the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38654using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38655setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38656root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38657.code
386581 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38659.endd
38660assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38661&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38662
38663
38664
38665.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38666.cindex "statistics"
38667.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38668A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38669information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38670. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38671. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38672
38673The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38674latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38675lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38676various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38677list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38678.code
38679eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38680.endd
38681By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38682messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38683both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38684are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38685addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38686options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38687also produced per user.
38688
38689The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38690histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38691hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38692example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38693as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38694
38695Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38696have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38697messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38698and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38699recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38700an entirely separate message.
38701
38702&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38703of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38704each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38705not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38706least one address that failed.
38707
38708The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38709or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38710transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38711(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38712a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38713senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38714and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38715
38716The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38717came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38718without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38719
38720There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38721outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38722by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38723.code
38724perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38725.endd
38726
38727.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38728.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38729.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38730.cindex "checking access"
38731The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38732debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38733policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38734familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38735sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38736access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38737
38738The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38739two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38740.code
38741exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38742.endd
38743The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38744given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38745connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38746is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38747.code
38748Rejected:
38749550 Relay not permitted
38750.endd
38751When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38752for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38753options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38754that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38755you can use:
38756.code
38757exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38758 -f himself@there.example
38759.endd
38760Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38761mandatory arguments.
38762
38763Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38764while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38765&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38766
38767
38768
38769.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38770.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38771.cindex "building DBM files"
38772.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38773.cindex "lower casing"
38774.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38775The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38776the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38777&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38778names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38779can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38780
38781A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38782the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38783&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38784strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38785files.
38786
38787The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38788single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38789It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38790well.
38791
38792.cindex "USE_DB"
38793If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38794configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38795filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38796create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38797.code
38798exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38799.endd
38800reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38801&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38802
38803In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38804Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38805environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38806&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38807when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38808recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38809
38810If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38811finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38812option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38813this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38814&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38815There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38816&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38817return code is 2.
38818
38819
38820
38821
38822.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38823.cindex "retry" "times"
38824.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38825A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38826fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38827complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38828information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38829is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38830output. For example:
38831.code
38832$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38833kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38834 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38835 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38836 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38837roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38838 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38839 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38840 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38841 past final cutoff time
38842.endd
38843You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38844will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38845A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38846message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38847suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38848&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38849run very often.
38850
38851The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38852of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38853passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38854configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38855file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38856environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38857
38858
38859
38860.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38861.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38862.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38863Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38864uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38865arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38866second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38867
38868.ilist
38869&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38870.next
38871&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38872for remote hosts
38873.next
38874&'callout'&: the callout cache
38875.next
38876&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38877.next
38878&'misc'&: other hints data
38879.endlist
38880
38881The &'misc'& database is used for
38882
38883.ilist
38884Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38885.next
38886Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38887&(smtp)& transport)
38888.next
38889Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38890in a transport)
38891.endlist
38892
38893
38894
38895.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38896.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38897The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38898&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38899spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38900.code
38901exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38902.endd
38903Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38904.code
38905T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3890631-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38907.endd
38908The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38909of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38910transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38911a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38912address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38913transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38914to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38915and a textual description of the error.
38916
38917The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38918the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38919ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38920exceeded.
38921
38922Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38923consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38924waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38925one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38926may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38927may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38928cross-references.
38929
38930
38931
38932.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38933.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38934The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38935database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38936days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38937updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38938since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38939for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38940updated sufficiently often.
38941
38942The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38943followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38944the retry database:
38945.code
38946exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38947.endd
38948Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38949message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38950they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38951are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38952types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38953message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38954queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38955&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38956For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38957removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38958whenever it removes information from the database.
38959
38960Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38961needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38962down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38963first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38964records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38965
38966It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38967hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38968a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38969work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38970but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38971After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38972point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38973tidied.
38974
38975&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38976databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38977
38978
38979
38980
38981.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38982.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38983The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38984Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38985getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38986is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38987key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38988displayed.
38989
38990If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38991except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38992out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38993data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38994by new data, for example:
38995.code
38996> 4 951102:1000
38997.endd
38998resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38999sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
39000used as optional separators.
39001
39002
39003
39004
39005.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
39006.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
39007.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
39008.cindex "locking mailboxes"
39009The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
39010Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
39011&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
39012a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
39013the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
39014argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
39015second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
39016is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
39017is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
39018
39019.vlist
39020.vitem &%-fcntl%&
39021Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
39022
39023.vitem &%-flock%&
39024Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
39025supports it.
39026
39027.vitem &%-interval%&
39028This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
39029interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
39030
39031.vitem &%-lockfile%&
39032Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
39033
39034.vitem &%-mbx%&
39035Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
39036
39037.vitem &%-q%&
39038Suppress verification output.
39039
39040.vitem &%-retries%&
39041This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
39042the lock (default 10).
39043
39044.vitem &%-restore_time%&
39045This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
39046locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
39047example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
39048subsequently sees.
39049
39050.vitem &%-timeout%&
39051This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
39052timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
39053default), a non-blocking call is used.
39054
39055.vitem &%-v%&
39056Generate verbose output.
39057.endlist
39058
39059If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
39060default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
39061mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
39062&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
39063requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
39064file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
39065more than 30 minutes old.
39066
39067The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
39068&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
39069to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
39070&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
39071number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
39072can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
39073
39074The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
39075&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
39076suppresses all output except error messages.
39077
39078A command such as
39079.code
39080exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
39081.endd
39082runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
39083.display
39084&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
39085<&'some commands'&>
39086&`End`&
39087.endd
39088runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
39089suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
39090such as
39091.code
39092exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
39093 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
39094.endd
39095Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
39096second argument &-- hence the quotes.
39097.ecindex IIDutils
39098
39099
39100. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39101. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39102
39103.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
39104.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
39105.cindex "X-windows"
39106.cindex "&'eximon'&"
39107.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
39108.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
39109The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
39110about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
39111perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
39112such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
39113monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
39114
39115
39116
39117.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
39118The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
39119script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
39120binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
39121be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
39122&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
39123parameters are for.
39124
39125The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
39126a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
39127preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
39128.code
39129EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
39130.endd
39131(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
39132the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
39133overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
39134&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
39135syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
39136
39137X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
39138way. For example, a resource setting of the form
39139.code
39140Eximon*background: gray94
39141.endd
39142changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
39143stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
39144black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
39145data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
39146&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
39147For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
39148reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
39149.code
39150xrdb -merge <<End
39151Eximon*highlight: gray
39152End
39153.endd
39154.cindex "admin user"
39155In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
39156&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
39157
39158The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
39159contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
39160if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
39161binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
39162versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
39163
39164The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
39165more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
39166main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
39167delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
39168different parts of the display.
39169
39170
39171
39172
39173.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
39174.cindex "stripchart"
39175The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
39176be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39177&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
39178configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
39179it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
39180hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
39181received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
39182period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
39183parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39184
39185The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
39186displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
39187title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
39188For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
39189
39190It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
39191a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
39192to a single partition.
39193
39194.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
39195This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
39196the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
39197this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
39198100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
39199SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39200&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39201
39202
39203
39204
39205.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
39206.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
39207.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
39208.cindex "window size"
39209Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
39210to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
39211shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
39212stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
39213the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
39214in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
39215
39216When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
39217currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
39218size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
39219remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
39220
39221The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
39222stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
39223the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
39224The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
39225&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
39226the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39227
39228Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
39229built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
39230START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39231
39232
39233
39234.section "The log display" "SECID267"
39235.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
39236The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
39237the main log is maintained.
39238To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
39239removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
39240The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
39241syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
39242to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
39243
39244The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
39245move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
39246scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
39247LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
39248to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
39249much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
39250a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
39251only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
39252available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
39253normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
39254configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39255
39256Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
39257and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
39258respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
39259It cannot go further back up the log.
39260
39261The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
39262normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
39263by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
39264by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
39265back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
39266the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
39267
39268Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
39269There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
39270the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
39271happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
39272&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
39273^C is typed the search is cancelled.
39274
39275The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
39276widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
39277&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
39278eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
39279However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
39280provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
39281come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
39282unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
39283on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
39284window.
39285
39286
39287
39288.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
39289.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
39290The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
39291are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
39292as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
39293parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
39294at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
39295the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
39296there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
39297to force an update of the queue display at any time.
39298
39299When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
39300and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
39301with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
39302pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
39303type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
39304such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
39305of the texts, the message is not displayed.
39306
39307If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
39308are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
39309example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
39310&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
39311has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
39312cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
39313a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
39314
39315While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
39316else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
39317queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
39318pressing the &"Hide"& button.
39319
39320The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
39321time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
39322message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
39323a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
39324recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
39325listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
39326an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
39327not shown.
39328
39329.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
39330If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
39331
39332The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
39333of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
39334The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
39335available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
39336display is updated.
39337
39338
39339
39340.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
39341.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
39342If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
39343pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
39344line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
39345any selected text.
39346
39347If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
39348MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
39349set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
39350value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
39351run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
39352.code
39353EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
39354.endd
39355The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
39356follows:
39357
39358.ilist
39359&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
39360in a new text window.
39361.next
39362&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
39363information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
39364&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
39365.next
39366&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
39367displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
39368amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
39369option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
39370.next
39371&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
39372delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
39373frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39374a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39375up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39376.next
39377&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39378that the message be frozen.
39379.next
39380.cindex "thawing messages"
39381.cindex "unfreezing messages"
39382.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39383&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39384that the message be thawed.
39385.next
39386.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39387&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39388that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39389for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39390.next
39391&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39392that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39393message.
39394.next
39395&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39396be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39397is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39398Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39399causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39400additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39401which case no action is taken.
39402.next
39403&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39404can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39405is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39406Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39407causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39408recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39409case no action is taken.
39410.next
39411&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39412mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39413.next
39414&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39415sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39416&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39417in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39418bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39419not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39420the address is qualified with that domain.
39421.endlist
39422
39423When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39424other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39425particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39426output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39427from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39428&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39429if no output is generated.
39430
39431The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39432thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39433&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39434force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39435
39436In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39437cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39438and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39439.ecindex IIDeximon
39440
39441
39442
39443
39444
39445. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39446. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39447
39448.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39449.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39450This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39451which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39452
39453For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39454Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39455existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39456chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39457security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39458its security as compared with other MTAs.
39459
39460What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39461have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39462absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39463as soon as possible.
39464
39465
39466.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39467.cindex "security" "build-time features"
39468There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39469to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39470Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39471penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39472
39473.ilist
39474ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39475start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39476filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39477the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39478&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39479default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39480
39481If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39482which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39483into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39484configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39485.next
39486
39487If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39488or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39489file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39490the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39491root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39492right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39493reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39494it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39495privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39496separate commands.
39497
39498.next
39499The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39500with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39501CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39502requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39503the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39504but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39505previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39506.next
39507If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39508is disabled.
39509.next
39510FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39511never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39512option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39513to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39514is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39515.endlist
39516
39517
39518
39519.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39520.cindex "setuid"
39521.cindex "root privilege"
39522The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39523privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39524example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39525may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39526discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39527is required for two things:
39528
39529.ilist
39530To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39531the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39532not required.
39533.next
39534To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39535perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39536configuration.
39537.endlist
39538
39539It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39540receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39541obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39542For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39543&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39544group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39545is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39546&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39547
39548Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39549abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39550&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39551
39552After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39553uid and gid in the following cases:
39554
39555.ilist
39556.oindex "&%-C%&"
39557.oindex "&%-D%&"
39558If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39559the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39560calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39561the calling process.
39562However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39563option may not be used at all.
39564If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39565can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39566user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39567.next
39568.oindex "&%-be%&"
39569.oindex "&%-bf%&"
39570.oindex "&%-bF%&"
39571If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39572(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39573calling process.
39574.next
39575If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39576process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39577uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39578runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39579testing address verification
39580.oindex "&%-bv%&"
39581.oindex "&%-bh%&"
39582(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39583option).
39584.next
39585For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39586remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39587.endlist
39588
39589The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39590
39591.ilist
39592A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39593user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39594function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39595will be used during message reception.
39596.next
39597A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39598job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39599.next
39600A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39601but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39602subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39603deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39604remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39605subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39606while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39607generating bounce and warning messages.
39608
39609While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39610process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39611this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39612gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39613.next
39614A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39615the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39616.endlist
39617
39618
39619
39620
39621.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39622.cindex "privilege, running without"
39623.cindex "unprivileged running"
39624.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39625Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39626operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39627by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39628gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39629(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39630routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39631to any other uid.
39632
39633.cindex SIGHUP
39634.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39635Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39636that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39637correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39638
39639An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39640to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39641process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39642when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39643SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39644
39645It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39646stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39647been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39648effect.
39649
39650If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39651set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39652to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39653
39654In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39655those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39656Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39657that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39658discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39659have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39660number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39661address this problem at this time.
39662
39663For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39664is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39665&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39666be used in the most straightforward way.
39667
39668If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39669number of restrictions on what you can do:
39670
39671.ilist
39672You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39673&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39674normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39675work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39676explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39677.next
39678Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39679not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39680.next
39681Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39682the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39683and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39684enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39685.next
39686Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39687some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39688
39689.olist
39690They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39691implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39692mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39693.next
39694You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39695owned by the Exim user.
39696.next
39697You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39698on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39699mailboxes need to be created manually.
39700.endlist olist
39701.endlist ilist
39702
39703
39704These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39705However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39706gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39707gives more security at essentially no cost.
39708
39709If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39710&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39711
39712
39713
39714
39715.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39716Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39717are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39718
39719
39720
39721.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39722.cindex "security" "local commands"
39723.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39724There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39725commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39726configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39727run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39728
39729.ilist
39730Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39731injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39732be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39733allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39734has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39735.next
39736A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39737&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39738&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39739hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39740NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39741forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39742need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39743.next
39744The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39745administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39746Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39747.next
39748Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39749taint checking might apply to their usage.
39750.next
39751Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39752administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39753instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39754.next
39755Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39756Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39757each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39758of opaque strings.
39759The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39760real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39761injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39762Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39763.endlist
39764
39765
39766
39767
39768.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39769.cindex "security" "data sources"
39770.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39771.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39772.cindex "PCRE" "security"
39773If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39774are some issues to be aware of:
39775
39776.ilist
39777Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39778.next
39779Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39780.next
39781Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39782data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39783"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39784expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39785when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39786possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39787data.
39788.next
39789It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39790&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39791items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39792.next
39793Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39794expected to yield one result.
39795.endlist
39796
39797
39798
39799
39800.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39801.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39802.cindex "IP source routing"
39803Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39804some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39805IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39806IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39807
39808
39809
39810.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39811Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39812be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39813
39814
39815
39816
39817.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39818.cindex "trusted users"
39819.cindex "admin user"
39820.cindex "privileged user"
39821.cindex "user" "trusted"
39822.cindex "user" "admin"
39823Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39824able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39825addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39826local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39827permit a remote host to be specified.
39828
39829.oindex "&%-f%&"
39830However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39831in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39832message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39833but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39834permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39835the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39836
39837Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39838other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39839the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39840as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39841group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39842
39843Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39844can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39845them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39846the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39847includes the contents of files on the spool.
39848
39849.oindex "&%-M%&"
39850.oindex "&%-q%&"
39851By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39852delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39853restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39854Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39855queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39856setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39857
39858Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39859the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39860the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39861group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39862the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39863unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39864files.
39865
39866By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39867introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39868setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39869This affects most of the checking options,
39870such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39871
39872
39873.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39874.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39875Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39876set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39877&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39878any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39879
39880
39881
39882.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39883Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39884of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39885with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39886to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39887this.
39888
39889
39890
39891.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39892The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39893are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39894Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39895converted output.
39896
39897
39898
39899.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39900Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39901to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39902does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39903arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39904
39905
39906
39907.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39908Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39909defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39910loading it.
39911
39912
39913.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39914.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39915A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39916&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39917The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39918that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39919conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39920
39921The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39922the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39923string.
39924
39925
39926
39927.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39928Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39929formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39930the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39931
39932
39933
39934.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39935These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39936enough to hold the result.
39937.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39938
39939
39940
39941
39942. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39943. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39944
39945.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39946.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39947.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39948.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39949.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39950A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39951followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39952the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39953kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39954two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39955is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39956themselves are recoverable.
39957
39958The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39959Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39960and should not be used as such.
39961
39962Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39963need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39964on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39965
39966.ilist
39967You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39968fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39969which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39970place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39971lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39972.next
39973.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39974If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39975&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39976cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39977.next
39978If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39979.next
39980If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39981signature.
39982.endlist
39983All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39984
39985Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39986its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39987files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39988the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39989the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39990is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39991file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39992-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39993attempt.
39994
39995Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39996These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39997They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39998relics of crashes and can be removed.
39999
40000.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
40001.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
40002.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
40003The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
40004process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
40005gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
40006message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
40007normally the Exim user.
40008
40009The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
40010transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
40011empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
40012in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
40013created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
40014&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
40015leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
40016&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
40017
40018The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
40019was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
40020start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
40021warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
40022
40023There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
40024order, and are omitted when not relevant:
40025
40026.vlist
40027.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40028This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
40029&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
40030recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
40031this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
40032identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
40033the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
40034the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
40035the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
40036newlines.
40037
40038.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40039A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
40040defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
40041The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40042starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40043character. It may contain internal newlines.
40044
40045.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40046A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
40047Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
40048length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40049starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40050character. It may contain internal newlines.
40051
40052.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
40053This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
40054&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
40055
40056.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
40057This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
40058lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
40059transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
40060messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40061
40062.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
40063This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
40064(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
40065time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
40066hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40067
40068.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
40069The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
40070&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
40071
40072.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
40073The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
40074&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
40075
40076.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40077This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
40078present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
40079
40080.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40081This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
40082present if the number is greater than zero.
40083
40084.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
40085This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
40086file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
40087
40088.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
40089.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
40090The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
40091
40092.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40093This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
40094command.
40095
40096.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40097This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
40098the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
40099messages.
40100
40101.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
40102If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
40103the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
40104&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
40105
40106.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
40107This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
40108address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
40109
40110.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40111.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
40112.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
40113This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
40114if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
40115received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
40116
40117.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
40118For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
40119unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
40120ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
40121supplied by the remote host, if any.
40122
40123.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40124This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
40125which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
40126generated messages.
40127
40128.vitem &%-local%&
40129The message is from a local sender.
40130
40131.vitem &%-localerror%&
40132The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
40133
40134.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
40135This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
40136when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
40137variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
40138
40139.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
40140The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
40141Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
40142
40143.vitem &%-N%&
40144A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
40145actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
40146&%-N%& is assumed.
40147
40148.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
40149This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
40150the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
40151
40152.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
40153The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
40154to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
40155
40156.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
40157If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
40158of &$spam_score_int$&.
40159
40160.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
40161The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
40162rather than Unix-format.
40163The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
40164There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
40165
40166.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
40167A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
40168certificate was verified by the server.
40169
40170.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
40171When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
40172name of the cipher suite that was used.
40173
40174.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
40175When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
40176was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
40177certificate.
40178.endlist
40179
40180Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
40181corresponding data is untrusted.
40182
40183Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
40184is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
40185line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
40186is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
40187the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
40188balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
40189to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
40190original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
40191addresses are complete.
40192
40193If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
40194the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
40195Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
40196tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
40197right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
40198follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
40199.code
40200YY darcy@austen.fict.example
40201NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
40202NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40203.endd
40204After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
40205This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
40206recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
40207delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
40208example:
40209.code
402104
40211editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40212darcy@austen.fict.example
40213rdo@foundation
40214alice@wonderland.fict.example
40215.endd
40216However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
40217result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
40218line is of the following form:
40219.display
40220<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
40221 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
40222.endd
40223The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
40224the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
40225fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
40226original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
40227envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
40228length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
40229characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
40230that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
40231
40232
40233A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
40234which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
40235when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
40236character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
40237embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
40238following:
40239
40240.table2 50pt
40241.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
40242.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
40243.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
40244.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
40245.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
40246.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
40247.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
40248.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
40249.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
40250.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
40251.endtable
40252
40253Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
40254purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
40255typical set of headers:
40256.code
40257111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
40258id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40259049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
40260038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
40261042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
40262049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
40263099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
40264darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40265104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
40266darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40267038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40268.endd
40269The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
40270&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
40271unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
40272.ecindex IIDforspo1
40273.ecindex IIDforspo2
40274.ecindex IIDforspo3
40275
40276.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
40277The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
40278an ASCII newline character.
40279However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
40280can have an alternate format.
40281This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
40282The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
40283suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
40284ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
40285Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
40286There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
40287
40288. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40289. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40290
40291.chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
40292 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
40293
40294.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
40295.cindex "DKIM"
40296
40297DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
40298linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
40299be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
40300DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
40301
40302As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
40303by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
40304any original DKIM signature.
40305
40306DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
40307It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40308
40309Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
40310.olist
40311Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
40312It can co-exist with all other Exim features
40313(including transport filters)
40314except cutthrough delivery.
40315.next
40316Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
40317ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
40318different signature contexts.
40319.endlist
40320
40321In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
40322default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
40323Exim's standard controls.
40324
40325Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
40326on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
40327
40328Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
40329When set, for each signature in incoming email,
40330exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
40331signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
40332.code
403332009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
40334 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
40335 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
40336 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
40337.endd
40338
40339You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
40340or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
40341control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
40342where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
40343senders).
40344
40345
40346.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
40347.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
40348
40349For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
40350Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
40351.code
40352rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40353
40354Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40355Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40356.endd
40357
40358Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
40359in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
40360for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
40361(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
40362but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
40363
40364Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
40365These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
40366
40367.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
40368The domain(s) you want to sign with.
40369After expansion, this can be a list.
40370Each element in turn,
40371lowercased,
40372is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
40373while expanding the remaining signing options.
40374If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40375and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40376
40377.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40378This sets the key selector string.
40379After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40380Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40381variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40382option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40383If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40384and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40385
40386.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40387This sets the private key to use.
40388You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40389&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40390The result can either
40391.ilist
40392be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40393.next
40394with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40395be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40396.next
40397start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40398the private key
40399.next
40400be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40401be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40402is set.
40403.endlist
40404
40405To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40406.code
40407openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40408openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40409.endd
40410The result file from the first command should be retained, and
40411this option set to use it.
40412Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40413for the DNS TXT record.
40414See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40415
40416Under GnuTLS:
40417.code
40418certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40419certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40420.endd
40421
40422Note that RFC 8301 says:
40423.code
40424Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40425Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40426.endd
40427
40428EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40429They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40430As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40431(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40432for some transition period.
40433The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40434for EC keys.
40435
40436OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40437.code
40438openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40439certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40440.endd
40441
40442To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40443.code
40444openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40445certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40446.endd
40447
40448Exim also supports an alternate format
40449of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40450of the standard, but not adopted.
40451A future release will probably drop that support.
40452
40453.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40454Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40455.ilist
40456&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40457.next
40458&`sha256`& &-- the default
40459.next
40460&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40461.endlist
40462
40463Note that RFC 8301 says:
40464.code
40465rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40466.endd
40467
40468.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40469If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40470the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40471syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40472local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40473tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40474
40475.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40476This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40477The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40478The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40479only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40480
40481.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40482This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40483should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40484either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40485unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40486variables here.
40487
40488.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40489If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40490list of header names.
40491Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40492in the message signature.
40493When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40494whether or not each header is present in the message.
40495The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40496&"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
40497.new
40498and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
40499.wen
40500
40501If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40502will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40503message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40504
40505A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
40506If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40507will be signed.
40508If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40509will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40510name will be appended.
40511
40512.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40513This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40514If not set, no such information will be included.
40515Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40516for the expiry tag
40517(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40518both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40519
40520RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40521
40522
40523.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40524.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40525
40526Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40527messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40528.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40529Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40530the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40531The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40532processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40533
40534.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40535Performing verification sets up information used by the
40536&%authresults%& expansion item.
40537
40538For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40539of this section can be ignored.
40540
40541The results of verification are made available to the
40542&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40543A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40544By default, the ACL is called once for each
40545syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40546If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40547If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40548summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40549
40550To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40551a large number of expansion variables
40552containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40553runtime of the ACL.
40554
40555Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40556more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40557&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40558&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40559
40560The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40561list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40562called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40563the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40564list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40565&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40566it defaults as:
40567.code
40568dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40569.endd
40570This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40571DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40572call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40573.code
40574dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40575.endd
40576This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40577and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40578You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40579.code
40580dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40581.endd
40582
40583If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40584&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40585
40586Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40587(such as the From: header)
40588care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40589and for the domain part if identities.
40590The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40591
40592If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40593for each matching signature.
40594
40595
40596Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40597available (from most to least important):
40598
40599
40600.vlist
40601.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40602The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40603an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40604&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40605
40606.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40607Within the DKIM ACL,
40608a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40609.ilist
40610&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40611identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40612.next
40613&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40614More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40615.next
40616&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40617available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40618.next
40619&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40620.endlist
40621
40622This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40623This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40624hash-method or key-size:
40625.code
40626 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40627 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40628 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40629 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40630 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40631 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40632 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40633.endd
40634
40635So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40636after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40637colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40638This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40639
40640.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40641A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40642"fail" or "invalid". One of
40643.ilist
40644&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40645key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40646.next
40647&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40648record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40649.next
40650&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40651body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40652means that the message body was modified in transit.
40653.next
40654&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40655could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40656re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40657DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40658.endlist
40659
40660This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40661
40662.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40663The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40664an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40665reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40666
40667.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40668The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40669if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40670identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40671
40672.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40673The key record selector string.
40674
40675.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40676The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40677If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40678may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40679The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40680for EC keys.
40681
40682Note that RFC 8301 says:
40683.code
40684rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40685
40686DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40687algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40688.endd
40689
40690To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40691and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40692or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40693processing of such signatures.
40694
40695.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40696The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40697
40698.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40699The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40700
40701.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40702A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40703(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40704Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40705not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40706strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40707
40708.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40709The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40710limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40711that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40712&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40713is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40714A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40715shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40716
40717.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40718UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40719When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40720
40721.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40722UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40723signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40724signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40725integer size comparisons against this value.
40726Note that Exim does not check this value.
40727
40728.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40729A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40730
40731.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40732"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40733
40734.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40735"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40736
40737.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40738Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40739in the key record.
40740
40741.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40742Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40743in the key record.
40744
40745.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40746Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40747
40748.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40749Number of bits in the key.
40750.new
40751Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
40752is verified, which is after the body hash is.
40753.wen
40754
40755Note that RFC 8301 says:
40756.code
40757Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40758less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40759.endd
40760
40761This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
40762option.
40763
40764.endlist
40765
40766In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40767
40768.vlist
40769.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40770ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40771for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40772(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40773verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40774
40775.code
40776# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40777warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40778 sender_domains = gmail.com
40779 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40780 dkim_status = none
40781.endd
40782
40783Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40784for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40785
40786.vitem &%dkim_status%&
40787ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40788results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40789to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40790
40791.code
40792deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40793 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40794 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40795 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40796.endd
40797
40798The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40799see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40800for more information of what they mean.
40801.endlist
40802
40803
40804
40805
40806.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40807.cindex SPF verification
40808
40809SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40810messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40811For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40812the &url(http://openspf.org).
40813. --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40814. --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40815. --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40816. --- discussion.
40817
40818Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40819This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40820
40821SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40822&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40823&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40824There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40825publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40826
40827For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40828.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40829Performing verification sets up information used by the
40830&%authresults%& expansion item.
40831
40832
40833.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40834.cindex ACL "spf condition"
40835The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40836It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40837and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40838Valid strings are:
40839.vlist
40840.vitem &%pass%&
40841The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40842
40843.vitem &%fail%&
40844The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40845domain in the envelope-from address.
40846
40847.vitem &%softfail%&
40848The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40849is a forgery.
40850
40851.vitem &%none%&
40852The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40853
40854.vitem &%neutral%&
40855The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40856published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40857its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40858
40859.vitem &%permerror%&
40860This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40861You may deny messages when this occurs.
40862
40863.vitem &%temperror%&
40864This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40865SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40866.endlist
40867
40868You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40869its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40870"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40871short-circuit fashion.
40872
40873Example:
40874.code
40875deny spf = fail
40876 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40877 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40878 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40879 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40880 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40881 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40882 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40883 ip=$sender_host_address
40884.endd
40885
40886When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40887variables:
40888
40889.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40890.vlist
40891.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40892.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40893 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40894 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40895 it for logging purposes.
40896
40897.vitem &$spf_received$&
40898.vindex &$spf_received$&
40899 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40900 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40901 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40902 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40903
40904 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40905 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40906
40907.vitem &$spf_result$&
40908.vindex &$spf_result$&
40909 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40910 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40911 temperror.
40912
40913.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40914.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40915 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40916 and required in order to obtain a result.
40917
40918.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40919.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40920 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40921 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40922.endlist
40923
40924
40925.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40926.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40927.cindex SPF "best guess"
40928In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40929"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40930SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40931capability.
40932Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40933for a description of what it means.
40934. --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40935
40936To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40937of the spf one. For example:
40938
40939.code
40940deny spf_guess = fail
40941 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40942.endd
40943
40944In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40945should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40946is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40947reject message.
40948
40949When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40950variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40951
40952Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40953what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40954&%spf_guess%& option.
40955For example, the following:
40956
40957.code
40958spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40959.endd
40960
40961would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40962
40963
40964.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40965.cindex lookup spf
40966A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40967address as the key and an IP address
40968(v4 or v6)
40969as the database:
40970
40971.code
40972 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40973.endd
40974
40975The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40976&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40977
40978
40979
40980
40981
40982.section DMARC SECDMARC
40983.cindex DMARC verification
40984
40985DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40986to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40987email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40988should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40989&url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40990
40991If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40992the libopendmarc library is used.
40993
40994For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40995&url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40996to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
40997repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40998SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40999This description assumes
41000that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
41001are in /usr/local/lib.
41002
41003. subsection
41004
41005There are three main-configuration options:
41006.cindex DMARC "configuration options"
41007
41008The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
41009.oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
41010defines the location of a text file of valid
41011top level domains the opendmarc library uses
41012during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
41013the most current version can be downloaded
41014from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
41015See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
41016.new
41017The default for the option is unset.
41018If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
41019.wen
41020
41021
41022The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
41023.oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
41024defines the location of a file to log results
41025of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
41026contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
41027which will manage the data, send out DMARC
41028reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
41029directory of this file is writable by the user
41030exim runs as.
41031The default is unset.
41032
41033The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
41034.oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41035defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
41036forensic report detailing alignment failures
41037if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
41038and you have configured Exim to send them.
41039If set, this is expanded and used for the
41040From: header line; the address is extracted
41041from it and used for the envelope from.
41042If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
41043the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
41044envelope from.
41045
41046. I wish we had subsections...
41047
41048.cindex DMARC controls
41049By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
41050non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
41051status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
41052use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
41053DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
41054DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
41055.code
41056 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41057.endd
41058A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
41059exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
41060Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
41061results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
41062be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
41063reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
41064forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
41065exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
41066configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
41067construction might be inadequate.
41068.code
41069 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41070.endd
41071(AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
41072not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
41073your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
41074send them.)
41075
41076There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
41077the DATA acl.
41078
41079. subsection
41080
41081DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
41082&"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
41083call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
41084condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
41085for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
41086up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
41087occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
41088
41089The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
41090right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
41091on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
41092mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
41093.display
41094&'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
41095&'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
41096&'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
41097&'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
41098&'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
41099&'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
41100&'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
41101&'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
41102.endd
41103You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
41104meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
41105"accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
41106short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
41107DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
41108strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
41109fails.
41110
41111Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
41112supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
41113result is a list of colon-separated strings.
41114
41115Performing the check sets up information used by the
41116&%authresults%& expansion item.
41117
41118Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
41119processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
41120expansion variables are available:
41121
41122.vlist
41123.vitem &$dmarc_status$&
41124.vindex &$dmarc_status$&
41125.cindex DMARC result
41126A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
41127thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
41128DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
41129(if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
41130in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
41131
41132.vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
41133.vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
41134Slightly longer, human readable status.
41135
41136.vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41137.vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41138The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
41139
41140.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41141.vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41142The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
41143are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
41144is any error, including no DMARC record.
41145.endlist
41146
41147. subsection
41148
41149By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
41150non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
41151create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
41152you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
41153DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
41154than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
41155processing or failure delivery issues).
41156
41157In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
41158tools, you need to:
41159.ilist
41160Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
41161.next
41162Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
41163import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
41164.endlist
41165
41166In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
41167.ilist
41168Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41169.next
41170Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
41171enable sending DMARC forensic reports
41172.endlist
41173
41174. subsection
41175
41176Example usage:
41177.code
41178(RCPT ACL)
41179 warn domains = +local_domains
41180 hosts = +local_hosts
41181 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41182
41183 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
41184 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41185
41186 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
41187 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
41188
41189(DATA ACL)
41190 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
41191 !authenticated = *
41192 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
41193
41194 warn dmarc_status = !accept
41195 !authenticated = *
41196 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
41197
41198 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
41199 !authenticated = *
41200 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
41201 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
41202
41203 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
41204 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
41205 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
41206
41207 deny dmarc_status = reject
41208 !authenticated = *
41209 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
41210
41211 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
41212.endd
41213
41214
41215
41216
41217
41218. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41219. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41220
41221.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
41222 "Proxy support"
41223.cindex "proxy support"
41224.cindex "proxy" "access via"
41225
41226A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
41227Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
41228
41229
41230.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
41231.cindex proxy inbound
41232.cindex proxy "server side"
41233.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
41234.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
41235
41236Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
41237that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
41238To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
41239in Local/Makefile.
41240
41241It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
41242&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
41243
41244The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
41245such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
41246to distribute load.
41247Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
41248the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
41249There is no logging if a host passes or
41250fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
41251recorded in an ACL (example is below).
41252
41253Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
41254main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
41255hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
41256Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
41257automatically determines which version is in use.
41258
41259The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
41260and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
41261negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
41262Exim and the proxy server.
41263
41264The following expansion variables are usable
41265(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
41266of the proxy):
41267.display
41268&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
41269&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
41270&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
41271&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
41272&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
41273.endd
41274If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
41275there was a protocol error.
41276The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
41277will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
41278
41279Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
41280per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
41281evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
41282handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
41283With the option set so high, you lose the ability
41284to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
41285In order to prevent your server from overload, you
41286need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
41287A possible solution is:
41288.display
41289 # Set max number of connections per host
41290 LIMIT = 5
41291 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
41292 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
41293
41294 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
41295 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
41296.endd
41297
41298
41299
41300.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
41301.cindex proxy outbound
41302.cindex proxy "client side"
41303.cindex proxy SOCKS
41304.cindex SOCKS proxy
41305Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
41306using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
41307The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
41308Local/Makefile.
41309
41310Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
41311on an smtp transport.
41312The option value is expanded and should then be a list
41313(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
41314Each proxy specifier is a list
41315(space-separated by default) where the initial element
41316is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
41317
41318Options are a string <name>=<value>.
41319The list of options is in the following table:
41320.display
41321&'auth '& authentication method
41322&'name '& authentication username
41323&'pass '& authentication password
41324&'port '& tcp port
41325&'tmo '& connection timeout
41326&'pri '& priority
41327&'weight '& selection bias
41328.endd
41329
41330More details on each of these options follows:
41331
41332.ilist
41333.cindex authentication "to proxy"
41334.cindex proxy authentication
41335&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
41336Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
41337for access to the proxy.
41338Default is &"none"&.
41339.next
41340&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
41341Default is empty.
41342.next
41343&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
41344Default is empty.
41345.next
41346&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
41347Default is 1080.
41348.next
41349&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
41350Default is 5.
41351.next
41352&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
41353higher values being tried first.
41354The default priority is 1.
41355.next
41356&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
41357Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
41358weighted by this value.
41359The default value for selection bias is 1.
41360.endlist
41361
41362Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
41363and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
41364overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
41365
41366.section Logging SECTproxyLog
41367To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
41368add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
41369This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
41370
41371. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41372. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41373
41374.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
41375 "Internationalisation""
41376.cindex internationalisation "email address"
41377.cindex EAI
41378.cindex i18n
41379.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
41380
41381Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41382To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41383Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41384
41385If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41386instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41387requirement, upon libidn2.
41388
41389.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41390.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41391The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41392a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41393accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41394SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41395
41396If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41397international handling for the message is enabled and
41398the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41399
41400The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41401message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41402whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41403when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41404
41405Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41406UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41407require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41408the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41409
41410HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41411components expanded to a-label form,
41412and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41413form of the name.
41414
41415.cindex log protocol
41416.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41417.cindex i18n logging
41418Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41419prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41420
41421The following expansion operators can be used:
41422.code
41423${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41424${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41425${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41426${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41427.endd
41428
41429.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41430.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41431The RCPT ACL
41432may use the following modifier:
41433.display
41434control = utf8_downconvert
41435control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41436.endd
41437This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41438a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41439Message Submission Agent context.
41440If a value is appended it may be:
41441.display
41442&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41443&`0 `& no downconversion
41444&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41445.endd
41446
41447If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41448is initially set to -1.
41449
41450The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41451If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41452and it overrides any previously set value.
41453
41454
41455There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41456Configurations supporting these should inspect
41457&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41458
41459There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41460Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41461for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41462
41463There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41464and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41465
41466
41467
41468.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41469To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41470the following expansion operator can be used:
41471.code
41472${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41473.endd
41474
41475The string is converted from the charset specified by
41476the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41477or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41478to the
41479modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41480with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41481(which has to be a single character)
41482are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41483<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41484
41485The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41486The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41487
41488This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41489by many other IMAP servers.
41490
41491Examples:
41492.display
41493&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41494&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41495&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41496.endd
41497
41498Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41499must be representable in UTF-16.
41500
41501
41502. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41503. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41504
41505.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41506 "Events"
41507.cindex events
41508
41509The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41510of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41511actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41512processing actions.
41513
41514Most installations will never need to use Events.
41515The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41516in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41517
41518There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41519The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41520a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41521
41522Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41523An example might look like:
41524.cindex logging custom
41525.code
41526event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41527{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41528 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41529 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41530 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41531 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41532 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41533 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41534 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41535} {}}
41536.endd
41537
41538Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41539The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41540expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41541
41542.new
41543The current list of events is:
41544.wen
41545.display
41546&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41547&`msg:complete after main `& per message
41548&`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41549&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41550&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41551&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41552&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41553&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41554&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41555&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41556&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41557&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41558&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41559&`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41560.endd
41561New event types may be added in future.
41562
41563The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41564event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41565or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41566
41567The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41568before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41569can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41570
41571The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41572should define the event action.
41573
41574An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41575with the event type:
41576.display
41577&`dane:fail `& failure reason
41578&`msg:defer `& error string
41579&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41580&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41581&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41582&`msg:host:defer `& error string
41583&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41584&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41585&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41586&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41587&`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41588.endd
41589
41590The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41591
41592For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41593however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41594the course of its processing:
41595.ilist
41596variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41597transport call
41598.next
41599acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41600and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41601.endlist
41602Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41603a useful way of writing to the main log.
41604
41605The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41606return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41607following will be forced:
41608.display
41609&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41610&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41611&`smtp:connect `& close connection
41612.endd
41613All other message types ignore the result string, and
41614no other use is made of it.
41615
41616For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41617then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41618the target system.
41619
41620For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41621chain element received on the connection.
41622For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41623loaded locally.
41624
41625. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41626. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41627
41628.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41629 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41630.cindex "adding drivers"
41631.cindex "new drivers, adding"
41632.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41633The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41634authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41635
41636.olist
41637Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41638existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41639.next
41640Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41641.display
41642<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41643.endd
41644where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41645code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41646should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41647.next
41648Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41649.code
41650#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41651.endd
41652.next
41653Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41654and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41655.next
41656Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41657near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41658Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41659As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41660simple form that most lookups have.
41661.next
41662Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41663&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41664driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41665.next
41666Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41667definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41668.next
41669Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41670&_src_&.
41671.next
41672Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41673as for other drivers and lookups.
41674.endlist
41675
41676Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41677proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41678occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41679options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41680searched using a binary chop procedure.
41681
41682There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41683the interface that is expected.
41684
41685
41686
41687
41688. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41689. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41690
41691. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41692. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41693. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41694. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41695. processors.
41696. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41697
41698.literal xml
41699<?sdop
41700 format="newpage"
41701 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41702 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41703?>
41704.literal off
41705
41706.makeindex "Options index" "option"
41707.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41708.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41709
41710
41711. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41712. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////